mirror of
https://gitlab.gnome.org/GNOME/gtk.git
synced 2024-11-06 08:40:08 +00:00
16097 lines
535 KiB
Plaintext
Executable File
16097 lines
535 KiB
Plaintext
Executable File
<!doctype book PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V3.1//EN" [
|
||
<!notation PNG system "PNG">
|
||
<!entity % local.notation.class "| PNG">
|
||
]>
|
||
<book id="gtk-tut">
|
||
|
||
<bookinfo>
|
||
<date>January 24th, 2003</date>
|
||
<title>GTK+ 2.0 Tutorial</title>
|
||
<authorgroup>
|
||
<author>
|
||
<firstname>Tony</firstname>
|
||
<surname>Gale</surname>
|
||
</author>
|
||
<author>
|
||
<firstname>Ian</firstname>
|
||
<surname>Main</surname>
|
||
</author>
|
||
<author>
|
||
<firstname>& the GTK team</firstname>
|
||
</author>
|
||
</authorgroup>
|
||
<abstract>
|
||
<para>This is a tutorial on how to use GTK (the GIMP Toolkit) through its C
|
||
interface.</para>
|
||
</abstract>
|
||
</bookinfo>
|
||
|
||
<toc></toc>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-TutorialDownload">
|
||
<title>Tutorial Availability</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>A copy of this tutorial in SGML and HTML is distributed with each
|
||
source code release of GTK+. For binary distributions, please check with
|
||
your vendor.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A copy is available online for reference at <ulink
|
||
url="http://www.gtk.org/documentation.html#Tutorials">http://www.gtk.org/documentation.html#Tutorials</ulink>. You can also find other GTK+ tutorials there.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A packaged version of this tutorial is available from
|
||
<ulink url="ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/tutorial/">
|
||
ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/tutorial</ulink> which contains the tutorial in
|
||
various different formats. This package is primary for those people wanting
|
||
to have the tutorial available for offline reference and for printing. Note
|
||
that the packaged version may be older than the online version.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Introduction">
|
||
<title>Introduction</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK (GIMP Toolkit) is a library for creating graphical user
|
||
interfaces. It is licensed using the LGPL license, so you can develop
|
||
open software, free software, or even commercial non-free software
|
||
using GTK without having to spend anything for licenses or royalties.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>It's called the GIMP toolkit because it was originally written for
|
||
developing the GNU Image Manipulation Program (GIMP), but GTK has
|
||
now been used in a large number of software projects, including the
|
||
GNU Network Object Model Environment (GNOME) project. GTK is built on
|
||
top of GDK (GIMP Drawing Kit) which is basically a wrapper around the
|
||
low-level functions for accessing the underlying windowing functions
|
||
(Xlib in the case of the X windows system), and gdk-pixbuf, a library for
|
||
client-side image manipulation.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK is essentially an object oriented application programmers
|
||
interface (API). Although written completely in C, it is implemented
|
||
using the idea of classes and callback functions (pointers to
|
||
functions).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There is also a third component called GLib which contains a few
|
||
replacements for some standard calls, as well as some additional
|
||
functions for handling linked lists, etc. The replacement functions
|
||
are used to increase GTK's portability, as some of the functions
|
||
implemented here are not available or are nonstandard on other Unixes
|
||
such as g_strerror(). Some also contain enhancements to the libc
|
||
versions, such as g_malloc() that has enhanced debugging utilities.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In version 2.0, GLib has picked up the type system which forms the
|
||
foundation for GTK's class hierarchy, the signal system which is used
|
||
throughout GTK, a thread API which abstracts the different native thread APIs
|
||
of the various platforms and a facility for loading modules.
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As the last component, GTK uses the Pango library for internationalized
|
||
text output.
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This tutorial describes the C interface to GTK. There are GTK
|
||
bindings for many other languages including C++, Guile, Perl, Python,
|
||
TOM, Ada95, Objective C, Free Pascal, Eiffel, Java and C#. If you intend to
|
||
use another language's bindings to GTK, look at that binding's
|
||
documentation first. In some cases that documentation may describe
|
||
some important conventions (which you should know first) and then
|
||
refer you back to this tutorial. There are also some cross-platform
|
||
APIs (such as wxWindows and V) which use GTK as one of their target
|
||
platforms; again, consult their documentation first.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you're developing your GTK application in C++, a few extra notes
|
||
are in order. There's a C++ binding to GTK called GTK--, which
|
||
provides a more C++-like interface to GTK; you should probably look
|
||
into this instead. If you don't like that approach for whatever
|
||
reason, there are two alternatives for using GTK. First, you can use
|
||
only the C subset of C++ when interfacing with GTK and then use the C
|
||
interface as described in this tutorial. Second, you can use GTK and
|
||
C++ together by declaring all callbacks as static functions in C++
|
||
classes, and again calling GTK using its C interface. If you choose
|
||
this last approach, you can include as the callback's data value a
|
||
pointer to the object to be manipulated (the so-called "this" value).
|
||
Selecting between these options is simply a matter of preference,
|
||
since in all three approaches you get C++ and GTK. None of these
|
||
approaches requires the use of a specialized preprocessor, so no
|
||
matter what you choose you can use standard C++ with GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This tutorial is an attempt to document as much as possible of GTK,
|
||
but it is by no means complete. This tutorial assumes a good
|
||
understanding of C, and how to create C programs. It would be a great
|
||
benefit for the reader to have previous X programming experience, but
|
||
it shouldn't be necessary. If you are learning GTK as your first
|
||
widget set, please comment on how you found this tutorial, and what
|
||
you had trouble with. There are also C++, Objective C, ADA, Guile and
|
||
other language bindings available, but I don't follow these.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This document is a "work in progress". Please look for updates on
|
||
<ulink url="http://www.gtk.org/">http://www.gtk.org/</ulink>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>I would very much like to hear of any problems you have learning GTK
|
||
from this document, and would appreciate input as to how it may be
|
||
improved. Please see the section on <link linkend="ch-Contributing">Contributing
|
||
</link> for further information.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-GettingStarted">
|
||
<title>Getting Started</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first thing to do, of course, is download the GTK source and
|
||
install it. You can always get the latest version from <ulink
|
||
url="ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk">ftp.gtk.org</ulink>. You can also view
|
||
other sources of GTK information on
|
||
<ulink url="http://www.gtk.org/">http://www.gtk.org/</ulink>. GTK
|
||
uses GNU autoconf for configuration. Once untar'd, type
|
||
<literal>./configure --help</literal> to see a list of options.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GTK source distribution also contains the complete source to all
|
||
of the examples used in this tutorial, along with Makefiles to aid
|
||
compilation.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To begin our introduction to GTK, we'll start with the simplest
|
||
program possible. This program will create a 200x200 pixel window and
|
||
has no way of exiting except to be killed by using the shell.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/base.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start base base.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can compile the above program with gcc using:</para>
|
||
<para><literallayout>
|
||
<literal>gcc base.c -o base `pkg-config --cflags --libs gtk+-2.0`</literal>
|
||
</literallayout></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The meaning of the unusual compilation options is explained below in
|
||
<link linkend="sec-Compiling">Compiling Hello World</link>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>All programs will of course include <filename>gtk/gtk.h</filename> which
|
||
declares the variables, functions, structures, etc. that will be used in your GTK
|
||
application.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next line:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>calls the function gtk_init(gint *argc, gchar ***argv) which will be called
|
||
in all GTK applications. This sets up a few things for us such as the default visual
|
||
and color map and then proceeds to call gdk_init(gint *argc, gchar ***argv).
|
||
This function initializes the library for use, sets up default signal handlers, and
|
||
checks the arguments passed to your application on the command line, looking for
|
||
one of the following:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist spacing=Compact>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--gtk-module</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--g-fatal-warnings</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--gtk-debug</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--gtk-no-debug</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--gdk-debug</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--gdk-no-debug</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--display</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--sync</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--name</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>--class</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>It removes these from the argument list, leaving anything it does not
|
||
recognize for your application to parse or ignore. This creates a set
|
||
of standard arguments accepted by all GTK applications.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next two lines of code create and display a window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL</literal> argument specifies that we want the
|
||
window to undergo window manager decoration and placement. Rather than
|
||
create a window of 0x0 size, a window without children is set to
|
||
200x200 by default so you can still manipulate it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The gtk_widget_show() function lets GTK know that we are done setting
|
||
the attributes of this widget, and that it can display it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The last line enters the GTK main processing loop.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_main() is another call you will see in every GTK application.
|
||
When control reaches this point, GTK will sleep waiting for X events
|
||
(such as button or key presses), timeouts, or file IO notifications to
|
||
occur. In our simple example, however, events are ignored.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-HelloWorld">
|
||
<title>Hello World in GTK</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now for a program with a widget (a button). It's the classic
|
||
hello world a la GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/helloworld.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start helloworld helloworld.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* This is a callback function. The data arguments are ignored
|
||
* in this example. More on callbacks below. */
|
||
static void hello( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Hello World\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
/* If you return FALSE in the "delete-event" signal handler,
|
||
* GTK will emit the "destroy" signal. Returning TRUE means
|
||
* you don't want the window to be destroyed.
|
||
* This is useful for popping up 'are you sure you want to quit?'
|
||
* type dialogs. */
|
||
|
||
g_print ("delete event occurred\n");
|
||
|
||
/* Change TRUE to FALSE and the main window will be destroyed with
|
||
* a "delete-event". */
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Another callback */
|
||
static void destroy( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
/* This is called in all GTK applications. Arguments are parsed
|
||
* from the command line and are returned to the application. */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
/* When the window is given the "delete-event" signal (this is given
|
||
* by the window manager, usually by the "close" option, or on the
|
||
* titlebar), we ask it to call the delete_event () function
|
||
* as defined above. The data passed to the callback
|
||
* function is NULL and is ignored in the callback function. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Here we connect the "destroy" event to a signal handler.
|
||
* This event occurs when we call gtk_widget_destroy() on the window,
|
||
* or if we return FALSE in the "delete-event" callback. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Creates a new button with the label "Hello World". */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Hello World");
|
||
|
||
/* When the button receives the "clicked" signal, it will call the
|
||
* function hello() passing it NULL as its argument. The hello()
|
||
* function is defined above. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (hello), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* This will cause the window to be destroyed by calling
|
||
* gtk_widget_destroy(window) when "clicked". Again, the destroy
|
||
* signal could come from here, or the window manager. */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
|
||
/* This packs the button into the window (a gtk container). */
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), button);
|
||
|
||
/* The final step is to display this newly created widget. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* and the window */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* All GTK applications must have a gtk_main(). Control ends here
|
||
* and waits for an event to occur (like a key press or
|
||
* mouse event). */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Compiling">
|
||
<title>Compiling Hello World</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>To compile use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literallayout>
|
||
<literal>gcc -Wall -g helloworld.c -o helloworld `pkg-config --cflags gtk+-2.0` \</literal>
|
||
<literal> `pkg-config --libs gtk+-2.0`</literal>
|
||
</literallayout></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This uses the program <literal>pkg-config</literal>, which can be obtained from
|
||
<ulink url="http://www.freedesktop.org">www.freedesktop.org</ulink>. This program
|
||
reads the <filename>.pc</filename> which comes with GTK to determine what
|
||
compiler switches are needed to compile programs that use GTK.
|
||
<literal>pkg-config --cflags gtk+-2.0</literal> will output a list of include
|
||
directories for the compiler to look in, and
|
||
<literal>pkg-config --libs gtk+-2.0</literal>
|
||
will output the list of libraries for the compiler to link with and
|
||
the directories to find them in. In the above example they could have
|
||
been combined into a single instance, such as
|
||
<literal>pkg-config --cflags --libs gtk+-2.0</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that the type of single quote used in the compile command above
|
||
is significant.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The libraries that are usually linked in are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The GTK library (<literal>-lgtk</literal>), the widget library,
|
||
based on top of GDK.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The GDK library (<literal>-lgdk</literal>), the Xlib wrapper.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The gdk-pixbuf library (<literal>-lgdk_pixbuf</literal>), the image
|
||
manipulation library.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The Pango library (<literal>-lpango</literal>) for internationalized
|
||
text.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The gobject library (<literal>-lgobject</literal>), containing the
|
||
type system on which GTK is based.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The gmodule library (<literal>-lgmodule</literal>), which is used
|
||
to load run time extensions.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The GLib library (<literal>-lglib</literal>), containing miscellaneous
|
||
functions; only g_print() is used in this particular example. GTK is built on top
|
||
of GLib so you will always require this library. See the section on
|
||
<link linkend="ch-glib">GLib</link> for details.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The Xlib library (<literal>-lX11</literal>) which is used by GDK.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The Xext library (<literal>-lXext</literal>). This contains code
|
||
for shared memory pixmaps and other X extensions.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>The math library (<literal>-lm</literal>). This is used by GTK
|
||
for various purposes.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheoryOfSignalsAndCallbacks">
|
||
<title>Theory of Signals and Callbacks</title>
|
||
|
||
<note>
|
||
<para>In version 2.0, the signal system has been moved from GTK to GLib, therefore the
|
||
functions and types explained in this section have a "g_" prefix rather than a "gtk_"
|
||
prefix. We won't go into details about the extensions which the GLib 2.0 signal system
|
||
has relative to the GTK 1.2 signal system.</para>
|
||
</note>
|
||
|
||
<para>Before we look in detail at <emphasis>helloworld</emphasis>, we'll discuss signals
|
||
and callbacks. GTK is an event driven toolkit, which means it will
|
||
sleep in gtk_main() until an event occurs and control is passed to the
|
||
appropriate function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This passing of control is done using the idea of "signals". (Note
|
||
that these signals are not the same as the Unix system signals, and
|
||
are not implemented using them, although the terminology is almost
|
||
identical.) When an event occurs, such as the press of a mouse button,
|
||
the appropriate signal will be "emitted" by the widget that was
|
||
pressed. This is how GTK does most of its useful work. There are
|
||
signals that all widgets inherit, such as "destroy", and there are
|
||
signals that are widget specific, such as "toggled" on a toggle
|
||
button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To make a button perform an action, we set up a signal handler to
|
||
catch these signals and call the appropriate function. This is done by
|
||
using a function such as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect( gpointer *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer func_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>where the first argument is the widget which will be emitting the
|
||
signal, and the second the name of the signal you wish to catch. The
|
||
third is the function you wish to be called when it is caught, and the
|
||
fourth, the data you wish to have passed to this function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function specified in the third argument is called a "callback
|
||
function", and should generally be of the form</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void callback_func( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
... /* other signal arguments */
|
||
gpointer callback_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>where the first argument will be a pointer to the widget that emitted
|
||
the signal, and the last a pointer to the data given as the last
|
||
argument to the g_signal_connect() function as shown above.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that the above form for a signal callback function declaration is
|
||
only a general guide, as some widget specific signals generate
|
||
different calling parameters.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Another call used in the <emphasis>helloworld</emphasis> example, is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect_swapped( gpointer *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer *callback_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>g_signal_connect_swapped() is the same as g_signal_connect() except
|
||
that the instance on which the signal is emitted and data will be swapped when
|
||
calling the handler. So when using this function to connect signals, the callback
|
||
should be of the form</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void callback_func( gpointer callback_data,
|
||
... /* other signal arguments */
|
||
GtkWidget *widget);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>where the object is usually a widget. We usually don't setup callbacks
|
||
for g_signal_connect_swapped() however. They are usually used to call a
|
||
GTK function that accepts a single widget or object as an argument, when a signal
|
||
is emitted on some <emphasis>other</emphasis> object. In the
|
||
<emphasis>helloworld</emphasis> example, we connect to the "clicked" signal
|
||
on the button, but call gtk_widget_destroy() on the window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If your callbacks need additional data, use g_signal_connect() instead
|
||
of g_signal_connect_swapped().</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Events">
|
||
<title>Events</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>In addition to the signal mechanism described above, there is a set
|
||
of <emphasis>events</emphasis> that reflect the X event mechanism. Callbacks may
|
||
also be attached to these events. These events are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist spacing=Compact>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> button_press_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> button_release_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> scroll_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> motion_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> delete_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> destroy_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> expose_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> key_press_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> key_release_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> enter_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> leave_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> configure_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> focus_in_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> focus_out_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> map_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> unmap_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> property_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> selection_clear_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> selection_request_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> selection_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> proximity_in_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> proximity_out_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> visibility_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> client_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> no_expose_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> window_state_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>In order to connect a callback function to one of these events you
|
||
use the function g_signal_connect(), as described above, using one of
|
||
the above event names as the <literal>name</literal> parameter. The callback
|
||
function for events has a slightly different form than that for
|
||
signals:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint callback_func( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer callback_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>GdkEvent is a C <literal>union</literal> structure whose type will depend upon
|
||
which of the above events has occurred. In order for us to tell which event
|
||
has been issued each of the possible alternatives has a <literal>type</literal>
|
||
member that reflects the event being issued. The other components
|
||
of the event structure will depend upon the type of the
|
||
event. Possible values for the type are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GDK_NOTHING
|
||
GDK_DELETE
|
||
GDK_DESTROY
|
||
GDK_EXPOSE
|
||
GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_PRESS
|
||
GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS
|
||
GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE
|
||
GDK_KEY_PRESS
|
||
GDK_KEY_RELEASE
|
||
GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE
|
||
GDK_CONFIGURE
|
||
GDK_MAP
|
||
GDK_UNMAP
|
||
GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_CLEAR
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_REQUEST
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_IN
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT
|
||
GDK_DRAG_ENTER
|
||
GDK_DRAG_LEAVE
|
||
GDK_DRAG_MOTION
|
||
GDK_DRAG_STATUS
|
||
GDK_DROP_START
|
||
GDK_DROP_FINISHED
|
||
GDK_CLIENT_EVENT
|
||
GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY
|
||
GDK_NO_EXPOSE
|
||
GDK_SCROLL
|
||
GDK_WINDOW_STATE
|
||
GDK_SETTING
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>So, to connect a callback function to one of these events we would use
|
||
something like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "button_press_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (button_press_callback), NULL);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This assumes that <literal>button</literal> is a Button widget. Now, when the
|
||
mouse is over the button and a mouse button is pressed, the function
|
||
button_press_callback() will be called. This function may be declared as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean button_press_callback( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that we can declare the second argument as type
|
||
<literal>GdkEventButton</literal> as we know what type of event will occur for this
|
||
function to be called.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The value returned from this function indicates whether the event
|
||
should be propagated further by the GTK event handling
|
||
mechanism. Returning TRUE indicates that the event has been handled,
|
||
and that it should not propagate further. Returning FALSE continues
|
||
the normal event handling. See the section on
|
||
<link linkend="ch-AdvancedEventsAndSignals">Advanced Event and Signal Handling</link>
|
||
for more details on this propagation process.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>For details on the GdkEvent data types, see the appendix entitled
|
||
<link linkend="app-GDKEventTypes">GDK Event Types</link>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GDK selection and drag-and-drop APIs also emit a number of events which
|
||
are reflected in GTK by the signals. See <link
|
||
linkend="sec-SignalsOnSourceWidgets">Signals on the source widget</link> and <link
|
||
linkend="sec-SignalsOnDestWidgets">Signals on the destination widget</link>
|
||
for details on the signatures of the callback functions for these signals:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist spacing=Compact>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> selection_received</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> selection_get</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_begin_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_end_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_data_delete</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_motion</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_drop</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_data_get</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> drag_data_received</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SteppingThroughHelloWorld">
|
||
<title>Stepping Through Hello World</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now that we know the theory behind this, let's clarify by walking
|
||
through the example <emphasis>helloworld</emphasis> program.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is the callback function that will be called when the button is
|
||
"clicked". We ignore both the widget and the data in this example, but
|
||
it is not hard to do things with them. The next example will use the
|
||
data argument to tell us which button was pressed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void hello( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Hello World\n");
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next callback is a bit special. The "delete-event" occurs when the
|
||
window manager sends this event to the application. We have a choice
|
||
here as to what to do about these events. We can ignore them, make
|
||
some sort of response, or simply quit the application.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The value you return in this callback lets GTK know what action to
|
||
take. By returning TRUE, we let it know that we don't want to have
|
||
the "destroy" signal emitted, keeping our application running. By
|
||
returning FALSE, we ask that "destroy" be emitted, which in turn will
|
||
call our "destroy" signal handler.</para>
|
||
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("delete event occurred\n");
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is another callback function which causes the program to quit by
|
||
calling gtk_main_quit(). This function tells GTK that it is to exit
|
||
from gtk_main when control is returned to it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void destroy( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>I assume you know about the main() function... yes, as with other
|
||
applications, all GTK applications will also have one of these.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This next part declares pointers to a structure of type
|
||
GtkWidget. These are used below to create a window and a button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is our gtk_init() again. As before, this initializes the toolkit,
|
||
and parses the arguments found on the command line. Any argument it
|
||
recognizes from the command line, it removes from the list, and
|
||
modifies argc and argv to make it look like they never existed,
|
||
allowing your application to parse the remaining arguments.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Create a new window. This is fairly straightforward. Memory is
|
||
allocated for the GtkWidget *window structure so it now points to a
|
||
valid structure. It sets up a new window, but it is not displayed
|
||
until we call gtk_widget_show(window) near the end of our program.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here are two examples of connecting a signal handler to an object, in
|
||
this case, the window. Here, the "delete-event" and "destroy" signals
|
||
are caught. The first is emitted when we use the window manager to
|
||
kill the window. The second is emitted when we use the gtk_widget_destroy() call
|
||
passing in the window widget as the object to destroy, or when, in the
|
||
"delete-event" handler, we return FALSE.
|
||
|
||
The <literal>G_CALLBACK</literal> is a macro
|
||
that performs type casting and checking for us, as well as aid the readability of
|
||
the code.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy), NULL);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This next function is used to set an attribute of a container object.
|
||
This just sets the window so it has a blank area along the inside of
|
||
it 10 pixels wide where no widgets will go. There are other similar
|
||
functions which we will look at in the section on
|
||
<link linkend="ch-SettingWidgetAttributes">Setting Widget Attributes</link></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>And again, <literal>GTK_CONTAINER</literal> is a macro to perform type casting.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This call creates a new button. It allocates space for a new GtkWidget
|
||
structure in memory, initializes it, and makes the button pointer
|
||
point to it. It will have the label "Hello World" on it when
|
||
displayed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Hello World");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here, we take this button, and make it do something useful. We attach
|
||
a signal handler to it so when it emits the "clicked" signal, our
|
||
hello() function is called. The data is ignored, so we simply pass in
|
||
NULL to the hello() callback function. Obviously, the "clicked" signal
|
||
is emitted when we click the button with our mouse pointer.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (hello), NULL);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>We are also going to use this button to exit our program. This will
|
||
illustrate how the "destroy" signal may come from either the window
|
||
manager, or our program. When the button is "clicked", same as above,
|
||
it calls the first hello() callback function, and then this one in the
|
||
order they are set up. You may have as many callback functions as you
|
||
need, and all will be executed in the order you connected
|
||
them. Because the gtk_widget_destroy() function accepts only a
|
||
GtkWidget *widget as an argument, we use the g_signal_connect_swapped()
|
||
function here instead of straight g_signal_connect().</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is a packing call, which will be explained in depth later on in
|
||
<link linkend="ch-PackingWidgets">Packing Widgets</link>. But it is
|
||
fairly easy to understand. It simply tells GTK that the button is to
|
||
be placed in the window where it will be displayed. Note that a GTK
|
||
container can only contain one widget. There are other widgets, that
|
||
are described later, which are designed to layout multiple widgets in
|
||
various ways.
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), button);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now we have everything set up the way we want it to be. With all the
|
||
signal handlers in place, and the button placed in the window where it
|
||
should be, we ask GTK to "show" the widgets on the screen. The window
|
||
widget is shown last so the whole window will pop up at once rather
|
||
than seeing the window pop up, and then the button form inside of
|
||
it. Although with such a simple example, you'd never notice.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And of course, we call gtk_main() which waits for events to come from
|
||
the X server and will call on the widgets to emit signals when these
|
||
events come.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And the final return. Control returns here after gtk_main_quit() is called.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
return 0;
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now, when we click the mouse button on a GTK button, the widget emits
|
||
a "clicked" signal. In order for us to use this information, our
|
||
program sets up a signal handler to catch that signal, which
|
||
dispatches the function of our choice. In our example, when the button
|
||
we created is "clicked", the hello() function is called with a NULL
|
||
argument, and then the next handler for this signal is called. This
|
||
calls the gtk_widget_destroy() function, passing it the window widget
|
||
as its argument, destroying the window widget. This causes the window
|
||
to emit the "destroy" signal, which is caught, and calls our destroy()
|
||
callback function, which simply exits GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Another course of events is to use the window manager to kill the
|
||
window, which will cause the "delete-event" to be emitted. This will
|
||
call our "delete-event" handler. If we return TRUE here, the window
|
||
will be left as is and nothing will happen. Returning FALSE will cause
|
||
GTK to emit the "destroy" signal which of course calls the "destroy"
|
||
callback, exiting GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-MovingOn">
|
||
<title>Moving On</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DataTypes">
|
||
<title>Data Types</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are a few things you probably noticed in the previous examples
|
||
that need explaining. The gint, gchar, etc. that you see are typedefs
|
||
to int and char, respectively, that are part of the GLib system. This
|
||
is done to get around that nasty dependency on the size of simple data
|
||
types when doing calculations.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A good example is "gint32" which will be typedef'd to a 32 bit integer
|
||
for any given platform, whether it be the 64 bit alpha, or the 32 bit
|
||
i386. The typedefs are very straightforward and intuitive. They are
|
||
all defined in <filename>glib/glib.h</filename> (which gets included from
|
||
<filename>gtk.h</filename>).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You'll also notice GTK's ability to use GtkWidget when the function
|
||
calls for a GtkObject. GTK is an object oriented design, and a widget
|
||
is an object.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-MoreOnSignalHandlers">
|
||
<title>More on Signal Handlers</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Lets take another look at the g_signal_connect() declaration.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect( gpointer object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer func_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Notice the gulong return value? This is a tag that identifies your
|
||
callback function. As stated above, you may have as many callbacks per
|
||
signal and per object as you need, and each will be executed in turn,
|
||
in the order they were attached.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This tag allows you to remove this callback from the list by using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_signal_handler_disconnect( gpointer object,
|
||
gulong id );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>So, by passing in the widget you wish to remove the handler from, and
|
||
the tag returned by one of the signal_connect functions, you can
|
||
disconnect a signal handler.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can also temporarily disable signal handlers with the
|
||
g_signal_handler_block() and g_signal_handler_unblock() family of
|
||
functions.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_signal_handler_block( gpointer object,
|
||
gulong id );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handlers_block_by_func( gpointer object,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handler_unblock( gpointer object,
|
||
gulong id );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handlers_unblock_by_func( gpointer object,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-AnUpgradedHelloWorld">
|
||
<title>An Upgraded Hello World</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Let's take a look at a slightly improved <emphasis>helloworld</emphasis> with
|
||
better examples of callbacks. This will also introduce us to our next
|
||
topic, packing widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/helloworld2.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start helloworld2 helloworld2.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Our new improved callback. The data passed to this function
|
||
* is printed to stdout. */
|
||
static void callback( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Hello again - %s was pressed\n", (gchar *) data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* another callback */
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *box1;
|
||
|
||
/* This is called in all GTK applications. Arguments are parsed
|
||
* from the command line and are returned to the application. */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
/* This is a new call, which just sets the title of our
|
||
* new window to "Hello Buttons!" */
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Hello Buttons!");
|
||
|
||
/* Here we just set a handler for delete_event that immediately
|
||
* exits GTK. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* We create a box to pack widgets into. This is described in detail
|
||
* in the "packing" section. The box is not really visible, it
|
||
* is just used as a tool to arrange widgets. */
|
||
box1 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Put the box into the main window. */
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), box1);
|
||
|
||
/* Creates a new button with the label "Button 1". */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Button 1");
|
||
|
||
/* Now when the button is clicked, we call the "callback" function
|
||
* with a pointer to "button 1" as its argument */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback), (gpointer) "button 1");
|
||
|
||
/* Instead of gtk_container_add, we pack this button into the invisible
|
||
* box, which has been packed into the window. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX(box1), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Always remember this step, this tells GTK that our preparation for
|
||
* this button is complete, and it can now be displayed. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* Do these same steps again to create a second button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Button 2");
|
||
|
||
/* Call the same callback function with a different argument,
|
||
* passing a pointer to "button 2" instead. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback), (gpointer) "button 2");
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start(GTK_BOX (box1), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* The order in which we show the buttons is not really important, but I
|
||
* recommend showing the window last, so it all pops up at once. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box1);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Rest in gtk_main and wait for the fun to begin! */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Compile this program using the same linking arguments as our first
|
||
example. You'll notice this time there is no easy way to exit the
|
||
program, you have to use your window manager or command line to kill
|
||
it. A good exercise for the reader would be to insert a third "Quit"
|
||
button that will exit the program. You may also wish to play with the
|
||
options to gtk_box_pack_start() while reading the next section. Try
|
||
resizing the window, and observe the behavior.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-PackingWidgets">
|
||
<title>Packing Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>When creating an application, you'll want to put more than one widget
|
||
inside a window. Our first <emphasis>helloworld</emphasis> example only used one
|
||
widget so we could simply use a gtk_container_add() call to "pack" the
|
||
widget into the window. But when you want to put more than one widget
|
||
into a window, how do you control where that widget is positioned?
|
||
This is where packing comes in.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheoryOfPackingBoxes">
|
||
<title>Theory of Packing Boxes</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Most packing is done by creating boxes. These
|
||
are invisible widget containers that we can pack our widgets into
|
||
which come in two forms, a horizontal box, and a vertical box. When
|
||
packing widgets into a horizontal box, the objects are inserted
|
||
horizontally from left to right or right to left depending on the call
|
||
used. In a vertical box, widgets are packed from top to bottom or vice
|
||
versa. You may use any combination of boxes inside or beside other
|
||
boxes to create the desired effect.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new horizontal box, we use a call to gtk_hbox_new(), and
|
||
for vertical boxes, gtk_vbox_new(). The gtk_box_pack_start() and
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end() functions are used to place objects inside of these
|
||
containers. The gtk_box_pack_start() function will start at the top
|
||
and work its way down in a vbox, and pack left to right in an hbox.
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end() will do the opposite, packing from bottom to top in
|
||
a vbox, and right to left in an hbox. Using these functions allows us
|
||
to right justify or left justify our widgets and may be mixed in any
|
||
way to achieve the desired effect. We will use gtk_box_pack_start() in
|
||
most of our examples. An object may be another container or a
|
||
widget. In fact, many widgets are actually containers themselves,
|
||
including the button, but we usually only use a label inside a button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>By using these calls, GTK knows where you want to place your widgets
|
||
so it can do automatic resizing and other nifty things. There are also
|
||
a number of options as to how your widgets should be packed. As you
|
||
can imagine, this method gives us a quite a bit of flexibility when
|
||
placing and creating widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DetailsOfBoxes">
|
||
<title>Details of Boxes</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Because of this flexibility, packing boxes in GTK can be confusing at
|
||
first. There are a lot of options, and it's not immediately obvious how
|
||
they all fit together. In the end, however, there are basically five
|
||
different styles.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/packbox1.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Each line contains one horizontal box (hbox) with several buttons. The
|
||
call to gtk_box_pack is shorthand for the call to pack each of the
|
||
buttons into the hbox. Each of the buttons is packed into the hbox the
|
||
same way (i.e., same arguments to the gtk_box_pack_start() function).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is the declaration of the gtk_box_pack_start() function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_box_pack_start( GtkBox *box,
|
||
GtkWidget *child,
|
||
gboolean expand,
|
||
gboolean fill,
|
||
guint padding );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the box you are packing the object into, the
|
||
second is the object. The objects will all be buttons for now, so
|
||
we'll be packing buttons into boxes.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The expand argument to gtk_box_pack_start() and gtk_box_pack_end()
|
||
controls whether the widgets are laid out in the box to fill in all
|
||
the extra space in the box so the box is expanded to fill the area
|
||
allotted to it (TRUE); or the box is shrunk to just fit the widgets
|
||
(FALSE). Setting expand to FALSE will allow you to do right and left
|
||
justification of your widgets. Otherwise, they will all expand to fit
|
||
into the box, and the same effect could be achieved by using only one
|
||
of gtk_box_pack_start() or gtk_box_pack_end().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The fill argument to the gtk_box_pack functions control whether the
|
||
extra space is allocated to the objects themselves (TRUE), or as extra
|
||
padding in the box around these objects (FALSE). It only has an effect
|
||
if the expand argument is also TRUE.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When creating a new box, the function looks like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hbox_new ( gboolean homogeneous,
|
||
gint spacing );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The homogeneous argument to gtk_hbox_new() (and the same for
|
||
gtk_vbox_new()) controls whether each object in the box has the same
|
||
size (i.e., the same width in an hbox, or the same height in a
|
||
vbox). If it is set, the gtk_box_pack() routines function essentially
|
||
as if the <literal>expand</literal> argument was always turned on.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>What's the difference between spacing (set when the box is created)
|
||
and padding (set when elements are packed)? Spacing is added between
|
||
objects, and padding is added on either side of an object. The
|
||
following figure should make it clearer:</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/packbox2.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is the code used to create the above images. I've commented it
|
||
fairly heavily so I hope you won't have any problems following
|
||
it. Compile it yourself and play with it.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-PackingDemonstrationProgram">
|
||
<title>Packing Demonstration Program</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* example-start packbox packbox.c */
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include "gtk/gtk.h"
|
||
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Make a new hbox filled with button-labels. Arguments for the
|
||
* variables we're interested are passed in to this function.
|
||
* We do not show the box, but do show everything inside. */
|
||
static GtkWidget *make_box( gboolean homogeneous,
|
||
gint spacing,
|
||
gboolean expand,
|
||
gboolean fill,
|
||
guint padding )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *box;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
char padstr[80];
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new hbox with the appropriate homogeneous
|
||
* and spacing settings */
|
||
box = gtk_hbox_new (homogeneous, spacing);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a series of buttons with the appropriate settings */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("gtk_box_pack");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("(box,");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("button,");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a button with the label depending on the value of
|
||
* expand. */
|
||
if (expand == TRUE)
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("TRUE,");
|
||
else
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("FALSE,");
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* This is the same as the button creation for "expand"
|
||
* above, but uses the shorthand form. */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label (fill ? "TRUE," : "FALSE,");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
sprintf (padstr, "%d);", padding);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label (padstr);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, expand, fill, padding);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
return box;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *box1;
|
||
GtkWidget *box2;
|
||
GtkWidget *separator;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *quitbox;
|
||
int which;
|
||
|
||
/* Our init, don't forget this! :) */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
if (argc != 2) {
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "usage: packbox num, where num is 1, 2, or 3.\n");
|
||
/* This just does cleanup in GTK and exits with an exit status of 1. */
|
||
exit (1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
which = atoi (argv[1]);
|
||
|
||
/* Create our window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
/* You should always remember to connect the delete_event signal
|
||
* to the main window. This is very important for proper intuitive
|
||
* behavior */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* We create a vertical box (vbox) to pack the horizontal boxes into.
|
||
* This allows us to stack the horizontal boxes filled with buttons one
|
||
* on top of the other in this vbox. */
|
||
box1 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* which example to show. These correspond to the pictures above. */
|
||
switch (which) {
|
||
case 1:
|
||
/* create a new label. */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);");
|
||
|
||
/* Align the label to the left side. We'll discuss this function and
|
||
* others in the section on Widget Attributes. */
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Pack the label into the vertical box (vbox box1). Remember that
|
||
* widgets added to a vbox will be packed one on top of the other in
|
||
* order. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Show the label */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Call our make box function - homogeneous = FALSE, spacing = 0,
|
||
* expand = FALSE, fill = FALSE, padding = 0 */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Call our make box function - homogeneous = FALSE, spacing = 0,
|
||
* expand = TRUE, fill = FALSE, padding = 0 */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, TRUE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Creates a separator, we'll learn more about these later,
|
||
* but they are quite simple. */
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
|
||
/* Pack the separator into the vbox. Remember each of these
|
||
* widgets is being packed into a vbox, so they'll be stacked
|
||
* vertically. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
/* Create another new label, and show it. */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("gtk_hbox_new (TRUE, 0);");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (TRUE, 0, TRUE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (TRUE, 0, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Another new separator. */
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
/* The last 3 arguments to gtk_box_pack_start are:
|
||
* expand, fill, padding. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 2:
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new label, remember box1 is a vbox as created
|
||
* near the beginning of main() */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 10, TRUE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 10, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
/* The last 3 arguments to gtk_box_pack_start are:
|
||
* expand, fill, padding. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, TRUE, FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* Args are: homogeneous, spacing, expand, fill, padding */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, TRUE, TRUE, 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
/* The last 3 arguments to gtk_box_pack_start are: expand, fill, padding. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 3:
|
||
|
||
/* This demonstrates the ability to use gtk_box_pack_end() to
|
||
* right justify widgets. First, we create a new box as before. */
|
||
box2 = make_box (FALSE, 0, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the label that will be put at the end. */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("end");
|
||
/* Pack it using gtk_box_pack_end(), so it is put on the right
|
||
* side of the hbox created in the make_box() call. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end (GTK_BOX (box2), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
/* Show the label. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Pack box2 into box1 (the vbox remember ? :) */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* A separator for the bottom. */
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
/* This explicitly sets the separator to 400 pixels wide by 5 pixels
|
||
* high. This is so the hbox we created will also be 400 pixels wide,
|
||
* and the "end" label will be separated from the other labels in the
|
||
* hbox. Otherwise, all the widgets in the hbox would be packed as
|
||
* close together as possible. */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (separator, 400, 5);
|
||
/* pack the separator into the vbox (box1) created near the start
|
||
* of main() */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create another new hbox.. remember we can use as many as we need! */
|
||
quitbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Our quit button. */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
|
||
/* Setup the signal to terminate the program when the button is clicked */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
window);
|
||
/* Pack the button into the quitbox.
|
||
* The last 3 arguments to gtk_box_pack_start are:
|
||
* expand, fill, padding. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (quitbox), button, TRUE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
/* pack the quitbox into the vbox (box1) */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), quitbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Pack the vbox (box1) which now contains all our widgets, into the
|
||
* main window. */
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), box1);
|
||
|
||
/* And show everything left */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (quitbox);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box1);
|
||
/* Showing the window last so everything pops up at once. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* And of course, our main function. */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
/* Control returns here when gtk_main_quit() is called, but not when
|
||
* exit() is used. */
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-PackingUsingTables">
|
||
<title>Packing Using Tables</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Let's take a look at another way of packing - Tables. These can be
|
||
extremely useful in certain situations.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Using tables, we create a grid that we can place widgets in. The
|
||
widgets may take up as many spaces as we specify.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first thing to look at, of course, is the gtk_table_new() function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_table_new( guint rows,
|
||
guint columns,
|
||
gboolean homogeneous );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the number of rows to make in the table, while
|
||
the second, obviously, is the number of columns.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The homogeneous argument has to do with how the table's boxes are
|
||
sized. If homogeneous is TRUE, the table boxes are resized to the size
|
||
of the largest widget in the table. If homogeneous is FALSE, the size
|
||
of a table boxes is dictated by the tallest widget in its same row,
|
||
and the widest widget in its column.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The rows and columns are laid out from 0 to n, where n was the number
|
||
specified in the call to gtk_table_new. So, if you specify rows = 2
|
||
and columns = 2, the layout would look something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
0 1 2
|
||
0+----------+----------+
|
||
| | |
|
||
1+----------+----------+
|
||
| | |
|
||
2+----------+----------+
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that the coordinate system starts in the upper left hand corner.
|
||
To place a widget into a box, use the following function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_attach( GtkTable *table,
|
||
GtkWidget *child,
|
||
guint left_attach,
|
||
guint right_attach,
|
||
guint top_attach,
|
||
guint bottom_attach,
|
||
GtkAttachOptions xoptions,
|
||
GtkAttachOptions yoptions,
|
||
guint xpadding,
|
||
guint ypadding );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument ("table") is the table you've created and the
|
||
second ("child") the widget you wish to place in the table.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The left and right attach arguments specify where to place the widget,
|
||
and how many boxes to use. If you want a button in the lower right
|
||
table entry of our 2x2 table, and want it to fill that entry <emphasis>only</emphasis>,
|
||
left_attach would be = 1, right_attach = 2, top_attach = 1,
|
||
bottom_attach = 2.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now, if you wanted a widget to take up the whole top row of our 2x2
|
||
table, you'd use left_attach = 0, right_attach = 2, top_attach = 0,
|
||
bottom_attach = 1.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The xoptions and yoptions are used to specify packing options and may
|
||
be bitwise OR'ed together to allow multiple options.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>These options are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<variablelist>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_FILL</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>If the table box is larger than the widget, and
|
||
<literal>GTK_FILL</literal> is specified, the widget will expand to use all the room
|
||
available.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_SHRINK</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>If the table widget was allocated less space
|
||
then was requested (usually by the user resizing the window), then the
|
||
widgets would normally just be pushed off the bottom of the window and
|
||
disappear. If <literal>GTK_SHRINK</literal> is specified, the widgets will shrink
|
||
with the table.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_EXPAND</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>This will cause the table to expand to use up
|
||
any remaining space in the window.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
</variablelist>
|
||
|
||
<para>Padding is just like in boxes, creating a clear area around the widget
|
||
specified in pixels.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_table_attach() has a <emphasis>lot</emphasis> of options.
|
||
So, there's a shortcut:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_attach_defaults( GtkTable *table,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
guint left_attach,
|
||
guint right_attach,
|
||
guint top_attach,
|
||
guint bottom_attach );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The X and Y options default to <literal>GTK_FILL | GTK_EXPAND</literal>,
|
||
and X and Y padding are set to 0. The rest of the arguments are identical to the
|
||
previous function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>We also have gtk_table_set_row_spacing() and
|
||
gtk_table_set_col_spacing(). These places spacing between the rows at
|
||
the specified row or column.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_set_row_spacing( GtkTable *table,
|
||
guint row,
|
||
guint spacing );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>and</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_set_col_spacing ( GtkTable *table,
|
||
guint column,
|
||
guint spacing );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that for columns, the space goes to the right of the column, and
|
||
for rows, the space goes below the row.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can also set a consistent spacing of all rows and/or columns with:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_set_row_spacings( GtkTable *table,
|
||
guint spacing );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And,</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_table_set_col_spacings( GtkTable *table,
|
||
guint spacing );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that with these calls, the last row and last column do not get
|
||
any spacing.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TablePackingExamples">
|
||
<title>Table Packing Example</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here we make a window with three buttons in a 2x2 table.
|
||
The first two buttons will be placed in the upper row.
|
||
A third, quit button, is placed in the lower row, spanning both columns.
|
||
Which means it should look something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/table.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's the source code:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start table table.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Our callback.
|
||
* The data passed to this function is printed to stdout */
|
||
static void callback( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Hello again - %s was pressed\n", (char *) data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This callback quits the program */
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *table;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the window title */
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Table");
|
||
|
||
/* Set a handler for delete_event that immediately
|
||
* exits GTK. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 20);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a 2x2 table */
|
||
table = gtk_table_new (2, 2, TRUE);
|
||
|
||
/* Put the table in the main window */
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), table);
|
||
|
||
/* Create first button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("button 1");
|
||
|
||
/* When the button is clicked, we call the "callback" function
|
||
* with a pointer to "button 1" as its argument */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback), (gpointer) "button 1");
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Insert button 1 into the upper left quadrant of the table */
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 0, 1, 0, 1);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* Create second button */
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("button 2");
|
||
|
||
/* When the button is clicked, we call the "callback" function
|
||
* with a pointer to "button 2" as its argument */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback), (gpointer) "button 2");
|
||
/* Insert button 2 into the upper right quadrant of the table */
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 1, 2, 0, 1);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* Create "Quit" button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
|
||
/* When the button is clicked, we call the "delete-event" function
|
||
* and the program exits */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Insert the quit button into the both
|
||
* lower quadrants of the table */
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 0, 2, 1, 2);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (table);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-WidgetOverview">
|
||
<title>Widget Overview</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The general steps to creating a widget in GTK are:</para>
|
||
<orderedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> gtk_*_new() - one of various functions to create a new widget.
|
||
These are all detailed in this section.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Connect all signals and events we wish to use to the
|
||
appropriate handlers.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Set the attributes of the widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Pack the widget into a container using the appropriate call
|
||
such as gtk_container_add() or gtk_box_pack_start().</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> gtk_widget_show() the widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</orderedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_widget_show() lets GTK know that we are done setting the
|
||
attributes of the widget, and it is ready to be displayed. You may
|
||
also use gtk_widget_hide to make it disappear again. The order in
|
||
which you show the widgets is not important, but I suggest showing the
|
||
window last so the whole window pops up at once rather than seeing the
|
||
individual widgets come up on the screen as they're formed. The
|
||
children of a widget (a window is a widget too) will not be displayed
|
||
until the window itself is shown using the gtk_widget_show() function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Casting">
|
||
<title>Casting</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>You'll notice as you go on that GTK uses a type casting system. This
|
||
is always done using macros that both test the ability to cast the
|
||
given item, and perform the cast. Some common ones you will see are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
G_OBJECT (object)
|
||
GTK_WIDGET (widget)
|
||
GTK_OBJECT (object)
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (function)
|
||
GTK_CONTAINER (container)
|
||
GTK_WINDOW (window)
|
||
GTK_BOX (box)
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These are all used to cast arguments in functions. You'll see them in the
|
||
examples, and can usually tell when to use them simply by looking at the
|
||
function's declaration.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can see below in the class hierarchy, all GtkWidgets are
|
||
derived from the GObject base class. This means you can use a widget
|
||
in any place the function asks for an object. Note that many functions
|
||
accept a gpointer so there is no need to cast the type.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>For example:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect( button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback_function), callback_data);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This casts the button into an object, and provides a cast for the
|
||
function pointer to the callback.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Many widgets are also containers. If you look in the class hierarchy
|
||
below, you'll notice that many widgets derive from the Container
|
||
class. Any one of these widgets may be used with the
|
||
<literal>GTK_CONTAINER</literal> macro to pass them to functions that ask for
|
||
containers.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Unfortunately, these macros are not extensively covered in the
|
||
tutorial, but I recommend taking a look through the GTK header
|
||
files or the GTK API reference manual. It can be very educational. In fact,
|
||
it's not difficult to learn how a widget works just by looking at the
|
||
function declarations.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-WidgetHierarchy">
|
||
<title>Widget Hierarchy</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>For your reference, here is the class hierarchy tree used to implement
|
||
widgets. (Deprecated widgets and auxiliary classes have been omitted.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GObject
|
||
|
|
||
GtkObject
|
||
+GtkWidget
|
||
| +GtkMisc
|
||
| | +GtkLabel
|
||
| | | `GtkAccelLabel
|
||
| | +GtkArrow
|
||
| | `GtkImage
|
||
| +GtkContainer
|
||
| | +GtkBin
|
||
| | | +GtkAlignment
|
||
| | | +GtkFrame
|
||
| | | | `GtkAspectFrame
|
||
| | | +GtkButton
|
||
| | | | +GtkToggleButton
|
||
| | | | | `GtkCheckButton
|
||
| | | | | `GtkRadioButton
|
||
| | | | `GtkOptionMenu
|
||
| | | +GtkItem
|
||
| | | | +GtkMenuItem
|
||
| | | | +GtkCheckMenuItem
|
||
| | | | | `GtkRadioMenuItem
|
||
| | | | +GtkImageMenuItem
|
||
| | | | +GtkSeparatorMenuItem
|
||
| | | | `GtkTearoffMenuItem
|
||
| | | +GtkWindow
|
||
| | | | +GtkDialog
|
||
| | | | | +GtkColorSelectionDialog
|
||
| | | | | +GtkFileSelection
|
||
| | | | | +GtkFontSelectionDialog
|
||
| | | | | +GtkInputDialog
|
||
| | | | | `GtkMessageDialog
|
||
| | | | `GtkPlug
|
||
| | | +GtkEventBox
|
||
| | | +GtkHandleBox
|
||
| | | +GtkScrolledWindow
|
||
| | | `GtkViewport
|
||
| | +GtkBox
|
||
| | | +GtkButtonBox
|
||
| | | | +GtkHButtonBox
|
||
| | | | `GtkVButtonBox
|
||
| | | +GtkVBox
|
||
| | | | +GtkColorSelection
|
||
| | | | `GtkFontSelection
|
||
| | | `GtkHBox
|
||
| | | +GtkCombo
|
||
| | | `GtkStatusbar
|
||
| | +GtkFixed
|
||
| | +GtkPaned
|
||
| | | +GtkHPaned
|
||
| | | `GtkVPaned
|
||
| | +GtkLayout
|
||
| | +GtkMenuShell
|
||
| | | +GtkMenuBar
|
||
| | | `GtkMenu
|
||
| | +GtkNotebook
|
||
| | +GtkSocket
|
||
| | +GtkTable
|
||
| | +GtkTextView
|
||
| | +GtkToolbar
|
||
| | `GtkTreeView
|
||
| +GtkCalendar
|
||
| +GtkDrawingArea
|
||
| +GtkEditable
|
||
| | +GtkEntry
|
||
| | `GtkSpinButton
|
||
| +GtkRuler
|
||
| | +GtkHRuler
|
||
| | `GtkVRuler
|
||
| +GtkRange
|
||
| | +GtkScale
|
||
| | | +GtkHScale
|
||
| | | `GtkVScale
|
||
| | `GtkScrollbar
|
||
| | +GtkHScrollbar
|
||
| | `GtkVScrollbar
|
||
| +GtkSeparator
|
||
| | +GtkHSeparator
|
||
| | `GtkVSeparator
|
||
| +GtkInvisible
|
||
| +GtkPreview
|
||
| `GtkProgressBar
|
||
+GtkAdjustment
|
||
+GtkCellRenderer
|
||
| +GtkCellRendererPixbuf
|
||
| +GtkCellRendererText
|
||
| +GtkCellRendererToggle
|
||
+GtkItemFactory
|
||
+GtkTooltips
|
||
`GtkTreeViewColumn
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-WidgetsWithoutWindows">
|
||
<title>Widgets Without Windows</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following widgets do not have an associated window. If you want to
|
||
capture events, you'll have to use the EventBox. See the section on
|
||
the <link linkend="sec-EventBox">EventBox</link> widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAlignment
|
||
GtkArrow
|
||
GtkBin
|
||
GtkBox
|
||
GtkButton
|
||
GtkCheckButton
|
||
GtkFixed
|
||
GtkImage
|
||
GtkLabel
|
||
GtkMenuItem
|
||
GtkNotebook
|
||
GtkPaned
|
||
GtkRadioButton
|
||
GtkRange
|
||
GtkScrolledWindow
|
||
GtkSeparator
|
||
GtkTable
|
||
GtkToolbar
|
||
GtkAspectFrame
|
||
GtkFrame
|
||
GtkVBox
|
||
GtkHBox
|
||
GtkVSeparator
|
||
GtkHSeparator
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>We'll further our exploration of GTK by examining each widget in turn,
|
||
creating a few simple functions to display them. Another good source
|
||
is the <literal>testgtk</literal> program that comes with GTK. It can be found in
|
||
<filename>tests/testgtk.c</filename>.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-ButtonWidget">
|
||
<title>The Button Widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-NormalButtons">
|
||
<title>Normal Buttons</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>We've almost seen all there is to see of the button widget. It's
|
||
pretty simple. There is however more than one way to create a button. You can
|
||
use the gtk_button_new_with_label() or gtk_button_new_with_mnemonic() to create
|
||
a button with a label, use gtk_button_new_from_stock() to create a button
|
||
containing the image and text from a stock item or use gtk_button_new() to
|
||
create a blank button. It's then up to you to pack a label or pixmap into
|
||
this new button. To do this, create a new box, and then pack your objects into
|
||
this box using the usual gtk_box_pack_start(), and then use gtk_container_add()
|
||
to pack the box into the button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's an example of using gtk_button_new() to create a button with a
|
||
image and a label in it. I've broken up the code to create a box from the rest
|
||
so you can use it in your programs. There are further examples of using images
|
||
later in the tutorial.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/buttons.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start buttons buttons.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new hbox with an image and a label packed into it
|
||
* and return the box. */
|
||
|
||
static GtkWidget *xpm_label_box( gchar *xpm_filename,
|
||
gchar *label_text )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *box;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *image;
|
||
|
||
/* Create box for image and label */
|
||
box = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box), 2);
|
||
|
||
/* Now on to the image stuff */
|
||
image = gtk_image_new_from_file (xpm_filename);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a label for the button */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new (label_text);
|
||
|
||
/* Pack the image and label into the box */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), image, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), label, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (image);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
return box;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Our usual callback function */
|
||
static void callback( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Hello again - %s was pressed\n", (char *) data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *box;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Pixmap'd Buttons!");
|
||
|
||
/* It's a good idea to do this for all windows. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new ();
|
||
|
||
/* Connect the "clicked" signal of the button to our callback */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (callback), (gpointer) "cool button");
|
||
|
||
/* This calls our box creating function */
|
||
box = xpm_label_box ("info.xpm", "cool button");
|
||
|
||
/* Pack and show all our widgets */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (button), box);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Rest in gtk_main and wait for the fun to begin! */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The xpm_label_box() function could be used to pack images and labels into
|
||
any widget that can be a container.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Button widget has the following signals:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>pressed</literal> - emitted when pointer button is pressed within
|
||
Button widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>released</literal> - emitted when pointer button is released within
|
||
Button widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>clicked</literal> - emitted when pointer button is pressed and then
|
||
released within Button widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>enter</literal> - emitted when pointer enters Button widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>leave</literal> - emitted when pointer leaves Button widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ToggleButtons">
|
||
<title>Toggle Buttons</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Toggle buttons are derived from normal buttons and are very similar,
|
||
except they will always be in one of two states, alternated by a
|
||
click. They may be depressed, and when you click again, they will pop
|
||
back up. Click again, and they will pop back down.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Toggle buttons are the basis for check buttons and radio buttons, as
|
||
such, many of the calls used for toggle buttons are inherited by radio
|
||
and check buttons. I will point these out when we come to them.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a new toggle button:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toggle_button_new( void );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toggle_button_new_with_label( const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toggle_button_new_with_mnemonic( const gchar *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can imagine, these work identically to the normal button widget
|
||
calls. The first creates a blank toggle button, and the last two, a
|
||
button with a label widget already packed into it. The _mnemonic() variant
|
||
additionally parses the label for '_'-prefixed mnemonic characters.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To retrieve the state of the toggle widget, including radio and check
|
||
buttons, we use a construct as shown in our example below. This tests
|
||
the state of the toggle button, by accessing the <literal>active</literal> field of the
|
||
toggle widget's structure, after first using the
|
||
<literal>GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON</literal> macro to cast the widget pointer into a toggle
|
||
widget pointer. The signal of interest to us emitted by toggle
|
||
buttons (the toggle button, check button, and radio button widgets) is
|
||
the "toggled" signal. To check the state of these buttons, set up a
|
||
signal handler to catch the toggled signal, and access the structure
|
||
to determine its state. The callback will look something like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void toggle_button_callback (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
if (gtk_toggle_button_get_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If control reaches here, the toggle button is down */
|
||
|
||
} else {
|
||
|
||
/* If control reaches here, the toggle button is up */
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To force the state of a toggle button, and its children, the radio and
|
||
check buttons, use this function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_toggle_button_set_active( GtkToggleButton *toggle_button,
|
||
gboolean is_active );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The above call can be used to set the state of the toggle button, and
|
||
its children the radio and check buttons. Passing in your created
|
||
button as the first argument, and a TRUE or FALSE for the second state
|
||
argument to specify whether it should be down (depressed) or up
|
||
(released). Default is up, or FALSE.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that when you use the gtk_toggle_button_set_active() function, and
|
||
the state is actually changed, it causes the "clicked" and "toggled"
|
||
signals to be emitted from the button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gboolean gtk_toggle_button_get_active (GtkToggleButton *toggle_button);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This returns the current state of the toggle button as a boolean
|
||
TRUE/FALSE value.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-CheckButtons">
|
||
<title>Check Buttons</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Check buttons inherit many properties and functions from the the
|
||
toggle buttons above, but look a little different. Rather than being
|
||
buttons with text inside them, they are small squares with the text to
|
||
the right of them. These are often used for toggling options on and
|
||
off in applications.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The creation functions are similar to those of the normal button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_check_button_new( void );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_check_button_new_with_label ( const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_check_button_new_with_mnemonic ( const gchar *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The gtk_check_button_new_with_label() function creates a check button
|
||
with a label beside it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Checking the state of the check button is identical to that of the
|
||
toggle button.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-RadioButtons">
|
||
<title>Radio Buttons</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Radio buttons are similar to check buttons except they are grouped so
|
||
that only one may be selected/depressed at a time. This is good for
|
||
places in your application where you need to select from a short list
|
||
of options.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a new radio button is done with one of these calls:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_radio_button_new( GSList *group );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_radio_button_new_from_widget( GtkRadioButton *group );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_radio_button_new_with_label( GSList *group,
|
||
const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_radio_button_new_with_label_from_widget( GtkRadioButton *group,
|
||
const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_radio_button_new_with_mnemonic( GSList *group,
|
||
const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_radio_button_new_with_mnemonic_from_widget( GtkRadioButton *group,
|
||
const gchar *label );
|
||
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You'll notice the extra argument to these calls. They require a group
|
||
to perform their duty properly. The first call to gtk_radio_button_new() or
|
||
gtk_radio_button_new_with_label() should pass NULL as the first argument.
|
||
Then create a group using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GSList *gtk_radio_button_get_group( GtkRadioButton *radio_button );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The important thing to remember is that gtk_radio_button_get_group() must be
|
||
called for each new button added to the group, with the previous button passed
|
||
in as an argument. The result is then passed into the next call to
|
||
gtk_radio_button_new() or gtk_radio_button_new_with_label(). This allows a
|
||
chain of buttons to be established. The example below should make this clear.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can shorten this slightly by using the following syntax, which
|
||
removes the need for a variable to hold the list of buttons:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
button2 = gtk_radio_button_new_with_label(
|
||
gtk_radio_button_get_group (GTK_RADIO_BUTTON (button1)),
|
||
"button2");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
The _from_widget() variants of the creation functions allow you to shorten this
|
||
further, by omitting the gtk_radio_button_get_group() call. This form is used
|
||
in the example to create the third button:
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
button2 = gtk_radio_button_new_with_label_from_widget(
|
||
GTK_RADIO_BUTTON (button1),
|
||
"button2");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>It is also a good idea to explicitly set which button should be the
|
||
default depressed button with:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_toggle_button_set_active( GtkToggleButton *toggle_button,
|
||
gboolean state );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is described in the section on toggle buttons, and works in
|
||
exactly the same way. Once the radio buttons are grouped together,
|
||
only one of the group may be active at a time. If the user clicks on
|
||
one radio button, and then on another, the first radio button will
|
||
first emit a "toggled" signal (to report becoming inactive), and then
|
||
the second will emit its "toggled" signal (to report becoming active).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following example creates a radio button group with three buttons.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/radiobuttons.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start radiobuttons radiobuttons.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <glib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static gboolean close_application( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window = NULL;
|
||
GtkWidget *box1;
|
||
GtkWidget *box2;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *separator;
|
||
GSList *group;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (close_application),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "radio buttons");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 0);
|
||
|
||
box1 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), box1);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box1);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_radio_button_new_with_label (NULL, "button1");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
group = gtk_radio_button_get_group (GTK_RADIO_BUTTON (button));
|
||
button = gtk_radio_button_new_with_label (group, "button2");
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (button), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_radio_button_new_with_label_from_widget (GTK_RADIO_BUTTON (button),
|
||
"button3");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("close");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (close_application),
|
||
window);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Adjustments">
|
||
<title>Adjustments</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK has various widgets that can be visually adjusted by the user
|
||
using the mouse or the keyboard, such as the range widgets, described
|
||
in the <link linkend="ch-RangeWidgets">Range Widgets</link>
|
||
section. There are also a few widgets that display some adjustable
|
||
portion of a larger area of data, such as the text widget and the
|
||
viewport widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Obviously, an application needs to be able to react to changes the
|
||
user makes in range widgets. One way to do this would be to have each
|
||
widget emit its own type of signal when its adjustment changes, and
|
||
either pass the new value to the signal handler, or require it to look
|
||
inside the widget's data structure in order to ascertain the value.
|
||
But you may also want to connect the adjustments of several widgets
|
||
together, so that adjusting one adjusts the others. The most obvious
|
||
example of this is connecting a scrollbar to a panning viewport or a
|
||
scrolling text area. If each widget has its own way of setting or
|
||
getting the adjustment value, then the programmer may have to write
|
||
their own signal handlers to translate between the output of one
|
||
widget's signal and the "input" of another's adjustment setting
|
||
function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK solves this problem using the Adjustment object, which is not a
|
||
widget but a way for widgets to store and pass adjustment information
|
||
in an abstract and flexible form. The most obvious use of Adjustment
|
||
is to store the configuration parameters and values of range widgets,
|
||
such as scrollbars and scale controls. However, since Adjustments are
|
||
derived from Object, they have some special powers beyond those of
|
||
normal data structures. Most importantly, they can emit signals, just
|
||
like widgets, and these signals can be used not only to allow your
|
||
program to react to user input on adjustable widgets, but also to
|
||
propagate adjustment values transparently between adjustable widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You will see how adjustments fit in when you see the other widgets
|
||
that incorporate them:
|
||
<link linkend="sec-ProgressBars">Progress Bars</link>,
|
||
<link linkend="sec-Viewports">Viewports</link>,
|
||
<link linkend="sec-ScrolledWindows">Scrolled Windows</link>, and others.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-CreatingAnAdjustment">
|
||
<title>Creating an Adjustment</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Many of the widgets which use adjustment objects do so automatically,
|
||
but some cases will be shown in later examples where you may need to
|
||
create one yourself. You create an adjustment using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkObject *gtk_adjustment_new( gdouble value,
|
||
gdouble lower,
|
||
gdouble upper,
|
||
gdouble step_increment,
|
||
gdouble page_increment,
|
||
gdouble page_size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>value</literal> argument is the initial value you want to give to the
|
||
adjustment, usually corresponding to the topmost or leftmost position
|
||
of an adjustable widget. The <literal>lower</literal> argument specifies the lowest
|
||
value which the adjustment can hold. The <literal>step_increment</literal> argument
|
||
specifies the "smaller" of the two increments by which the user can
|
||
change the value, while the <literal>page_increment</literal> is the "larger" one.
|
||
The <literal>page_size</literal> argument usually corresponds somehow to the visible
|
||
area of a panning widget. The <literal>upper</literal> argument is used to represent
|
||
the bottom most or right most coordinate in a panning widget's
|
||
child. Therefore it is <emphasis>not</emphasis> always the largest number that
|
||
<literal>value</literal> can take, since the <literal>page_size</literal> of such widgets is
|
||
usually non-zero.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-UsingAdjustments">
|
||
<title>Using Adjustments the Easy Way</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The adjustable widgets can be roughly divided into those which use and
|
||
require specific units for these values and those which treat them as
|
||
arbitrary numbers. The group which treats the values as arbitrary
|
||
numbers includes the range widgets (scrollbars and scales, the
|
||
progress bar widget, and the spin button widget). These widgets are
|
||
all the widgets which are typically "adjusted" directly by the user
|
||
with the mouse or keyboard. They will treat the <literal>lower</literal> and
|
||
<literal>upper</literal> values of an adjustment as a range within which the user
|
||
can manipulate the adjustment's <literal>value</literal>. By default, they will only
|
||
modify the <literal>value</literal> of an adjustment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The other group includes the text widget, the viewport widget, the
|
||
compound list widget, and the scrolled window widget. All of these
|
||
widgets use pixel values for their adjustments. These are also all
|
||
widgets which are typically "adjusted" indirectly using scrollbars.
|
||
While all widgets which use adjustments can either create their own
|
||
adjustments or use ones you supply, you'll generally want to let this
|
||
particular category of widgets create its own adjustments. Usually,
|
||
they will eventually override all the values except the <literal>value</literal>
|
||
itself in whatever adjustments you give them, but the results are, in
|
||
general, undefined (meaning, you'll have to read the source code to
|
||
find out, and it may be different from widget to widget).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now, you're probably thinking, since text widgets and viewports insist
|
||
on setting everything except the <literal>value</literal> of their adjustments,
|
||
while scrollbars will <emphasis>only</emphasis> touch the adjustment's
|
||
<literal>value</literal>, if you <emphasis>share</emphasis> an adjustment
|
||
object between a scrollbar and a text widget, manipulating the scrollbar will
|
||
automagically adjust the viewport widget? Of course it will! Just like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* creates its own adjustments */
|
||
viewport = gtk_viewport_new (NULL, NULL);
|
||
/* uses the newly-created adjustment for the scrollbar as well */
|
||
vscrollbar = gtk_vscrollbar_new (gtk_viewport_get_vadjustment (viewport));
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-AdjustmentInternals">
|
||
<title>Adjustment Internals</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Ok, you say, that's nice, but what if I want to create my own handlers
|
||
to respond when the user adjusts a range widget or a spin button, and
|
||
how do I get at the value of the adjustment in these handlers? To
|
||
answer these questions and more, let's start by taking a look at
|
||
<literal>struct _GtkAdjustment</literal> itself:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkAdjustment
|
||
{
|
||
GtkObject parent_instance;
|
||
|
||
gdouble lower;
|
||
gdouble upper;
|
||
gdouble value;
|
||
gdouble step_increment;
|
||
gdouble page_increment;
|
||
gdouble page_size;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you don't like to poke directly at struct internals like a
|
||
<emphasis>real</emphasis> C programmer, you can use the following accessor to
|
||
inspect the <literal>value</literal> of an adjustment:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gdouble gtk_adjustment_get_value( GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Since, when you set the <literal>value</literal> of an Adjustment, you generally
|
||
want the change to be reflected by every widget that uses this
|
||
adjustment, GTK provides this convenience function to do this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_adjustment_set_value( GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gdouble value );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As mentioned earlier, Adjustment is a subclass of Object just
|
||
like all the various widgets, and thus it is able to emit signals.
|
||
This is, of course, why updates happen automagically when you share an
|
||
adjustment object between a scrollbar and another adjustable widget;
|
||
all adjustable widgets connect signal handlers to their adjustment's
|
||
<literal>value_changed</literal> signal, as can your program. Here's the definition
|
||
of this signal in <literal>struct _GtkAdjustmentClass</literal>:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void (* value_changed) (GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The various widgets that use the Adjustment object will emit this
|
||
signal on an adjustment whenever they change its value. This happens
|
||
both when user input causes the slider to move on a range widget, as
|
||
well as when the program explicitly changes the value with
|
||
gtk_adjustment_set_value(). So, for example, if you have a scale
|
||
widget, and you want to change the rotation of a picture whenever its
|
||
value changes, you would create a callback like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void cb_rotate_picture (GtkAdjustment *adj, GtkWidget *picture)
|
||
{
|
||
set_picture_rotation (picture, gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj));
|
||
...
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>and connect it to the scale widget's adjustment like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect (adj, "value_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_rotate_picture), picture);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>What about when a widget reconfigures the <literal>upper</literal> or <literal>lower</literal>
|
||
fields of its adjustment, such as when a user adds more text to a text
|
||
widget? In this case, it emits the <literal>changed</literal> signal, which looks
|
||
like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void (* changed) (GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Range widgets typically connect a handler to this signal, which
|
||
changes their appearance to reflect the change - for example, the size
|
||
of the slider in a scrollbar will grow or shrink in inverse proportion
|
||
to the difference between the <literal>lower</literal> and <literal>upper</literal> values of its
|
||
adjustment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You probably won't ever need to attach a handler to this signal,
|
||
unless you're writing a new type of range widget. However, if you
|
||
change any of the values in a Adjustment directly, you should emit
|
||
this signal on it to reconfigure whatever widgets are using it, like
|
||
this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (adjustment, "changed");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now go forth and adjust!</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-RangeWidgets">
|
||
<title>Range Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The category of range widgets includes the ubiquitous scrollbar widget
|
||
and the less common scale widget. Though these two types of widgets
|
||
are generally used for different purposes, they are quite similar in
|
||
function and implementation. All range widgets share a set of common
|
||
graphic elements, each of which has its own X window and receives
|
||
events. They all contain a "trough" and a "slider" (what is sometimes
|
||
called a "thumbwheel" in other GUI environments). Dragging the slider
|
||
with the pointer moves it back and forth within the trough, while
|
||
clicking in the trough advances the slider towards the location of the
|
||
click, either completely, or by a designated amount, depending on
|
||
which mouse button is used.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As mentioned in <link linkend="ch-Adjustments">Adjustments</link> above,
|
||
all range widgets are associated with an adjustment object, from which
|
||
they calculate the length of the slider and its position within the
|
||
trough. When the user manipulates the slider, the range widget will
|
||
change the value of the adjustment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ScrollbarWidgets">
|
||
<title>Scrollbar Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>These are your standard, run-of-the-mill scrollbars. These should be
|
||
used only for scrolling some other widget, such as a list, a text box,
|
||
or a viewport (and it's generally easier to use the scrolled window
|
||
widget in most cases). For other purposes, you should use scale
|
||
widgets, as they are friendlier and more featureful.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are separate types for horizontal and vertical scrollbars.
|
||
There really isn't much to say about these. You create them with the
|
||
following functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hscrollbar_new( GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vscrollbar_new( GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>and that's about it (if you don't believe me, look in the header
|
||
files!). The <literal>adjustment</literal> argument can either be a pointer to an
|
||
existing Adjustment, or NULL, in which case one will be created for
|
||
you. Specifying NULL might actually be useful in this case, if you
|
||
wish to pass the newly-created adjustment to the constructor function
|
||
of some other widget which will configure it for you, such as a text
|
||
widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ScaleWidgets">
|
||
<title>Scale Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Scale widgets are used to allow the user to visually select and
|
||
manipulate a value within a specific range. You might want to use a
|
||
scale widget, for example, to adjust the magnification level on a
|
||
zoomed preview of a picture, or to control the brightness of a color,
|
||
or to specify the number of minutes of inactivity before a screensaver
|
||
takes over the screen.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Creating a Scale Widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>As with scrollbars, there are separate widget types for horizontal and
|
||
vertical scale widgets. (Most programmers seem to favour horizontal
|
||
scale widgets.) Since they work essentially the same way, there's no
|
||
need to treat them separately here. The following functions create vertical and
|
||
horizontal scale widgets, respectively:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vscale_new( GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vscale_new_with_range( gdouble min,
|
||
gdouble max,
|
||
gdouble step );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hscale_new( GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hscale_new_with_range( gdouble min,
|
||
gdouble max,
|
||
gdouble step );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>adjustment</literal> argument can either be an adjustment which has
|
||
already been created with gtk_adjustment_new(), or NULL, in
|
||
which case, an anonymous Adjustment is created with all of its
|
||
values set to <literal>0.0</literal> (which isn't very useful in this case).
|
||
In order to avoid confusing yourself, you probably want to create your
|
||
adjustment with a <literal>page_size</literal> of <literal>0.0</literal> so
|
||
that its <literal>upper</literal> value actually corresponds to the highest
|
||
value the user can select. The _new_with_range()<29>variants take care of creating
|
||
a suitable adjustment. (If you're <emphasis>already</emphasis> thoroughly
|
||
confused, read the section on <link linkend="ch-Adjustments">Adjustments</link>
|
||
again for an explanation of what exactly adjustments do and how to create and
|
||
manipulate them.)</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Functions and Signals (well, functions, at least)</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Scale widgets can display their current value as a number beside the
|
||
trough. The default behaviour is to show the value, but you can change
|
||
this with this function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_scale_set_draw_value( GtkScale *scale,
|
||
gboolean draw_value );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you might have guessed, <literal>draw_value</literal> is either <literal>TRUE</literal> or
|
||
<literal>FALSE</literal>, with predictable consequences for either one.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The value displayed by a scale widget is rounded to one decimal point
|
||
by default, as is the <literal>value</literal> field in its Adjustment. You can
|
||
change this with:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_scale_set_digits( GtkScale *scale,
|
||
gint digits );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>where <literal>digits</literal> is the number of decimal places you want. You can
|
||
set <literal>digits</literal> to anything you like, but no more than 13 decimal
|
||
places will actually be drawn on screen.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Finally, the value can be drawn in different positions
|
||
relative to the trough:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_scale_set_value_pos( GtkScale *scale,
|
||
GtkPositionType pos );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The argument <literal>pos</literal> is of type <literal>GtkPositionType</literal>,
|
||
which can take one of the following values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_POS_LEFT
|
||
GTK_POS_RIGHT
|
||
GTK_POS_TOP
|
||
GTK_POS_BOTTOM
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you position the value on the "side" of the trough (e.g., on the
|
||
top or bottom of a horizontal scale widget), then it will follow the
|
||
slider up and down the trough.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>All the preceding functions are defined in
|
||
<literal><gtk/gtkscale.h></literal>. The header files for all GTK widgets
|
||
are automatically included when you include
|
||
<literal><gtk/gtk.h></literal>. But you should look over the header files
|
||
of all widgets that interest you, in order to learn more about their functions
|
||
and features.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-CommonRangeFunctions">
|
||
<title>Common Range Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Range widget class is fairly complicated internally, but, like
|
||
all the "base class" widgets, most of its complexity is only
|
||
interesting if you want to hack on it. Also, almost all of the
|
||
functions and signals it defines are only really used in writing
|
||
derived widgets. There are, however, a few useful functions that are
|
||
defined in <literal><gtk/gtkrange.h></literal> and will work on all range
|
||
widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Setting the Update Policy</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The "update policy" of a range widget defines at what points during
|
||
user interaction it will change the <literal>value</literal> field of its
|
||
Adjustment and emit the "value_changed" signal on this
|
||
Adjustment. The update policies, defined in
|
||
<literal><gtk/gtkenums.h></literal> as type <literal>enum GtkUpdateType</literal>,
|
||
are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<variablelist>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>This is the default. The
|
||
"value_changed" signal is emitted continuously, i.e., whenever the
|
||
slider is moved by even the tiniest amount.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_UPDATE_DISCONTINUOUS</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>The "value_changed" signal is
|
||
only emitted once the slider has stopped moving and the user has
|
||
released the mouse button.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>The "value_changed" signal is emitted
|
||
when the user releases the mouse button, or if the slider stops moving
|
||
for a short period of time.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
</variablelist>
|
||
|
||
<para>The update policy of a range widget can be set by casting it using the
|
||
<literal>GTK_RANGE(widget)</literal> macro and passing it to this function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_range_set_update_policy( GtkRange *range,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Getting and Setting Adjustments</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Getting and setting the adjustment for a range widget "on the fly" is
|
||
done, predictably, with:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAdjustment* gtk_range_get_adjustment( GtkRange *range );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_range_set_adjustment( GtkRange *range,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>gtk_range_get_adjustment()</literal> returns a pointer to the adjustment to
|
||
which <literal>range</literal> is connected.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>gtk_range_set_adjustment()</literal> does absolutely nothing if you pass it
|
||
the adjustment that <literal>range</literal> is already using, regardless of whether
|
||
you changed any of its fields or not. If you pass it a new
|
||
Adjustment, it will unreference the old one if it exists (possibly
|
||
destroying it), connect the appropriate signals to the new one, and
|
||
call the private function <literal>gtk_range_adjustment_changed()</literal>, which
|
||
will (or at least, is supposed to...) recalculate the size and/or
|
||
position of the slider and redraw if necessary. As mentioned in the
|
||
section on adjustments, if you wish to reuse the same Adjustment,
|
||
when you modify its values directly, you should emit the "changed"
|
||
signal on it, like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (adjustment, "changed");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-KeyAndMouseBindings">
|
||
<title>Key and Mouse bindings</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>All of the GTK range widgets react to mouse clicks in more or less
|
||
the same way. Clicking button-1 in the trough will cause its
|
||
adjustment's <literal>page_increment</literal> to be added or subtracted from its
|
||
<literal>value</literal>, and the slider to be moved accordingly. Clicking mouse
|
||
button-2 in the trough will jump the slider to the point at which the
|
||
button was clicked. Clicking button-3 in the trough of a range or any button on
|
||
a scrollbar's arrows will cause its adjustment's value to change by
|
||
<literal>step_increment</literal> at a time.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Scrollbars are not focusable, thus have no key bindings. The key bindings
|
||
for the other range widgets (which are, of course, only active when the widget
|
||
has focus) are do <emphasis>not</emphasis> differentiate between horizontal and
|
||
vertical range widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>All range widgets can be operated with the left, right, up and down arrow
|
||
keys, as well as with the <literal>Page Up</literal> and <literal>Page Down</literal>
|
||
keys. The arrows move the slider up and down by <literal>step_increment</literal>, while
|
||
<literal>Page Up</literal> and <literal>Page Down</literal> move it by
|
||
<literal>page_increment</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The user can also move the slider all the way to one end or the other
|
||
of the trough using the keyboard. This is done with the <literal>Home</literal>
|
||
and <literal>End</literal> keys.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-RangeWidgetsExample">
|
||
<title>Example</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>This example is a somewhat modified version of the "range controls"
|
||
test from <filename>testgtk.c</filename>. It basically puts up a window with three
|
||
range widgets all connected to the same adjustment, and a couple of
|
||
controls for adjusting some of the parameters mentioned above and in
|
||
the section on adjustments, so you can see how they affect the way
|
||
these widgets work for the user.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/rangewidgets.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start rangewidgets rangewidgets.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *hscale, *vscale;
|
||
|
||
static void cb_pos_menu_select( GtkWidget *item,
|
||
GtkPositionType pos )
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set the value position on both scale widgets */
|
||
gtk_scale_set_value_pos (GTK_SCALE (hscale), pos);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_value_pos (GTK_SCALE (vscale), pos);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void cb_update_menu_select( GtkWidget *item,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy )
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set the update policy for both scale widgets */
|
||
gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (hscale), policy);
|
||
gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (vscale), policy);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void cb_digits_scale( GtkAdjustment *adj )
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set the number of decimal places to which adj->value is rounded */
|
||
gtk_scale_set_digits (GTK_SCALE (hscale), (gint) adj->value);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_digits (GTK_SCALE (vscale), (gint) adj->value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void cb_page_size( GtkAdjustment *get,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *set )
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set the page size and page increment size of the sample
|
||
* adjustment to the value specified by the "Page Size" scale */
|
||
set->page_size = get->value;
|
||
set->page_increment = get->value;
|
||
|
||
/* This sets the adjustment and makes it emit the "changed" signal to
|
||
reconfigure all the widgets that are attached to this signal. */
|
||
gtk_adjustment_set_value (set, CLAMP (set->value,
|
||
set->lower,
|
||
(set->upper - set->page_size)));
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name(set, "changed");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void cb_draw_value( GtkToggleButton *button )
|
||
{
|
||
/* Turn the value display on the scale widgets off or on depending
|
||
* on the state of the checkbutton */
|
||
gtk_scale_set_draw_value (GTK_SCALE (hscale), button->active);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_draw_value (GTK_SCALE (vscale), button->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convenience functions */
|
||
|
||
static GtkWidget *make_menu_item ( gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback callback,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *item;
|
||
|
||
item = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (name);
|
||
g_signal_connect (item, "activate",
|
||
callback, (gpointer) data);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (item);
|
||
|
||
return item;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void scale_set_default_values( GtkScale *scale )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (scale),
|
||
GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_digits (scale, 1);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_value_pos (scale, GTK_POS_TOP);
|
||
gtk_scale_set_draw_value (scale, TRUE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* makes the sample window */
|
||
|
||
static void create_range_controls( void )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *box1, *box2, *box3;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *scrollbar;
|
||
GtkWidget *separator;
|
||
GtkWidget *opt, *menu, *item;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *scale;
|
||
GtkObject *adj1, *adj2;
|
||
|
||
/* Standard window-creating stuff */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "range controls");
|
||
|
||
box1 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), box1);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box1);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* value, lower, upper, step_increment, page_increment, page_size */
|
||
/* Note that the page_size value only makes a difference for
|
||
* scrollbar widgets, and the highest value you'll get is actually
|
||
* (upper - page_size). */
|
||
adj1 = gtk_adjustment_new (0.0, 0.0, 101.0, 0.1, 1.0, 1.0);
|
||
|
||
vscale = gtk_vscale_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (adj1));
|
||
scale_set_default_values (GTK_SCALE (vscale));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), vscale, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vscale);
|
||
|
||
box3 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), box3, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box3);
|
||
|
||
/* Reuse the same adjustment */
|
||
hscale = gtk_hscale_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (adj1));
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (hscale), 200, -1);
|
||
scale_set_default_values (GTK_SCALE (hscale));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box3), hscale, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (hscale);
|
||
|
||
/* Reuse the same adjustment again */
|
||
scrollbar = gtk_hscrollbar_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (adj1));
|
||
/* Notice how this causes the scales to always be updated
|
||
* continuously when the scrollbar is moved */
|
||
gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (scrollbar),
|
||
GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box3), scrollbar, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (scrollbar);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
/* A checkbutton to control whether the value is displayed or not */
|
||
button = gtk_check_button_new_with_label("Display value on scale widgets");
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (button), TRUE);
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_draw_value), NULL);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* An option menu to change the position of the value */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Scale Value Position:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
opt = gtk_option_menu_new ();
|
||
menu = gtk_menu_new ();
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Top",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_pos_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_POS_TOP));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Bottom", G_CALLBACK (cb_pos_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_POS_BOTTOM));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Left", G_CALLBACK (cb_pos_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_POS_LEFT));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Right", G_CALLBACK (cb_pos_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_POS_RIGHT));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
gtk_option_menu_set_menu (GTK_OPTION_MENU (opt), menu);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), opt, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (opt);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Yet another option menu, this time for the update policy of the
|
||
* scale widgets */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Scale Update Policy:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
opt = gtk_option_menu_new ();
|
||
menu = gtk_menu_new ();
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Continuous",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_update_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Discontinuous",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_update_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_UPDATE_DISCONTINUOUS));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
item = make_menu_item ("Delayed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_update_menu_select),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED));
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), item);
|
||
|
||
gtk_option_menu_set_menu (GTK_OPTION_MENU (opt), menu);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), opt, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (opt);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* An HScale widget for adjusting the number of digits on the
|
||
* sample scales. */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Scale Digits:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
adj2 = gtk_adjustment_new (1.0, 0.0, 5.0, 1.0, 1.0, 0.0);
|
||
g_signal_connect (adj2, "value_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_digits_scale), NULL);
|
||
scale = gtk_hscale_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (adj2));
|
||
gtk_scale_set_digits (GTK_SCALE (scale), 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), scale, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (scale);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* And, one last HScale widget for adjusting the page size of the
|
||
* scrollbar. */
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Scrollbar Page Size:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), label, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
adj2 = gtk_adjustment_new (1.0, 1.0, 101.0, 1.0, 1.0, 0.0);
|
||
g_signal_connect (adj2, "value_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (cb_page_size), (gpointer) adj1);
|
||
scale = gtk_hscale_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (adj2));
|
||
gtk_scale_set_digits (GTK_SCALE (scale), 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), scale, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (scale);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
box2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 10);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box2), 10);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box1), box2, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box2);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box2), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
create_range_controls ();
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You will notice that the program does not call g_signal_connect()
|
||
for the "delete-event", but only for the "destroy" signal. This will
|
||
still perform the desired function, because an unhandled
|
||
"delete-event" will result in a "destroy" signal being given to the
|
||
window.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-MiscWidgets">
|
||
<title>Miscellaneous Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Labels">
|
||
<title>Labels</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Labels are used a lot in GTK, and are relatively simple. Labels emit
|
||
no signals as they do not have an associated X window. If you need to
|
||
catch signals, or do clipping, place it inside a <link linkend="sec-EventBox">
|
||
EventBox</link> widget or a Button widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new label, use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_label_new( const char *str );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_label_new_with_mnemonic( const char *str );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The sole argument is the string you wish the label to display.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To change the label's text after creation, use the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_label_set_text( GtkLabel *label,
|
||
const char *str );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the label you created previously (cast
|
||
using the <literal>GTK_LABEL()</literal> macro), and the second is the new string.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The space needed for the new string will be automatically adjusted if
|
||
needed. You can produce multi-line labels by putting line breaks in
|
||
the label string.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To retrieve the current string, use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
const gchar* gtk_label_get_text( GtkLabel *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Do not free the returned string, as it is used internally by GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The label text can be justified using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_label_set_justify( GtkLabel *label,
|
||
GtkJustification jtype );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Values for <literal>jtype</literal> are:</para>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_JUSTIFY_LEFT
|
||
GTK_JUSTIFY_RIGHT
|
||
GTK_JUSTIFY_CENTER (the default)
|
||
GTK_JUSTIFY_FILL
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The label widget is also capable of line wrapping the text
|
||
automatically. This can be activated using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_label_set_line_wrap (GtkLabel *label,
|
||
gboolean wrap);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>wrap</literal> argument takes a TRUE or FALSE value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you want your label underlined, then you can set a pattern on the
|
||
label:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_label_set_pattern (GtkLabel *label,
|
||
const gchar *pattern);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The pattern argument indicates how the underlining should look. It
|
||
consists of a string of underscore and space characters. An underscore
|
||
indicates that the corresponding character in the label should be
|
||
underlined. For example, the string <literal>"__ __"</literal> would underline the
|
||
first two characters and eight and ninth characters.</para>
|
||
|
||
<note><para>If you simply want to have an underlined accelerator ("mnemonic")
|
||
in your label, you should use gtk_label_new_with_mnemonic() or
|
||
gtk_label_set_text_with_mnemonic(), not gtk_label_set_pattern().</para>
|
||
</note>
|
||
|
||
<para>Below is a short example to illustrate these functions. This example
|
||
makes use of the Frame widget to better demonstrate the label
|
||
styles. You can ignore this for now as the <link linkend="sec-Frames">Frame</link>
|
||
widget is explained later on.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In GTK+ 2.0, label texts can contain markup for font and other text attribute
|
||
changes, and labels may be selectable (for copy-and-paste). These advanced features
|
||
won't be explained here.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/label.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start label label.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkWidget *window = NULL;
|
||
GtkWidget *hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialise GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Label");
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), hbox);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 5);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Normal Label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is a Normal label");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Multi-line Label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is a Multi-line label.\nSecond line\n" \
|
||
"Third line");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Left Justified Label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is a Left-Justified\n" \
|
||
"Multi-line label.\nThird line");
|
||
gtk_label_set_justify (GTK_LABEL (label), GTK_JUSTIFY_LEFT);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Right Justified Label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is a Right-Justified\nMulti-line label.\n" \
|
||
"Fourth line, (j/k)");
|
||
gtk_label_set_justify (GTK_LABEL (label), GTK_JUSTIFY_RIGHT);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Line wrapped label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is an example of a line-wrapped label. It " \
|
||
"should not be taking up the entire " /* big space to test spacing */\
|
||
"width allocated to it, but automatically " \
|
||
"wraps the words to fit. " \
|
||
"The time has come, for all good men, to come to " \
|
||
"the aid of their party. " \
|
||
"The sixth sheik's six sheep's sick.\n" \
|
||
" It supports multiple paragraphs correctly, " \
|
||
"and correctly adds "\
|
||
"many extra spaces. ");
|
||
gtk_label_set_line_wrap (GTK_LABEL (label), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Filled, wrapped label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This is an example of a line-wrapped, filled label. " \
|
||
"It should be taking "\
|
||
"up the entire width allocated to it. " \
|
||
"Here is a sentence to prove "\
|
||
"my point. Here is another sentence. "\
|
||
"Here comes the sun, do de do de do.\n"\
|
||
" This is a new paragraph.\n"\
|
||
" This is another newer, longer, better " \
|
||
"paragraph. It is coming to an end, "\
|
||
"unfortunately.");
|
||
gtk_label_set_justify (GTK_LABEL (label), GTK_JUSTIFY_FILL);
|
||
gtk_label_set_line_wrap (GTK_LABEL (label), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Underlined label");
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("This label is underlined!\n"
|
||
"This one is underlined in quite a funky fashion");
|
||
gtk_label_set_justify (GTK_LABEL (label), GTK_JUSTIFY_LEFT);
|
||
gtk_label_set_pattern (GTK_LABEL (label),
|
||
"_________________________ _ _________ _ ______ __ _______ ___");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Arrows">
|
||
<title>Arrows</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Arrow widget draws an arrowhead, facing in a number of possible
|
||
directions and having a number of possible styles. It can be very
|
||
useful when placed on a button in many applications. Like the Label
|
||
widget, it emits no signals.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are only two functions for manipulating an Arrow widget:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_arrow_new( GtkArrowType arrow_type,
|
||
GtkShadowType shadow_type );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_arrow_set( GtkArrow *arrow,
|
||
GtkArrowType arrow_type,
|
||
GtkShadowType shadow_type );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first creates a new arrow widget with the indicated type and
|
||
appearance. The second allows these values to be altered
|
||
retrospectively. The <literal>arrow_type</literal> argument may take one of the
|
||
following values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_ARROW_UP
|
||
GTK_ARROW_DOWN
|
||
GTK_ARROW_LEFT
|
||
GTK_ARROW_RIGHT
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These values obviously indicate the direction in which the arrow will
|
||
point. The <literal>shadow_type</literal> argument may take one of these values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_IN
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT (the default)
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_IN
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_OUT
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's a brief example to illustrate their use.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/arrow.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start arrow arrow.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Create an Arrow widget with the specified parameters
|
||
* and pack it into a button */
|
||
static GtkWidget *create_arrow_button( GtkArrowType arrow_type,
|
||
GtkShadowType shadow_type )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *arrow;
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new ();
|
||
arrow = gtk_arrow_new (arrow_type, shadow_type);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (button), arrow);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (arrow);
|
||
|
||
return button;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *box;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize the toolkit */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Arrow Buttons");
|
||
|
||
/* It's a good idea to do this for all windows. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a box to hold the arrows/buttons */
|
||
box = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (box), 2);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), box);
|
||
|
||
/* Pack and show all our widgets */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (box);
|
||
|
||
button = create_arrow_button (GTK_ARROW_UP, GTK_SHADOW_IN);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
|
||
button = create_arrow_button (GTK_ARROW_DOWN, GTK_SHADOW_OUT);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
|
||
button = create_arrow_button (GTK_ARROW_LEFT, GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_IN);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
|
||
button = create_arrow_button (GTK_ARROW_RIGHT, GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_OUT);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (box), button, FALSE, FALSE, 3);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Rest in gtk_main and wait for the fun to begin! */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheTooltipsObject">
|
||
<title>The Tooltips Object</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>These are the little text strings that pop up when you leave your
|
||
pointer over a button or other widget for a few seconds. They are easy
|
||
to use, so I will just explain them without giving an example. If you
|
||
want to see some code, take a look at the <filename>testgtk.c</filename> program
|
||
distributed with GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Widgets that do not receive events (widgets that do not have their
|
||
own window) will not work with tooltips.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first call you will use creates a new tooltip. You only need to do
|
||
this once for a set of tooltips as the <literal>GtkTooltips</literal> object this
|
||
function returns can be used to create multiple tooltips.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkTooltips *gtk_tooltips_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once you have created a new tooltip, and the widget you wish to use it
|
||
on, simply use this call to set it:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_tooltips_set_tip( GtkTooltips *tooltips,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
const gchar *tip_text,
|
||
const gchar *tip_private );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the tooltip you've already created, followed by
|
||
the widget you wish to have this tooltip pop up for, and the text you
|
||
wish it to say. The last argument is a text string that can be used as
|
||
an identifier when using GtkTipsQuery to implement context sensitive
|
||
help. For now, you can set it to NULL.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- TODO: sort out what how to do the context sensitive help -->
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's a short example:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkTooltips *tooltips;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
tooltips = gtk_tooltips_new ();
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("button 1");
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
gtk_tooltips_set_tip (tooltips, button, "This is button 1", NULL);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are other calls that can be used with tooltips. I will just list
|
||
them with a brief description of what they do.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_tooltips_enable( GtkTooltips *tooltips );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Enable a disabled set of tooltips.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_tooltips_disable( GtkTooltips *tooltips );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Disable an enabled set of tooltips.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>And that's all the functions associated with tooltips. More than
|
||
you'll ever want to know :-)</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ProgressBars">
|
||
<title>Progress Bars</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Progress bars are used to show the status of an operation. They are
|
||
pretty easy to use, as you will see with the code below. But first
|
||
lets start out with the calls to create a new progress bar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_progress_bar_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now that the progress bar has been created we can use it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_progress_bar_set_fraction ( GtkProgressBar *pbar,
|
||
gdouble fraction );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the progress bar you wish to operate on, and the
|
||
second argument is the amount "completed", meaning the amount the
|
||
progress bar has been filled from 0-100%. This is passed to the
|
||
function as a real number ranging from 0 to 1.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK v1.2 has added new functionality to the progress bar that enables
|
||
it to display its value in different ways, and to inform the user of
|
||
its current value and its range.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A progress bar may be set to one of a number of orientations using the
|
||
function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_progress_bar_set_orientation( GtkProgressBar *pbar,
|
||
GtkProgressBarOrientation orientation );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>orientation</literal> argument may take one of the following
|
||
values to indicate the direction in which the progress bar moves:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_LEFT_TO_RIGHT
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_RIGHT_TO_LEFT
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_BOTTOM_TO_TOP
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_TOP_TO_BOTTOM
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As well as indicating the amount of progress that has occured, the
|
||
progress bar may be set to just indicate that there is some activity.
|
||
This can be useful in situations where progress cannot be measured against
|
||
a value range. The following function indicates that some progress has been
|
||
made.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_progress_bar_pulse ( GtkProgressBar *progress );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The step size of the activity indicator is set using the following
|
||
function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_progress_bar_set_pulse_step( GtkProgressBar *pbar,
|
||
gdouble fraction );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>When not in activity mode, the progress bar can also display a
|
||
configurable text string within its trough, using the following
|
||
function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_progress_bar_set_text( GtkProgressBar *progress,
|
||
const gchar *text );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<note><para>Note that gtk_progress_set_text() doesn't support the printf()-like formatting
|
||
of the GTK+ 1.2 Progressbar.</para></note>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can turn off the display of the string by calling gtk_progess_bar_set_text()
|
||
again with NULL as second argument.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The current text setting of a progressbar can be retrieved with the
|
||
following function. Do not free the returned string.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
const gchar *gtk_progress_bar_get_text( GtkProgressBar *pbar );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Progress Bars are usually used with timeouts or other such functions
|
||
(see section on <link linkend="ch-Timeouts">Timeouts, I/O and Idle Functions</link>)
|
||
to give the illusion of multitasking. All will employ the
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_fraction() or gtk_progress_bar_pulse() functions in the
|
||
same manner.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is an example of the progress bar, updated using timeouts. This
|
||
code also shows you how to reset the Progress Bar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/progressbar.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start progressbar progressbar.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
typedef struct _ProgressData {
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *pbar;
|
||
int timer;
|
||
gboolean activity_mode;
|
||
} ProgressData;
|
||
|
||
/* Update the value of the progress bar so that we get
|
||
* some movement */
|
||
static gboolean progress_timeout( gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
ProgressData *pdata = (ProgressData *)data;
|
||
gdouble new_val;
|
||
|
||
if (pdata->activity_mode)
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_pulse (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Calculate the value of the progress bar using the
|
||
* value range set in the adjustment object */
|
||
|
||
new_val = gtk_progress_bar_get_fraction (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar)) + 0.01;
|
||
|
||
if (new_val > 1.0)
|
||
new_val = 0.0;
|
||
|
||
/* Set the new value */
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_fraction (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar), new_val);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* As this is a timeout function, return TRUE so that it
|
||
* continues to get called */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Callback that toggles the text display within the progress bar trough */
|
||
static void toggle_show_text( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
ProgressData *pdata )
|
||
{
|
||
const gchar *text;
|
||
|
||
text = gtk_progress_bar_get_text (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar));
|
||
if (text && *text)
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_text (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar), "");
|
||
else
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_text (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar), "some text");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Callback that toggles the activity mode of the progress bar */
|
||
static void toggle_activity_mode( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
ProgressData *pdata )
|
||
{
|
||
pdata->activity_mode = !pdata->activity_mode;
|
||
if (pdata->activity_mode)
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_pulse (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar));
|
||
else
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_fraction (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar), 0.0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Callback that toggles the orientation of the progress bar */
|
||
static void toggle_orientation( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
ProgressData *pdata )
|
||
{
|
||
switch (gtk_progress_bar_get_orientation (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar))) {
|
||
case GTK_PROGRESS_LEFT_TO_RIGHT:
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_orientation (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar),
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_RIGHT_TO_LEFT);
|
||
break;
|
||
case GTK_PROGRESS_RIGHT_TO_LEFT:
|
||
gtk_progress_bar_set_orientation (GTK_PROGRESS_BAR (pdata->pbar),
|
||
GTK_PROGRESS_LEFT_TO_RIGHT);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:;
|
||
/* do nothing */
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Clean up allocated memory and remove the timer */
|
||
static void destroy_progress( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
ProgressData *pdata)
|
||
{
|
||
g_source_remove (pdata->timer);
|
||
pdata->timer = 0;
|
||
pdata->window = NULL;
|
||
g_free (pdata);
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
ProgressData *pdata;
|
||
GtkWidget *align;
|
||
GtkWidget *separator;
|
||
GtkWidget *table;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *check;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate memory for the data that is passed to the callbacks */
|
||
pdata = g_malloc (sizeof (ProgressData));
|
||
|
||
pdata->window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_resizable (GTK_WINDOW (pdata->window), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (pdata->window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy_progress),
|
||
(gpointer) pdata);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (pdata->window), "GtkProgressBar");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (pdata->window), 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), 10);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (pdata->window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a centering alignment object */
|
||
align = gtk_alignment_new (0.5, 0.5, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), align, FALSE, FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (align);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the GtkProgressBar */
|
||
pdata->pbar = gtk_progress_bar_new ();
|
||
pdata->activity_mode = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (align), pdata->pbar);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (pdata->pbar);
|
||
|
||
/* Add a timer callback to update the value of the progress bar */
|
||
pdata->timer = g_timeout_add (100, progress_timeout, pdata);
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_hseparator_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), separator, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (separator);
|
||
|
||
/* rows, columns, homogeneous */
|
||
table = gtk_table_new (2, 3, FALSE);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), table, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (table);
|
||
|
||
/* Add a check button to select displaying of the trough text */
|
||
check = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Show text");
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), check, 0, 1, 0, 1,
|
||
GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL, GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL,
|
||
5, 5);
|
||
g_signal_connect (check, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (toggle_show_text),
|
||
pdata);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (check);
|
||
|
||
/* Add a check button to toggle activity mode */
|
||
check = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Activity mode");
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), check, 0, 1, 1, 2,
|
||
GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL, GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL,
|
||
5, 5);
|
||
g_signal_connect (check, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (toggle_activity_mode),
|
||
pdata);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (check);
|
||
|
||
/* Add a check button to toggle orientation */
|
||
check = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Right to Left");
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), check, 0, 1, 2, 3,
|
||
GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL, GTK_EXPAND | GTK_FILL,
|
||
5, 5);
|
||
g_signal_connect (check, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (toggle_orientation),
|
||
pdata);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (check);
|
||
|
||
/* Add a button to exit the program */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("close");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
pdata->window);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* This makes it so the button is the default. */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
|
||
/* This grabs this button to be the default button. Simply hitting
|
||
* the "Enter" key will cause this button to activate. */
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (pdata->window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Dialogs">
|
||
<title>Dialogs</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Dialog widget is very simple, and is actually just a window with a
|
||
few things pre-packed into it for you. The structure for a Dialog is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct GtkDialog
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWindow window;
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *action_area;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>So you see, it simply creates a window, and then packs a vbox into the
|
||
top, which contains a separator and then an hbox called the
|
||
"action_area".</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Dialog widget can be used for pop-up messages to the user, and
|
||
other similar tasks. There are two functions to create a new Dialog.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_dialog_new( void );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_dialog_new_with_buttons( const gchar *title,
|
||
GtkWindow *parent,
|
||
GtkDialogFlags flags,
|
||
const gchar *first_button_text,
|
||
... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first function will create an empty dialog, and it is now up to you to use
|
||
it. You could pack a button in the action_area by doing something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
button = ...
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (GTK_DIALOG (window)->action_area),
|
||
button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And you could add to the vbox area by packing, for instance, a label
|
||
in it, try something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Dialogs are groovy");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (GTK_DIALOG (window)->vbox),
|
||
label, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As an example in using the dialog box, you could put two buttons in
|
||
the action_area, a Cancel button and an Ok button, and a label in the
|
||
vbox area, asking the user a question or giving an error etc. Then
|
||
you could attach a different signal to each of the buttons and perform
|
||
the operation the user selects.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If the simple functionality provided by the default vertical and
|
||
horizontal boxes in the two areas doesn't give you enough control for
|
||
your application, then you can simply pack another layout widget into
|
||
the boxes provided. For example, you could pack a table into the
|
||
vertical box.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The more complicated _new_with_buttons() variant allows to set one or
|
||
more of the following flags.</para>
|
||
|
||
<variablelist>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_DIALOG_MODAL</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>make the dialog modal.
|
||
</para></listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_DIALOG_DESTROY_WITH_PARENT</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>ensures that the dialog window is destroyed together with the specified
|
||
parent.</para></listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_DIALOG_NO_SEPARATOR</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>omits the separator between the vbox and the action_area.
|
||
</para></listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
</variablelist>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Rulers">
|
||
<title>Rulers</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Ruler widgets are used to indicate the location of the mouse pointer
|
||
in a given window. A window can have a vertical ruler spanning across
|
||
the height and a horizontal ruler spanning down the width. A small
|
||
triangular indicator on the ruler shows the exact location of the
|
||
pointer relative to the ruler.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A ruler must first be created. Horizontal and vertical rulers are
|
||
created using</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hruler_new( void ); /* horizontal ruler */
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vruler_new( void ); /* vertical ruler */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once a ruler is created, we can define the unit of measurement. Units
|
||
of measure for rulers can be <literal>GTK_PIXELS</literal>, <literal>GTK_INCHES</literal> or
|
||
<literal>GTK_CENTIMETERS</literal>. This is set using</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_ruler_set_metric( GtkRuler *ruler,
|
||
GtkMetricType metric );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The default measure is <literal>GTK_PIXELS</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_metric( GTK_RULER(ruler), GTK_PIXELS );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Other important characteristics of a ruler are how to mark the units
|
||
of scale and where the position indicator is initially placed. These
|
||
are set for a ruler using</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_ruler_set_range( GtkRuler *ruler,
|
||
gdouble lower,
|
||
gdouble upper,
|
||
gdouble position,
|
||
gdouble max_size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The lower and upper arguments define the extent of the ruler, and
|
||
max_size is the largest possible number that will be displayed.
|
||
Position defines the initial position of the pointer indicator within
|
||
the ruler.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A vertical ruler can span an 800 pixel wide window thus</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_range( GTK_RULER(vruler), 0, 800, 0, 800);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The markings displayed on the ruler will be from 0 to 800, with a
|
||
number for every 100 pixels. If instead we wanted the ruler to range
|
||
from 7 to 16, we would code</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_range( GTK_RULER(vruler), 7, 16, 0, 20);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The indicator on the ruler is a small triangular mark that indicates
|
||
the position of the pointer relative to the ruler. If the ruler is
|
||
used to follow the mouse pointer, the motion_notify_event signal
|
||
should be connected to the motion_notify_event method of the ruler.
|
||
To follow all mouse movements within a window area, we would use</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#define EVENT_METHOD(i, x) GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS(i)->x
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (area, "motion_notify_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (EVENT_METHOD (ruler, motion_notify_event)),
|
||
ruler);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following example creates a drawing area with a horizontal ruler
|
||
above it and a vertical ruler to the left of it. The size of the
|
||
drawing area is 600 pixels wide by 400 pixels high. The horizontal
|
||
ruler spans from 7 to 13 with a mark every 100 pixels, while the
|
||
vertical ruler spans from 0 to 400 with a mark every 100 pixels.
|
||
Placement of the drawing area and the rulers is done using a table.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/rulers.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start rulers rulers.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
#define EVENT_METHOD(i, x) GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS(i)->x
|
||
|
||
#define XSIZE 600
|
||
#define YSIZE 400
|
||
|
||
/* This routine gets control when the close button is clicked */
|
||
static gboolean close_application( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The main routine */
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] ) {
|
||
GtkWidget *window, *table, *area, *hrule, *vrule;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize GTK and create the main window */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (close_application), NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a table for placing the ruler and the drawing area */
|
||
table = gtk_table_new (3, 2, FALSE);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), table);
|
||
|
||
area = gtk_drawing_area_new ();
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (area), XSIZE, YSIZE);
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), area, 1, 2, 1, 2,
|
||
GTK_EXPAND|GTK_FILL, GTK_FILL, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (area, GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK |
|
||
GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
|
||
|
||
/* The horizontal ruler goes on top. As the mouse moves across the
|
||
* drawing area, a motion_notify_event is passed to the
|
||
* appropriate event handler for the ruler. */
|
||
hrule = gtk_hruler_new ();
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_metric (GTK_RULER (hrule), GTK_PIXELS);
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_range (GTK_RULER (hrule), 7, 13, 0, 20);
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (area, "motion_notify_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (EVENT_METHOD (hrule, motion_notify_event)),
|
||
hrule);
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), hrule, 1, 2, 0, 1,
|
||
GTK_EXPAND|GTK_SHRINK|GTK_FILL, GTK_FILL, 0, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* The vertical ruler goes on the left. As the mouse moves across
|
||
* the drawing area, a motion_notify_event is passed to the
|
||
* appropriate event handler for the ruler. */
|
||
vrule = gtk_vruler_new ();
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_metric (GTK_RULER (vrule), GTK_PIXELS);
|
||
gtk_ruler_set_range (GTK_RULER (vrule), 0, YSIZE, 10, YSIZE );
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (area, "motion_notify_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (EVENT_METHOD (vrule, motion_notify_event)),
|
||
vrule);
|
||
gtk_table_attach (GTK_TABLE (table), vrule, 0, 1, 1, 2,
|
||
GTK_FILL, GTK_EXPAND|GTK_SHRINK|GTK_FILL, 0, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Now show everything */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (area);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (hrule);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vrule);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (table);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Statusbars">
|
||
<title>Statusbars</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Statusbars are simple widgets used to display a text message. They
|
||
keep a stack of the messages pushed onto them, so that popping the
|
||
current message will re-display the previous text message.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In order to allow different parts of an application to use the same
|
||
statusbar to display messages, the statusbar widget issues Context
|
||
Identifiers which are used to identify different "users". The message
|
||
on top of the stack is the one displayed, no matter what context it is
|
||
in. Messages are stacked in last-in-first-out order, not context
|
||
identifier order.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A statusbar is created with a call to:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_statusbar_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>A new Context Identifier is requested using a call to the following
|
||
function with a short textual description of the context:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
guint gtk_statusbar_get_context_id( GtkStatusbar *statusbar,
|
||
const gchar *context_description );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are three functions that can operate on statusbars:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
guint gtk_statusbar_push( GtkStatusbar *statusbar,
|
||
guint context_id,
|
||
const gchar *text );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_statusbar_pop( GtkStatusbar *statusbar)
|
||
guint context_id );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_statusbar_remove( GtkStatusbar *statusbar,
|
||
guint context_id,
|
||
guint message_id );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first, gtk_statusbar_push(), is used to add a new message to the
|
||
statusbar. It returns a Message Identifier, which can be passed later
|
||
to the function gtk_statusbar_remove to remove the message with the
|
||
given Message and Context Identifiers from the statusbar's stack.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function gtk_statusbar_pop() removes the message highest in the
|
||
stack with the given Context Identifier.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In addition to messages, statusbars may also display a resize grip, which
|
||
can be dragged with the mouse to resize the toplevel window containing the statusbar,
|
||
similar to dragging the window frame. The following functions control the display
|
||
of the resize grip.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_statusbar_set_has_resize_grip( GtkStatusbar *statusbar,
|
||
gboolean setting );
|
||
|
||
gboolean gtk_statusbar_get_has_resize_grip( GtkStatusbar *statusbar );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following example creates a statusbar and two buttons, one for
|
||
pushing items onto the statusbar, and one for popping the last item
|
||
back off.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/statusbar.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start statusbar statusbar.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
#include <glib.h>
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *status_bar;
|
||
|
||
static void push_item( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
static int count = 1;
|
||
gchar *buff;
|
||
|
||
buff = g_strdup_printf ("Item %d", count++);
|
||
gtk_statusbar_push (GTK_STATUSBAR (status_bar), GPOINTER_TO_INT (data), buff);
|
||
g_free (buff);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void pop_item( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_statusbar_pop (GTK_STATUSBAR (status_bar), GPOINTER_TO_INT (data));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
gint context_id;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (window), 200, 100);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "GTK Statusbar Example");
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 1);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
status_bar = gtk_statusbar_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), status_bar, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (status_bar);
|
||
|
||
context_id = gtk_statusbar_get_context_id(
|
||
GTK_STATUSBAR (status_bar), "Statusbar example");
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("push item");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (push_item), GINT_TO_POINTER (context_id));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("pop last item");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (pop_item), GINT_TO_POINTER (context_id));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* always display the window as the last step so it all splashes on
|
||
* the screen at once. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TextEntries">
|
||
<title>Text Entries</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Entry widget allows text to be typed and displayed in a single line
|
||
text box. The text may be set with function calls that allow new text
|
||
to replace, prepend or append the current contents of the Entry widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Create a new Entry widget with the following function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_entry_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next function alters the text which is currently
|
||
within the Entry widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_entry_set_text( GtkEntry *entry,
|
||
const gchar *text );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function gtk_entry_set_text() sets the contents of the Entry widget,
|
||
replacing the current contents. Note that the class Entry implements the Editable
|
||
interface (yes, gobject supports Java-like interfaces) which contains some more
|
||
functions for manipulating the contents.
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The contents of the Entry can be retrieved by using a call to the
|
||
following function. This is useful in the callback functions described below.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
const gchar *gtk_entry_get_text( GtkEntry *entry );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The value returned by this function is used internally, and must not
|
||
be freed using either free() or g_free().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we don't want the contents of the Entry to be changed by someone typing
|
||
into it, we can change its editable state.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_editable_set_editable( GtkEditable *entry,
|
||
gboolean editable );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function above allows us to toggle the editable state of the
|
||
Entry widget by passing in a TRUE or FALSE value for the <literal>editable</literal>
|
||
argument.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we are using the Entry where we don't want the text entered to be
|
||
visible, for example when a password is being entered, we can use the
|
||
following function, which also takes a boolean flag.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_entry_set_visibility( GtkEntry *entry,
|
||
gboolean visible );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>A region of the text may be set as selected by using the following
|
||
function. This would most often be used after setting some default
|
||
text in an Entry, making it easy for the user to remove it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_editable_select_region( GtkEditable *entry,
|
||
gint start,
|
||
gint end );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we want to catch when the user has entered text, we can connect to
|
||
the <literal>activate</literal> or <literal>changed</literal> signal. Activate is raised when the
|
||
user hits the enter key within the Entry widget. Changed is raised
|
||
when the text changes at all, e.g., for every character entered or
|
||
removed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following code is an example of using an Entry widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/entry.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start entry entry.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static void enter_callback( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkWidget *entry )
|
||
{
|
||
const gchar *entry_text;
|
||
entry_text = gtk_entry_get_text (GTK_ENTRY (entry));
|
||
printf ("Entry contents: %s\n", entry_text);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void entry_toggle_editable( GtkWidget *checkbutton,
|
||
GtkWidget *entry )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_editable_set_editable (GTK_EDITABLE (entry),
|
||
GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (checkbutton)->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void entry_toggle_visibility( GtkWidget *checkbutton,
|
||
GtkWidget *entry )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_entry_set_visibility (GTK_ENTRY (entry),
|
||
GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (checkbutton)->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox, *hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *entry;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *check;
|
||
gint tmp_pos;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (window), 200, 100);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "GTK Entry");
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
entry = gtk_entry_new ();
|
||
gtk_entry_set_max_length (GTK_ENTRY (entry), 50);
|
||
g_signal_connect (entry, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (enter_callback),
|
||
entry);
|
||
gtk_entry_set_text (GTK_ENTRY (entry), "hello");
|
||
tmp_pos = GTK_ENTRY (entry)->text_length;
|
||
gtk_editable_insert_text (GTK_EDITABLE (entry), " world", -1, &tmp_pos);
|
||
gtk_editable_select_region (GTK_EDITABLE (entry),
|
||
0, GTK_ENTRY (entry)->text_length);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), entry, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (entry);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), hbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (hbox);
|
||
|
||
check = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Editable");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), check, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
g_signal_connect (check, "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (entry_toggle_editable), entry);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (check), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (check);
|
||
|
||
check = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Visible");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), check, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
g_signal_connect (check, "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (entry_toggle_visibility), entry);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (check), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (check);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_from_stock (GTK_STOCK_CLOSE);
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SpinButtons">
|
||
<title>Spin Buttons</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Spin Button widget is generally used to allow the user to select a
|
||
value from a range of numeric values. It consists of a text
|
||
entry box with up and down arrow buttons attached to the
|
||
side. Selecting one of the buttons causes the value to "spin" up and
|
||
down the range of possible values. The entry box may also be edited
|
||
directly to enter a specific value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Spin Button allows the value to have zero or a number of decimal
|
||
places and to be incremented/decremented in configurable steps. The
|
||
action of holding down one of the buttons optionally results in an
|
||
acceleration of change in the value according to how long it is
|
||
depressed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Spin Button uses an <link linkend="ch-Adjustments">Adjustment</link>
|
||
object to hold information about the range of values that the spin
|
||
button can take. This makes for a powerful Spin Button widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Recall that an adjustment widget is created with the following
|
||
function, which illustrates the information that it holds:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkObject *gtk_adjustment_new( gdouble value,
|
||
gdouble lower,
|
||
gdouble upper,
|
||
gdouble step_increment,
|
||
gdouble page_increment,
|
||
gdouble page_size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These attributes of an Adjustment are used by the Spin Button in the
|
||
following way:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>value</literal>: initial value for the Spin Button</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>lower</literal>: lower range value</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>upper</literal>: upper range value</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>step_increment</literal>: value to increment/decrement when pressing
|
||
mouse button 1 on a button</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>page_increment</literal>: value to increment/decrement when pressing
|
||
mouse button 2 on a button</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>page_size</literal>: unused</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>Additionally, mouse button 3 can be used to jump directly to the
|
||
<literal>upper</literal> or <literal>lower</literal> values when used to select one of the
|
||
buttons. Lets look at how to create a Spin Button:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_spin_button_new( GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gdouble climb_rate,
|
||
guint digits );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>climb_rate</literal> argument take a value between 0.0 and 1.0 and
|
||
indicates the amount of acceleration that the Spin Button has. The
|
||
<literal>digits</literal> argument specifies the number of decimal places to which
|
||
the value will be displayed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A Spin Button can be reconfigured after creation using the following
|
||
function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_configure( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gdouble climb_rate,
|
||
guint digits );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>spin_button</literal> argument specifies the Spin Button widget that is
|
||
to be reconfigured. The other arguments are as specified above.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The adjustment can be set and retrieved independantly using the
|
||
following two functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_adjustment( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
GtkAdjustment *gtk_spin_button_get_adjustment( GtkSpinButton *spin_button );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The number of decimal places can also be altered using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_digits( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
guint digits) ;
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The value that a Spin Button is currently displaying can be changed
|
||
using the following function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_value( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
gdouble value );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The current value of a Spin Button can be retrieved as either a
|
||
floating point or integer value with the following functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gdouble gtk_spin_button_get_value ( GtkSpinButton *spin_button );
|
||
|
||
gint gtk_spin_button_get_value_as_int( GtkSpinButton *spin_button );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you want to alter the value of a Spin Button relative to its current
|
||
value, then the following function can be used:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_spin( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
GtkSpinType direction,
|
||
gdouble increment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>direction</literal> parameter can take one of the following values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_SPIN_STEP_FORWARD
|
||
GTK_SPIN_STEP_BACKWARD
|
||
GTK_SPIN_PAGE_FORWARD
|
||
GTK_SPIN_PAGE_BACKWARD
|
||
GTK_SPIN_HOME
|
||
GTK_SPIN_END
|
||
GTK_SPIN_USER_DEFINED
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This function packs in quite a bit of functionality, which I will
|
||
attempt to clearly explain. Many of these settings use values from the
|
||
Adjustment object that is associated with a Spin Button.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_SPIN_STEP_FORWARD</literal> and <literal>GTK_SPIN_STEP_BACKWARD</literal> change the
|
||
value of the Spin Button by the amount specified by <literal>increment</literal>,
|
||
unless <literal>increment</literal> is equal to 0, in which case the value is
|
||
changed by the value of <literal>step_increment</literal> in theAdjustment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_SPIN_PAGE_FORWARD</literal> and <literal>GTK_SPIN_PAGE_BACKWARD</literal> simply
|
||
alter the value of the Spin Button by <literal>increment</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_SPIN_HOME</literal> sets the value of the Spin Button to the bottom of
|
||
the Adjustments range.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_SPIN_END</literal> sets the value of the Spin Button to the top of the
|
||
Adjustments range.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_SPIN_USER_DEFINED</literal> simply alters the value of the Spin Button
|
||
by the specified amount.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>We move away from functions for setting and retreving the range attributes
|
||
of the Spin Button now, and move onto functions that affect the
|
||
appearance and behaviour of the Spin Button widget itself.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first of these functions is used to constrain the text box of the
|
||
Spin Button such that it may only contain a numeric value. This
|
||
prevents a user from typing anything other than numeric values into
|
||
the text box of a Spin Button:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_numeric( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
gboolean numeric );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can set whether a Spin Button will wrap around between the upper
|
||
and lower range values with the following function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_wrap( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
gboolean wrap );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can set a Spin Button to round the value to the nearest
|
||
<literal>step_increment</literal>, which is set within the Adjustment object used
|
||
with the Spin Button. This is accomplished with the following
|
||
function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_snap_to_ticks( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
gboolean snap_to_ticks );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The update policy of a Spin Button can be changed with the following
|
||
function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_set_update_policy( GtkSpinButton *spin_button,
|
||
GtkSpinButtonUpdatePolicy policy );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The possible values of <literal>policy</literal> are either <literal>GTK_UPDATE_ALWAYS</literal> or
|
||
<literal>GTK_UPDATE_IF_VALID</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>These policies affect the behavior of a Spin Button when parsing
|
||
inserted text and syncing its value with the values of the
|
||
Adjustment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In the case of <literal>GTK_UPDATE_IF_VALID</literal> the Spin Button value only
|
||
gets changed if the text input is a numeric value that is within the
|
||
range specified by the Adjustment. Otherwise the text is reset to the
|
||
current value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In case of <literal>GTK_UPDATE_ALWAYS</literal> we ignore errors while converting
|
||
text into a numeric value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Finally, you can explicitly request that a Spin Button update itself:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_spin_button_update( GtkSpinButton *spin_button );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>It's example time again.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/spinbutton.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start spinbutton spinbutton.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static GtkWidget *spinner1;
|
||
|
||
static void toggle_snap( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSpinButton *spin )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_snap_to_ticks (spin, GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget)->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void toggle_numeric( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSpinButton *spin )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_numeric (spin, GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget)->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void change_digits( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSpinButton *spin )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_digits (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner1),
|
||
gtk_spin_button_get_value_as_int (spin));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void get_value( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gchar *buf;
|
||
GtkLabel *label;
|
||
GtkSpinButton *spin;
|
||
|
||
spin = GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner1);
|
||
label = GTK_LABEL (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), "user_data"));
|
||
if (GPOINTER_TO_INT (data) == 1)
|
||
buf = g_strdup_printf ("%d", gtk_spin_button_get_value_as_int (spin));
|
||
else
|
||
buf = g_strdup_printf ("%0.*f", spin->digits,
|
||
gtk_spin_button_get_value (spin));
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (label, buf);
|
||
g_free (buf);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *main_vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox2;
|
||
GtkWidget *spinner2;
|
||
GtkWidget *spinner;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *val_label;
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adj;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialise GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Spin Button");
|
||
|
||
main_vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (main_vbox), 10);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), main_vbox);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Not accelerated");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), frame, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), vbox);
|
||
|
||
/* Day, month, year spinners */
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), hbox, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Day :");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0.5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
adj = (GtkAdjustment *) gtk_adjustment_new (1.0, 1.0, 31.0, 1.0,
|
||
5.0, 0.0);
|
||
spinner = gtk_spin_button_new (adj, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_wrap (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), spinner, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Month :");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0.5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
adj = (GtkAdjustment *) gtk_adjustment_new (1.0, 1.0, 12.0, 1.0,
|
||
5.0, 0.0);
|
||
spinner = gtk_spin_button_new (adj, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_wrap (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), spinner, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Year :");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0.5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
adj = (GtkAdjustment *) gtk_adjustment_new (1998.0, 0.0, 2100.0,
|
||
1.0, 100.0, 0.0);
|
||
spinner = gtk_spin_button_new (adj, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_wrap (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner), FALSE);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (spinner, 55, -1);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), spinner, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Accelerated");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), frame, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), vbox);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Value :");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0.5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
adj = (GtkAdjustment *) gtk_adjustment_new (0.0, -10000.0, 10000.0,
|
||
0.5, 100.0, 0.0);
|
||
spinner1 = gtk_spin_button_new (adj, 1.0, 2);
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_wrap (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner1), TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (spinner1, 100, -1);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), spinner1, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Digits :");
|
||
gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (label), 0, 0.5);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
adj = (GtkAdjustment *) gtk_adjustment_new (2, 1, 5, 1, 1, 0);
|
||
spinner2 = gtk_spin_button_new (adj, 0.0, 0);
|
||
gtk_spin_button_set_wrap (GTK_SPIN_BUTTON (spinner2), TRUE);
|
||
g_signal_connect (adj, "value_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (change_digits),
|
||
spinner2);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), spinner2, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Snap to 0.5-ticks");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (toggle_snap),
|
||
spinner1);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (button), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Numeric only input mode");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (toggle_numeric),
|
||
spinner1);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (button), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
val_label = gtk_label_new ("");
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Value as Int");
|
||
g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (button), "user_data", val_label);
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (get_value),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (1));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Value as Float");
|
||
g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (button), "user_data", val_label);
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (get_value),
|
||
GINT_TO_POINTER (2));
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), val_label, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (val_label), "0");
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Close");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Enter the event loop */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ComboBox">
|
||
<title>Combo Box</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The combo box is another fairly simple widget that is really just a
|
||
collection of other widgets. From the user's point of view, the widget
|
||
consists of a text entry box and a pull down menu from which the user
|
||
can select one of a set of predefined entries. Alternatively, the user
|
||
can type a different option directly into the text box.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following extract from the structure that defines a Combo Box
|
||
identifies several of the components:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkCombo {
|
||
GtkHBox hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *entry;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *popup;
|
||
GtkWidget *popwin;
|
||
GtkWidget *list;
|
||
... };
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can see, the Combo Box has two principal parts that you really
|
||
care about: an entry and a list.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>First off, to create a combo box, use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_combo_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now, if you want to set the string in the entry section of the combo
|
||
box, this is done by manipulating the <literal>entry</literal> widget directly:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_entry_set_text (GTK_ENTRY (GTK_COMBO (combo)->entry), "My String.");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To set the values in the popdown list, one uses the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_combo_set_popdown_strings( GtkCombo *combo,
|
||
GList *strings );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Before you can do this, you have to assemble a GList of the strings
|
||
that you want. GList is a linked list implementation that is part of
|
||
<link linkend="ch-GLib">GLib</link>, a library supporting GTK. For the
|
||
moment, the quick and dirty explanation is that you need to set up a
|
||
GList pointer, set it equal to NULL, then append strings to it with</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_append( GList *glist,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>It is important that you set the initial GList pointer to NULL. The
|
||
value returned from the g_list_append() function must be used as the new
|
||
pointer to the GList.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's a typical code segment for creating a set of options:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *glist = NULL;
|
||
|
||
glist = g_list_append (glist, "String 1");
|
||
glist = g_list_append (glist, "String 2");
|
||
glist = g_list_append (glist, "String 3");
|
||
glist = g_list_append (glist, "String 4");
|
||
|
||
gtk_combo_set_popdown_strings (GTK_COMBO (combo), glist);
|
||
|
||
/* can free glist now, combo takes a copy */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The combo widget makes a copy of the strings passed to it in the glist
|
||
structure. As a result, you need to make sure you free the memory used
|
||
by the list if that is appropriate for your application.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>At this point you have a working combo box that has been set up.
|
||
There are a few aspects of its behavior that you can change. These
|
||
are accomplished with the functions: </para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_combo_set_use_arrows( GtkCombo *combo,
|
||
gboolean val );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_combo_set_use_arrows_always( GtkCombo *combo,
|
||
gboolean val );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_combo_set_case_sensitive( GtkCombo *combo,
|
||
gboolean val );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_combo_set_use_arrows() lets the user change the value in the
|
||
entry using the up/down arrow keys. This doesn't bring up the list, but
|
||
rather replaces the current text in the entry with the next list entry
|
||
(up or down, as your key choice indicates). It does this by searching
|
||
in the list for the item corresponding to the current value in the
|
||
entry and selecting the previous/next item accordingly. Usually in an
|
||
entry the arrow keys are used to change focus (you can do that anyway
|
||
using TAB). Note that when the current item is the last of the list
|
||
and you press arrow-down it changes the focus (the same applies with
|
||
the first item and arrow-up).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If the current value in the entry is not in the list, then the
|
||
function of gtk_combo_set_use_arrows() is disabled.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_combo_set_use_arrows_always() similarly allows the use the
|
||
the up/down arrow keys to cycle through the choices in the dropdown
|
||
list, except that it wraps around the values in the list, completely
|
||
disabling the use of the up and down arrow keys for changing focus.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_combo_set_case_sensitive() toggles whether or not GTK
|
||
searches for entries in a case sensitive manner. This is used when the
|
||
Combo widget is asked to find a value from the list using the current
|
||
entry in the text box. This completion can be performed in either a
|
||
case sensitive or insensitive manner, depending upon the use of this
|
||
function. The Combo widget can also simply complete the current entry
|
||
if the user presses the key combination MOD-1 and "Tab". MOD-1 is
|
||
often mapped to the "Alt" key, by the <literal>xmodmap</literal> utility. Note,
|
||
however that some window managers also use this key combination, which
|
||
will override its use within GTK.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now that we have a combo box, tailored to look and act how we want it,
|
||
all that remains is being able to get data from the combo box. This is
|
||
relatively straightforward. The majority of the time, all you are
|
||
going to care about getting data from is the entry. The entry is
|
||
accessed simply by <literal>GTK_ENTRY (GTK_COMBO (combo)->entry)</literal>. The
|
||
two principal things that you are going to want to do with it are
|
||
connect to the activate signal, which indicates that the user has
|
||
pressed the Return or Enter key, and read the text. The first is
|
||
accomplished using something like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_COMBO (combo)->entry, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (my_callback_function), my_data);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Getting the text at any arbitrary time is accomplished by simply using
|
||
the entry function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *gtk_entry_get_text( GtkEntry *entry );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Such as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *string;
|
||
|
||
string = gtk_entry_get_text (GTK_ENTRY (GTK_COMBO (combo)->entry));
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>That's about all there is to it. There is a function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_combo_disable_activate( GtkCombo *combo );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>that will disable the activate signal on the entry widget in the combo
|
||
box. Personally, I can't think of why you'd want to use it, but it
|
||
does exist.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- There is also a function to set the string on a particular item, void
|
||
gtk_combo_set_item_string(GtkCombo *combo, GtkItem *item, const gchar
|
||
*item_value), but this requires that you have a pointer to the
|
||
appropriate Item. Frankly, I have no idea how to do that.
|
||
-->
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Calendar">
|
||
<title>Calendar</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Calendar widget is an effective way to display and retrieve
|
||
monthly date related information. It is a very simple widget to create
|
||
and work with.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a GtkCalendar widget is a simple as: </para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_calendar_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>There might be times where you need to change a lot of information
|
||
within this widget and the following functions allow you to make
|
||
multiple change to a Calendar widget without the user seeing multiple
|
||
on-screen updates.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_calendar_freeze( GtkCalendar *Calendar );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_calendar_thaw( GtkCalendar *Calendar );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>They work just like the freeze/thaw functions of every other
|
||
widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Calendar widget has a few options that allow you to change the way
|
||
the widget both looks and operates by using the function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_calendar_display_options( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
GtkCalendarDisplayOptions flags );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>flags</literal> argument can be formed by combining either of the
|
||
following five options using the logical bitwise OR (|) operation:</para>
|
||
|
||
<variablelist>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_CALENDAR_SHOW_HEADING</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>this option specifies that the month and year should be shown
|
||
when drawing the calendar.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_CALENDAR_SHOW_DAY_NAMES</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>this option specifies that the three letter descriptions should
|
||
be displayed for each day (eg Mon,Tue, etc.).</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_CALENDAR_NO_MONTH_CHANGE</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>this option states that the user
|
||
should not and can not change the currently displayed month. This can
|
||
be good if you only need to display a particular month such as if you
|
||
are displaying 12 calendar widgets for every month in a particular
|
||
year.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_CALENDAR_SHOW_WEEK_NUMBERS</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>this option specifies that the
|
||
number for each week should be displayed down the left side of the
|
||
calendar. (eg. Jan 1 = Week 1,Dec 31 = Week 52).</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
<varlistentry>
|
||
<term><literal>GTK_CALENDAR_WEEK_START_MONDAY</literal></term>
|
||
<listitem><para>this option states that the
|
||
calander week will start on Monday instead of Sunday which is the
|
||
default. This only affects the order in which days are displayed from
|
||
left to right.</para>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</varlistentry>
|
||
</variablelist>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following functions are used to set the the currently displayed
|
||
date:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint gtk_calendar_select_month( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
guint month,
|
||
guint year );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_calendar_select_day( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
guint day );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The return value from <literal>gtk_calendar_select_month()</literal> is a boolean
|
||
value indicating whether the selection was successful.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>With <literal>gtk_calendar_select_day()</literal> the specified day number is
|
||
selected within the current month, if that is possible. A
|
||
<literal>day</literal> value of 0 will deselect any current selection.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In addition to having a day selected, any number of days in the month
|
||
may be "marked". A marked day is highlighted within the calendar
|
||
display. The following functions are provided to manipulate marked
|
||
days:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint gtk_calendar_mark_day( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
guint day);
|
||
|
||
gint gtk_calendar_unmark_day( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
guint day);
|
||
|
||
void gtk_calendar_clear_marks( GtkCalendar *calendar);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The currently marked days are stored within an array within the
|
||
GtkCalendar structure. This array is 31 elements long so to test
|
||
whether a particular day is currently marked, you need to access the
|
||
corresponding element of the array (don't forget in C that array
|
||
elements are numbered 0 to n-1). For example:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkCalendar *calendar;
|
||
calendar = gtk_calendar_new ();
|
||
|
||
...
|
||
|
||
/* Is day 7 marked? */
|
||
if (calendar->marked_date[7-1])
|
||
/* day is marked */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that marks are persistent across month and year changes.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The final Calendar widget function is used to retrieve the currently
|
||
selected date, month and/or year.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_calendar_get_date( GtkCalendar *calendar,
|
||
guint *year,
|
||
guint *month,
|
||
guint *day );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This function requires you to pass the addresses of <literal>guint</literal>
|
||
variables, into which the result will be placed. Passing <literal>NULL</literal> as
|
||
a value will result in the corresponding value not being returned.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Calendar widget can generate a number of signals indicating date
|
||
selection and change. The names of these signals are self explanatory,
|
||
and are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>month_changed</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>day_selected</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>day_selected_double_click</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>prev_month</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>next_month</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>prev_year</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>next_year</literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>That just leaves us with the need to put all of this together into
|
||
example code.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/calendar.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start calendar calendar.c -->
|
||
/*
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1998 Cesar Miquel, Shawn T. Amundson, Mattias Gr<47>nlund
|
||
* Copyright (C) 2000 Tony Gale
|
||
*
|
||
* This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||
* it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||
* the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
|
||
* (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||
* along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||
* Foundation, Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <string.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
#define DEF_PAD 10
|
||
#define DEF_PAD_SMALL 5
|
||
|
||
#define TM_YEAR_BASE 1900
|
||
|
||
typedef struct _CalendarData {
|
||
GtkWidget *flag_checkboxes[5];
|
||
gboolean settings[5];
|
||
GtkWidget *font_dialog;
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *prev2_sig;
|
||
GtkWidget *prev_sig;
|
||
GtkWidget *last_sig;
|
||
GtkWidget *month;
|
||
} CalendarData;
|
||
|
||
enum {
|
||
calendar_show_header,
|
||
calendar_show_days,
|
||
calendar_month_change,
|
||
calendar_show_week,
|
||
calendar_monday_first
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/*
|
||
* GtkCalendar
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_date_to_string( CalendarData *data,
|
||
char *buffer,
|
||
gint buff_len )
|
||
{
|
||
GDate date;
|
||
guint year, month, day;
|
||
|
||
gtk_calendar_get_date (GTK_CALENDAR (data->window),
|
||
&year, &month, &day);
|
||
g_date_set_dmy (&date, day, month + 1, year);
|
||
g_date_strftime (buffer, buff_len - 1, "%x", &date);
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_set_signal_strings( char *sig_str,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
const gchar *prev_sig;
|
||
|
||
prev_sig = gtk_label_get_text (GTK_LABEL (data->prev_sig));
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (data->prev2_sig), prev_sig);
|
||
|
||
prev_sig = gtk_label_get_text (GTK_LABEL (data->last_sig));
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (data->prev_sig), prev_sig);
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (data->last_sig), sig_str);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_month_changed( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "month_changed: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 15, 256 - 15);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_day_selected( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "day_selected: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 14, 256 - 14);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_day_selected_double_click ( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "day_selected_double_click: ";
|
||
guint day;
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 27, 256 - 27);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
|
||
gtk_calendar_get_date (GTK_CALENDAR (data->window),
|
||
NULL, NULL, &day);
|
||
|
||
if (GTK_CALENDAR (data->window)->marked_date[day-1] == 0) {
|
||
gtk_calendar_mark_day (GTK_CALENDAR (data->window), day);
|
||
} else {
|
||
gtk_calendar_unmark_day (GTK_CALENDAR (data->window), day);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_prev_month( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "prev_month: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 12, 256 - 12);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_next_month( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "next_month: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 12, 256 - 12);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_prev_year( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "prev_year: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 11, 256 - 11);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_next_year( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
CalendarData *data )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[256] = "next_year: ";
|
||
|
||
calendar_date_to_string (data, buffer + 11, 256 - 11);
|
||
calendar_set_signal_strings (buffer, data);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_set_flags( CalendarData *calendar )
|
||
{
|
||
gint i;
|
||
gint options = 0;
|
||
for (i = 0;i < 5; i++)
|
||
if (calendar->settings[i])
|
||
{
|
||
options = options + (1 << i);
|
||
}
|
||
if (calendar->window)
|
||
gtk_calendar_display_options (GTK_CALENDAR (calendar->window), options);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_toggle_flag( GtkWidget *toggle,
|
||
CalendarData *calendar)
|
||
{
|
||
gint i;
|
||
gint j;
|
||
j = 0;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 5; i++)
|
||
if (calendar->flag_checkboxes[i] == toggle)
|
||
j = i;
|
||
|
||
calendar->settings[j] = !calendar->settings[j];
|
||
calendar_set_flags (calendar);
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_font_selection_ok( GtkWidget *button,
|
||
CalendarData *calendar )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkRcStyle *style;
|
||
char *font_name;
|
||
|
||
if (calendar->window)
|
||
{
|
||
font_name = gtk_font_selection_dialog_get_font_name (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (calendar->font_dialog));
|
||
if (font_name)
|
||
{
|
||
style = gtk_rc_style_new ();
|
||
pango_font_description_free (style->font_desc);
|
||
style->font_desc = pango_font_description_from_string (font_name);
|
||
gtk_widget_modify_style (calendar->window, style);
|
||
g_free (font_name);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_destroy (calendar->font_dialog);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void calendar_select_font( GtkWidget *button,
|
||
CalendarData *calendar )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
|
||
if (!calendar->font_dialog) {
|
||
window = gtk_font_selection_dialog_new ("Font Selection Dialog");
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (window));
|
||
calendar->font_dialog = window;
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_position (GTK_WINDOW (window), GTK_WIN_POS_MOUSE);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroyed),
|
||
&calendar->font_dialog);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (window)->ok_button,
|
||
"clicked", G_CALLBACK (calendar_font_selection_ok),
|
||
calendar);
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (window)->cancel_button,
|
||
"clicked", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
calendar->font_dialog);
|
||
}
|
||
window = calendar->font_dialog;
|
||
if (!GTK_WIDGET_VISIBLE (window))
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
else
|
||
gtk_widget_destroy (window);
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void create_calendar( void )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox, *vbox2, *vbox3;
|
||
GtkWidget *hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *hbbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *calendar;
|
||
GtkWidget *toggle;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *separator;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *bbox;
|
||
static CalendarData calendar_data;
|
||
gint i;
|
||
|
||
struct {
|
||
char *label;
|
||
} flags[] =
|
||
{
|
||
{ "Show Heading" },
|
||
{ "Show Day Names" },
|
||
{ "No Month Change" },
|
||
{ "Show Week Numbers" },
|
||
{ "Week Start Monday" }
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
calendar_data.window = NULL;
|
||
calendar_data.font_dialog = NULL;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 5; i++) {
|
||
calendar_data.settings[i] = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "GtkCalendar Example");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 5);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_false),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_resizable (GTK_WINDOW (window), FALSE);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
|
||
/*
|
||
* The top part of the window, Calendar, flags and fontsel.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), hbox, TRUE, TRUE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
hbbox = gtk_hbutton_box_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), hbbox, FALSE, FALSE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
gtk_button_box_set_layout (GTK_BUTTON_BOX (hbbox), GTK_BUTTONBOX_SPREAD);
|
||
gtk_box_set_spacing (GTK_BOX (hbbox), 5);
|
||
|
||
/* Calendar widget */
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Calendar");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start(GTK_BOX (hbbox), frame, FALSE, TRUE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
calendar=gtk_calendar_new ();
|
||
calendar_data.window = calendar;
|
||
calendar_set_flags (&calendar_data);
|
||
gtk_calendar_mark_day (GTK_CALENDAR (calendar), 19);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), calendar);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "month_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_month_changed),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "day_selected",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_day_selected),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "day_selected_double_click",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_day_selected_double_click),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "prev_month",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_prev_month),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "next_month",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_next_month),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "prev_year",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_prev_year),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
g_signal_connect (calendar, "next_year",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_next_year),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
|
||
|
||
separator = gtk_vseparator_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), separator, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), vbox2, FALSE, FALSE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
|
||
/* Build the Right frame with the flags in */
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Flags");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), frame, TRUE, TRUE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
vbox3 = gtk_vbox_new (TRUE, DEF_PAD_SMALL);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), vbox3);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 5; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
toggle = gtk_check_button_new_with_label (flags[i].label);
|
||
g_signal_connect (toggle,
|
||
"toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_toggle_flag),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox3), toggle, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
calendar_data.flag_checkboxes[i] = toggle;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Build the right font-button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Font...");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button,
|
||
"clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (calendar_select_font),
|
||
&calendar_data);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), button, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/*
|
||
* Build the Signal-event part.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new ("Signal events");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), frame, TRUE, TRUE, DEF_PAD);
|
||
|
||
vbox2 = gtk_vbox_new (TRUE, DEF_PAD_SMALL);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), vbox2);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 3);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Signal:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
calendar_data.last_sig = gtk_label_new ("");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), calendar_data.last_sig, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 3);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Previous signal:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
calendar_data.prev_sig = gtk_label_new ("");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), calendar_data.prev_sig, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 3);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox2), hbox, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Second previous signal:");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), label, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
calendar_data.prev2_sig = gtk_label_new ("");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox), calendar_data.prev2_sig, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
bbox = gtk_hbutton_box_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), bbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_button_box_set_layout (GTK_BUTTON_BOX (bbox), GTK_BUTTONBOX_END);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Close");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (bbox), button);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (window);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
int main (int argc,
|
||
char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
create_calendar ();
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ColorSelection">
|
||
<title>Color Selection</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The color selection widget is, not surprisingly, a widget for
|
||
interactive selection of colors. This composite widget lets the user
|
||
select a color by manipulating RGB (Red, Green, Blue) and HSV (Hue,
|
||
Saturation, Value) triples. This is done either by adjusting single
|
||
values with sliders or entries, or by picking the desired color from a
|
||
hue-saturation wheel/value bar. Optionally, the opacity of the color
|
||
can also be set.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The color selection widget currently emits only one signal,
|
||
"color_changed", which is emitted whenever the current color in the
|
||
widget changes, either when the user changes it or if it's set
|
||
explicitly through gtk_color_selection_set_color().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Lets have a look at what the color selection widget has to offer
|
||
us. The widget comes in two flavours: GtkColorSelection and
|
||
GtkColorSelectionDialog.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_color_selection_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You'll probably not be using this constructor directly. It creates an
|
||
orphan ColorSelection widget which you'll have to parent
|
||
yourself. The ColorSelection widget inherits from the VBox
|
||
widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_color_selection_dialog_new( const gchar *title );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is the most common color selection constructor. It creates a
|
||
ColorSelectionDialog. It consists of a Frame containing a
|
||
ColorSelection widget, an HSeparator and an HBox with three buttons,
|
||
"Ok", "Cancel" and "Help". You can reach these buttons by accessing
|
||
the "ok_button", "cancel_button" and "help_button" widgets in the
|
||
ColorSelectionDialog structure,
|
||
(i.e., <literal>GTK_COLOR_SELECTION_DIALOG (colorseldialog)->ok_button</literal>)).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_color_selection_set_has_opacity_control( GtkColorSelection *colorsel,
|
||
gboolean has_opacity );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The color selection widget supports adjusting the opacity of a color
|
||
(also known as the alpha channel). This is disabled by
|
||
default. Calling this function with has_opacity set to TRUE enables
|
||
opacity. Likewise, has_opacity set to FALSE will disable opacity.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_color_selection_set_current_color( GtkColorSelection *colorsel,
|
||
GdkColor *color );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_color_selection_set_current_alpha( GtkColorSelection *colorsel,
|
||
guint16 alpha );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can set the current color explicitly by calling
|
||
gtk_color_selection_set_current_color() with a pointer to a GdkColor.
|
||
Setting the opacity (alpha channel) is done with
|
||
gtk_color_selection_set_current_alpha(). The alpha value should be between
|
||
0 (fully transparent) and 65535 (fully opaque).
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_color_selection_get_current_color( GtkColorSelection *colorsel,
|
||
GdkColor *color );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_color_selection_get_current_alpha( GtkColorSelection *colorsel,
|
||
guint16 *alpha );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>When you need to query the current color, typically when you've
|
||
received a "color_changed" signal, you use these functions.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><!-- Need to do a whole section on DnD - TRG
|
||
Drag and drop
|
||
-------------</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The color sample areas (right under the hue-saturation wheel) supports
|
||
drag and drop. The type of drag and drop is "application/x-color". The
|
||
message data consists of an array of 4 (or 5 if opacity is enabled)
|
||
gdouble values, where the value at position 0 is 0.0 (opacity on) or
|
||
1.0 (opacity off) followed by the red, green and blue values at
|
||
positions 1,2 and 3 respectively. If opacity is enabled, the opacity
|
||
is passed in the value at position 4.
|
||
--></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's a simple example demonstrating the use of the
|
||
ColorSelectionDialog. The program displays a window containing a
|
||
drawing area. Clicking on it opens a color selection dialog, and
|
||
changing the color in the color selection dialog changes the
|
||
background color.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/colorsel.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start colorsel colorsel.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <glib.h>
|
||
#include <gdk/gdk.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *colorseldlg = NULL;
|
||
GtkWidget *drawingarea = NULL;
|
||
GdkColor color;
|
||
|
||
/* Color changed handler */
|
||
|
||
static void color_changed_cb( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkColorSelection *colorsel )
|
||
{
|
||
GdkColor ncolor;
|
||
|
||
gtk_color_selection_get_current_color (colorsel, &ncolor);
|
||
gtk_widget_modify_bg (drawingarea, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &ncolor);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Drawingarea event handler */
|
||
|
||
static gboolean area_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer client_data )
|
||
{
|
||
gint handled = FALSE;
|
||
gint response;
|
||
GtkColorSelection *colorsel;
|
||
|
||
/* Check if we've received a button pressed event */
|
||
|
||
if (event->type == GDK_BUTTON_PRESS)
|
||
{
|
||
handled = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* Create color selection dialog */
|
||
if (colorseldlg == NULL)
|
||
colorseldlg = gtk_color_selection_dialog_new ("Select background color");
|
||
|
||
/* Get the ColorSelection widget */
|
||
colorsel = GTK_COLOR_SELECTION (GTK_COLOR_SELECTION_DIALOG (colorseldlg)->colorsel);
|
||
|
||
gtk_color_selection_set_previous_color (colorsel, &color);
|
||
gtk_color_selection_set_current_color (colorsel, &color);
|
||
gtk_color_selection_set_has_palette (colorsel, TRUE);
|
||
|
||
/* Connect to the "color_changed" signal, set the client-data
|
||
* to the colorsel widget */
|
||
g_signal_connect (colorsel, "color_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (color_changed_cb), (gpointer) colorsel);
|
||
|
||
/* Show the dialog */
|
||
response = gtk_dialog_run (GTK_DIALOG (colorseldlg));
|
||
|
||
if (response == GTK_RESPONSE_OK)
|
||
gtk_color_selection_get_current_color (colorsel, &color);
|
||
else
|
||
gtk_widget_modify_bg (drawingarea, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &color);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_hide (colorseldlg);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return handled;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Close down and exit handler */
|
||
|
||
static gboolean destroy_window( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer client_data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Main */
|
||
|
||
gint main( gint argc,
|
||
gchar *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize the toolkit, remove gtk-related commandline stuff */
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create toplevel window, set title and policies */
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Color selection test");
|
||
gtk_window_set_resizable ((GTK_WINDOW (window), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
/* Attach to the "delete" and "destroy" events so we can exit */
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy_window), (gpointer) window);
|
||
|
||
/* Create drawingarea, set size and catch button events */
|
||
|
||
drawingarea = gtk_drawing_area_new ();
|
||
|
||
color.red = 0;
|
||
color.blue = 65535;
|
||
color.green = 0;
|
||
gtk_widget_modify_bg (drawingarea, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &color);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (drawingarea), 200, 200);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (drawingarea, GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (drawingarea), "event",
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (area_event), (gpointer) drawingarea);
|
||
|
||
/* Add drawingarea to window, then show them both */
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), drawingarea);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (drawingarea);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Enter the gtk main loop (this never returns) */
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
/* Satisfy grumpy compilers */
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-FileSelections">
|
||
<title>File Selections</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The file selection widget is a quick and simple way to display a File
|
||
dialog box. It comes complete with Ok, Cancel, and Help buttons, a
|
||
great way to cut down on programming time.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new file selection box use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_file_selection_new( const gchar *title );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To set the filename, for example to bring up a specific directory, or
|
||
give a default filename, use this function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_file_selection_set_filename( GtkFileSelection *filesel,
|
||
const gchar *filename );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To grab the text that the user has entered or clicked on, use this
|
||
function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *gtk_file_selection_get_filename( GtkFileSelection *filesel );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are also pointers to the widgets contained within the file
|
||
selection widget. These are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
dir_list
|
||
file_list
|
||
selection_entry
|
||
selection_text
|
||
main_vbox
|
||
ok_button
|
||
cancel_button
|
||
help_button
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Most likely you will want to use the ok_button, cancel_button, and
|
||
help_button pointers in signaling their use.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Included here is an example stolen from <filename>testgtk.c</filename>,
|
||
modified to run on its own. As you will see, there is nothing much to creating a file
|
||
selection widget. While in this example the Help button appears on the
|
||
screen, it does nothing as there is not a signal attached to it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/filesel.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start filesel filesel.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Get the selected filename and print it to the console */
|
||
static void file_ok_sel( GtkWidget *w,
|
||
GtkFileSelection *fs )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("%s\n", gtk_file_selection_get_filename (GTK_FILE_SELECTION (fs)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *filew;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new file selection widget */
|
||
filew = gtk_file_selection_new ("File selection");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (filew, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
/* Connect the ok_button to file_ok_sel function */
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_FILE_SELECTION (filew)->ok_button,
|
||
"clicked", G_CALLBACK (file_ok_sel), (gpointer) filew);
|
||
|
||
/* Connect the cancel_button to destroy the widget */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (GTK_FILE_SELECTION (filew)->cancel_button,
|
||
"clicked", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
filew);
|
||
|
||
/* Lets set the filename, as if this were a save dialog, and we are giving
|
||
a default filename */
|
||
gtk_file_selection_set_filename (GTK_FILE_SELECTION(filew),
|
||
"penguin.png");
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (filew);
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-ContainerWidgets">
|
||
<title>Container Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-EventBox">
|
||
<title>The EventBox</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Some GTK widgets don't have associated X windows, so they just draw on
|
||
their parents. Because of this, they cannot receive events and if they
|
||
are incorrectly sized, they don't clip so you can get messy
|
||
overwriting, etc. If you require more from these widgets, the EventBox
|
||
is for you.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>At first glance, the EventBox widget might appear to be totally
|
||
useless. It draws nothing on the screen and responds to no
|
||
events. However, it does serve a function - it provides an X window
|
||
for its child widget. This is important as many GTK widgets do not
|
||
have an associated X window. Not having an X window saves memory and
|
||
improves performance, but also has some drawbacks. A widget without an
|
||
X window cannot receive events, and does not perform any clipping on
|
||
its contents. Although the name <emphasis>EventBox</emphasis> emphasizes the
|
||
event-handling function, the widget can also be used for clipping.
|
||
(and more, see the example below).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new EventBox widget, use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_event_box_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>A child widget can then be added to this EventBox:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (event_box), child_widget);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following example demonstrates both uses of an EventBox - a label
|
||
is created that is clipped to a small box, and set up so that a
|
||
mouse-click on the label causes the program to exit. Resizing the
|
||
window reveals varying amounts of the label.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/eventbox.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start eventbox eventbox.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *event_box;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Event Box");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create an EventBox and add it to our toplevel window */
|
||
|
||
event_box = gtk_event_box_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), event_box);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (event_box);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a long label */
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Click here to quit, quit, quit, quit, quit");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (event_box), label);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Clip it short. */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (label, 110, 20);
|
||
|
||
/* And bind an action to it */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (event_box, GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK);
|
||
g_signal_connect (event_box, "button_press_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Yet one more thing you need an X window for ... */
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_realize (event_box);
|
||
gdk_window_set_cursor (event_box->window, gdk_cursor_new (GDK_HAND1));
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheAlignmentWidget">
|
||
<title>The Alignment widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The alignment widget allows you to place a widget within its window at
|
||
a position and size relative to the size of the Alignment widget
|
||
itself. For example, it can be very useful for centering a widget
|
||
within the window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are only two functions associated with the Alignment widget:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_alignment_new( gfloat xalign,
|
||
gfloat yalign,
|
||
gfloat xscale,
|
||
gfloat yscale );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_alignment_set( GtkAlignment *alignment,
|
||
gfloat xalign,
|
||
gfloat yalign,
|
||
gfloat xscale,
|
||
gfloat yscale );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first function creates a new Alignment widget with the specified
|
||
parameters. The second function allows the alignment parameters of an
|
||
exisiting Alignment widget to be altered.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>All four alignment parameters are floating point numbers which can
|
||
range from 0.0 to 1.0. The <literal>xalign</literal> and <literal>yalign</literal> arguments
|
||
affect the position of the widget placed within the Alignment
|
||
widget. The <literal>xscale</literal> and <literal>yscale</literal> arguments affect the amount of
|
||
space allocated to the widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A child widget can be added to this Alignment widget using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (alignment), child_widget);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>For an example of using an Alignment widget, refer to the example for
|
||
the <link linkend="sec-ProgressBars">Progress Bar</link> widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-FixedContainer">
|
||
<title>Fixed Container</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Fixed container allows you to place widgets at a fixed position
|
||
within it's window, relative to it's upper left hand corner. The
|
||
position of the widgets can be changed dynamically.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are only a few functions associated with the fixed widget:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_fixed_new( void );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_fixed_put( GtkFixed *fixed,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint x,
|
||
gint y );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_fixed_move( GtkFixed *fixed,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint x,
|
||
gint y );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function gtk_fixed_new() allows you to create a new Fixed
|
||
container.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_fixed_put() places <literal>widget</literal> in the container <literal>fixed</literal> at
|
||
the position specified by <literal>x</literal> and <literal>y</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>gtk_fixed_move() allows the specified widget to be moved to a new
|
||
position.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_has_window( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gboolean has_window );
|
||
|
||
gboolean gtk_widget_get_has_window( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Normally, Fixed widgets don't have their own X window. Since this is
|
||
different from the behaviour of Fixed widgets in earlier releases of GTK,
|
||
the function gtk_widget_set_has_window() allows the creation of Fixed widgets
|
||
<emphasis>with</emphasis> their own window. It has to be called before
|
||
realizing the widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following example illustrates how to use the Fixed Container.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/fixed.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start fixed fixed.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* I'm going to be lazy and use some global variables to
|
||
* store the position of the widget within the fixed
|
||
* container */
|
||
gint x = 50;
|
||
gint y = 50;
|
||
|
||
/* This callback function moves the button to a new position
|
||
* in the Fixed container. */
|
||
static void move_button( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkWidget *fixed )
|
||
{
|
||
x = (x + 30) % 300;
|
||
y = (y + 50) % 300;
|
||
gtk_fixed_move (GTK_FIXED (fixed), widget, x, y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *fixed;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
gint i;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialise GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Fixed Container");
|
||
|
||
/* Here we connect the "destroy" event to a signal handler */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a Fixed Container */
|
||
fixed = gtk_fixed_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), fixed);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (fixed);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 1 ; i <= 3 ; i++) {
|
||
/* Creates a new button with the label "Press me" */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Press me");
|
||
|
||
/* When the button receives the "clicked" signal, it will call the
|
||
* function move_button() passing it the Fixed Container as its
|
||
* argument. */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (move_button), (gpointer) fixed);
|
||
|
||
/* This packs the button into the fixed containers window. */
|
||
gtk_fixed_put (GTK_FIXED (fixed), button, i*50, i*50);
|
||
|
||
/* The final step is to display this newly created widget. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Display the window */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Enter the event loop */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-LayoutContainer">
|
||
<title>Layout Container</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Layout container is similar to the Fixed container except that it
|
||
implements an infinite (where infinity is less than 2^32) scrolling
|
||
area. The X window system has a limitation where windows can be at
|
||
most 32767 pixels wide or tall. The Layout container gets around this
|
||
limitation by doing some exotic stuff using window and bit gravities,
|
||
so that you can have smooth scrolling even when you have many child
|
||
widgets in your scrolling area.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A Layout container is created using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_layout_new( GtkAdjustment *hadjustment,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *vadjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can see, you can optionally specify the Adjustment objects that
|
||
the Layout widget will use for its scrolling.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can add and move widgets in the Layout container using the
|
||
following two functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_layout_put( GtkLayout *layout,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint x,
|
||
gint y );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_layout_move( GtkLayout *layout,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint x,
|
||
gint y );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The size of the Layout container can be set using the next function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_layout_set_size( GtkLayout *layout,
|
||
guint width,
|
||
guint height );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The final four functions for use with Layout widgets are for
|
||
manipulating the horizontal and vertical adjustment widgets:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAdjustment* gtk_layout_get_hadjustment( GtkLayout *layout );
|
||
|
||
GtkAdjustment* gtk_layout_get_vadjustment( GtkLayout *layout );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_layout_set_hadjustment( GtkLayout *layout,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_layout_set_vadjustment( GtkLayout *layout,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Frames">
|
||
<title>Frames</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Frames can be used to enclose one or a group of widgets with a box
|
||
which can optionally be labelled. The position of the label and the
|
||
style of the box can be altered to suit.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A Frame can be created with the following function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_frame_new( const gchar *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The label is by default placed in the upper left hand corner of the
|
||
frame. A value of NULL for the <literal>label</literal> argument will result in no
|
||
label being displayed. The text of the label can be changed using the
|
||
next function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_frame_set_label( GtkFrame *frame,
|
||
const gchar *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The position of the label can be changed using this function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_frame_set_label_align( GtkFrame *frame,
|
||
gfloat xalign,
|
||
gfloat yalign );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>xalign</literal> and <literal>yalign</literal> take values between 0.0 and 1.0. <literal>xalign</literal>
|
||
indicates the position of the label along the top horizontal of the
|
||
frame. <literal>yalign</literal> is not currently used. The default value of xalign
|
||
is 0.0 which places the label at the left hand end of the frame.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next function alters the style of the box that is used to outline
|
||
the frame.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_frame_set_shadow_type( GtkFrame *frame,
|
||
GtkShadowType type);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>type</literal> argument can take one of the following values:</para>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_NONE
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_IN
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_IN (the default)
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_OUT
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following code example illustrates the use of the Frame widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/frame.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start frame frame.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
/* GtkWidget is the storage type for widgets */
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialise GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Frame Example");
|
||
|
||
/* Here we connect the "destroy" event to a signal handler */
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (window, 300, 300);
|
||
/* Sets the border width of the window. */
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a Frame */
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new (NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), frame);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the frame's label */
|
||
gtk_frame_set_label (GTK_FRAME (frame), "GTK Frame Widget");
|
||
|
||
/* Align the label at the right of the frame */
|
||
gtk_frame_set_label_align (GTK_FRAME (frame), 1.0, 0.0);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the style of the frame */
|
||
gtk_frame_set_shadow_type (GTK_FRAME (frame), GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_OUT);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (frame);
|
||
|
||
/* Display the window */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Enter the event loop */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-AspectFrames">
|
||
<title>Aspect Frames</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The aspect frame widget is like a frame widget, except that it also
|
||
enforces the aspect ratio (that is, the ratio of the width to the
|
||
height) of the child widget to have a certain value, adding extra
|
||
space if necessary. This is useful, for instance, if you want to
|
||
preview a larger image. The size of the preview should vary when the
|
||
user resizes the window, but the aspect ratio needs to always match
|
||
the original image.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new aspect frame use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_aspect_frame_new( const gchar *label,
|
||
gfloat xalign,
|
||
gfloat yalign,
|
||
gfloat ratio,
|
||
gboolean obey_child);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>xalign</literal> and <literal>yalign</literal> specify alignment as with Alignment
|
||
widgets. If <literal>obey_child</literal> is TRUE, the aspect ratio of a child
|
||
widget will match the aspect ratio of the ideal size it requests.
|
||
Otherwise, it is given by <literal>ratio</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To change the options of an existing aspect frame, you can use:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_aspect_frame_set( GtkAspectFrame *aspect_frame,
|
||
gfloat xalign,
|
||
gfloat yalign,
|
||
gfloat ratio,
|
||
gboolean obey_child);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As an example, the following program uses an AspectFrame to present a
|
||
drawing area whose aspect ratio will always be 2:1, no matter how the
|
||
user resizes the top-level window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/aspectframe.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start aspectframe aspectframe.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *aspect_frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *drawing_area;
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Aspect Frame");
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create an aspect_frame and add it to our toplevel window */
|
||
|
||
aspect_frame = gtk_aspect_frame_new ("2x1", /* label */
|
||
0.5, /* center x */
|
||
0.5, /* center y */
|
||
2, /* xsize/ysize = 2 */
|
||
FALSE /* ignore child's aspect */);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), aspect_frame);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (aspect_frame);
|
||
|
||
/* Now add a child widget to the aspect frame */
|
||
|
||
drawing_area = gtk_drawing_area_new ();
|
||
|
||
/* Ask for a 200x200 window, but the AspectFrame will give us a 200x100
|
||
* window since we are forcing a 2x1 aspect ratio */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (drawing_area, 200, 200);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (aspect_frame), drawing_area);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (drawing_area);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-PanedWindowWidgets">
|
||
<title>Paned Window Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The paned window widgets are useful when you want to divide an area
|
||
into two parts, with the relative size of the two parts controlled by
|
||
the user. A groove is drawn between the two portions with a handle
|
||
that the user can drag to change the ratio. The division can either be
|
||
horizontal (HPaned) or vertical (VPaned).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create a new paned window, call one of:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hpaned_new (void);
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vpaned_new (void);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>After creating the paned window widget, you need to add child widgets
|
||
to its two halves. To do this, use the functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_paned_add1 (GtkPaned *paned, GtkWidget *child);
|
||
|
||
void gtk_paned_add2 (GtkPaned *paned, GtkWidget *child);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>gtk_paned_add1()</literal> adds the child widget to the left or top half of
|
||
the paned window. <literal>gtk_paned_add2()</literal> adds the child widget to the
|
||
right or bottom half of the paned window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As an example, we will create part of the user interface of an
|
||
imaginary email program. A window is divided into two portions
|
||
vertically, with the top portion being a list of email messages and
|
||
the bottom portion the text of the email message. Most of the program
|
||
is pretty straightforward. A couple of points to note: text can't be
|
||
added to a Text widget until it is realized. This could be done by
|
||
calling gtk_widget_realize(), but as a demonstration of an
|
||
alternate technique, we connect a handler to the "realize" signal to
|
||
add the text. Also, we need to add the <literal>GTK_SHRINK</literal> option to some
|
||
of the items in the table containing the text window and its
|
||
scrollbars, so that when the bottom portion is made smaller, the
|
||
correct portions shrink instead of being pushed off the bottom of the
|
||
window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/paned.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start paned paned.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Create the list of "messages" */
|
||
static GtkWidget *create_list( void )
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *scrolled_window;
|
||
GtkWidget *tree_view;
|
||
GtkListStore *model;
|
||
GtkTreeIter iter;
|
||
GtkCellRenderer *cell;
|
||
GtkTreeViewColumn *column;
|
||
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new scrolled window, with scrollbars only if needed */
|
||
scrolled_window = gtk_scrolled_window_new (NULL, NULL);
|
||
gtk_scrolled_window_set_policy (GTK_SCROLLED_WINDOW (scrolled_window),
|
||
GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC,
|
||
GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC);
|
||
|
||
model = gtk_list_store_new (1, G_TYPE_STRING);
|
||
tree_view = gtk_tree_view_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (scrolled_window), tree_view);
|
||
gtk_tree_view_set_model (GTK_TREE_VIEW (tree_view), GTK_TREE_MODEL (model));
|
||
gtk_widget_show (tree_view);
|
||
|
||
/* Add some messages to the window */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 10; i++) {
|
||
gchar *msg = g_strdup_printf ("Message #%d", i);
|
||
gtk_list_store_append (GTK_LIST_STORE (model), &iter);
|
||
gtk_list_store_set (GTK_LIST_STORE (model),
|
||
&iter,
|
||
0, msg,
|
||
-1);
|
||
g_free (msg);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
cell = gtk_cell_renderer_text_new ();
|
||
|
||
column = gtk_tree_view_column_new_with_attributes ("Messages",
|
||
cell,
|
||
"text", 0,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_tree_view_append_column (GTK_TREE_VIEW (tree_view),
|
||
GTK_TREE_VIEW_COLUMN (column));
|
||
|
||
return scrolled_window;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add some text to our text widget - this is a callback that is invoked
|
||
when our window is realized. We could also force our window to be
|
||
realized with gtk_widget_realize, but it would have to be part of
|
||
a hierarchy first */
|
||
|
||
static void insert_text( GtkTextBuffer *buffer )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkTextIter iter;
|
||
|
||
gtk_text_buffer_get_iter_at_offset (buffer, &iter, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_text_buffer_insert (buffer, &iter,
|
||
"From: pathfinder@nasa.gov\n"
|
||
"To: mom@nasa.gov\n"
|
||
"Subject: Made it!\n"
|
||
"\n"
|
||
"We just got in this morning. The weather has been\n"
|
||
"great - clear but cold, and there are lots of fun sights.\n"
|
||
"Sojourner says hi. See you soon.\n"
|
||
" -Path\n", -1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create a scrolled text area that displays a "message" */
|
||
static GtkWidget *create_text( void )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *scrolled_window;
|
||
GtkWidget *view;
|
||
GtkTextBuffer *buffer;
|
||
|
||
view = gtk_text_view_new ();
|
||
buffer = gtk_text_view_get_buffer (GTK_TEXT_VIEW (view));
|
||
|
||
scrolled_window = gtk_scrolled_window_new (NULL, NULL);
|
||
gtk_scrolled_window_set_policy (GTK_SCROLLED_WINDOW (scrolled_window),
|
||
GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC,
|
||
GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (scrolled_window), view);
|
||
insert_text (buffer);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (scrolled_window);
|
||
|
||
return scrolled_window;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *vpaned;
|
||
GtkWidget *list;
|
||
GtkWidget *text;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Paned Windows");
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (window), 450, 400);
|
||
|
||
/* create a vpaned widget and add it to our toplevel window */
|
||
|
||
vpaned = gtk_vpaned_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vpaned);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vpaned);
|
||
|
||
/* Now create the contents of the two halves of the window */
|
||
|
||
list = create_list ();
|
||
gtk_paned_add1 (GTK_PANED (vpaned), list);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (list);
|
||
|
||
text = create_text ();
|
||
gtk_paned_add2 (GTK_PANED (vpaned), text);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (text);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Viewports">
|
||
<title>Viewports</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>It is unlikely that you will ever need to use the Viewport widget
|
||
directly. You are much more likely to use the
|
||
<link linkend="sec-ScrolledWindows">Scrolled Window</link> widget which
|
||
itself uses the Viewport.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A viewport widget allows you to place a larger widget within it such
|
||
that you can view a part of it at a time. It uses
|
||
<link linkend="ch-Adjustments">Adjustments</link> to define the area that
|
||
is currently in view.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A Viewport is created with the function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_viewport_new( GtkAdjustment *hadjustment,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *vadjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can see you can specify the horizontal and vertical Adjustments
|
||
that the widget is to use when you create the widget. It will create
|
||
its own if you pass NULL as the value of the arguments.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can get and set the adjustments after the widget has been created
|
||
using the following four functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAdjustment *gtk_viewport_get_hadjustment( GtkViewport *viewport );
|
||
|
||
GtkAdjustment *gtk_viewport_get_vadjustment( GtkViewport *viewport );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_viewport_set_hadjustment( GtkViewport *viewport,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_viewport_set_vadjustment( GtkViewport *viewport,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The only other viewport function is used to alter its appearance:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_viewport_set_shadow_type( GtkViewport *viewport,
|
||
GtkShadowType type );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Possible values for the <literal>type</literal> parameter are:</para>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_NONE,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_IN,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_IN,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_ETCHED_OUT
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ScrolledWindows"
|
||
<title>Scrolled Windows</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Scrolled windows are used to create a scrollable area with another
|
||
widget inside it. You may insert any type of widget into a scrolled
|
||
window, and it will be accessible regardless of the size by using the
|
||
scrollbars.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following function is used to create a new scrolled window.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_scrolled_window_new( GtkAdjustment *hadjustment,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *vadjustment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Where the first argument is the adjustment for the horizontal
|
||
direction, and the second, the adjustment for the vertical direction.
|
||
These are almost always set to NULL.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_scrolled_window_set_policy( GtkScrolledWindow *scrolled_window,
|
||
GtkPolicyType hscrollbar_policy,
|
||
GtkPolicyType vscrollbar_policy );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This sets the policy to be used with respect to the scrollbars.
|
||
The first argument is the scrolled window you wish to change. The second
|
||
sets the policy for the horizontal scrollbar, and the third the policy for
|
||
the vertical scrollbar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The policy may be one of <literal>GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC</literal> or
|
||
<literal>GTK_POLICY_ALWAYS</literal>. <literal>GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC</literal> will automatically
|
||
decide whether you need scrollbars, whereas <literal>GTK_POLICY_ALWAYS</literal>
|
||
will always leave the scrollbars there.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>You can then place your object into the scrolled window using the
|
||
following function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_scrolled_window_add_with_viewport( GtkScrolledWindow *scrolled_window,
|
||
GtkWidget *child);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is a simple example that packs a table with 100 toggle buttons
|
||
into a scrolled window. I've only commented on the parts that may be
|
||
new to you.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/scrolledwin.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start scrolledwin scrolledwin.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static void destroy( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *scrolled_window;
|
||
GtkWidget *table;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
char buffer[32];
|
||
int i, j;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new dialog window for the scrolled window to be
|
||
* packed into. */
|
||
window = gtk_dialog_new ();
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy), NULL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "GtkScrolledWindow example");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (window, 300, 300);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new scrolled window. */
|
||
scrolled_window = gtk_scrolled_window_new (NULL, NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (scrolled_window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* the policy is one of GTK_POLICY AUTOMATIC, or GTK_POLICY_ALWAYS.
|
||
* GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC will automatically decide whether you need
|
||
* scrollbars, whereas GTK_POLICY_ALWAYS will always leave the scrollbars
|
||
* there. The first one is the horizontal scrollbar, the second,
|
||
* the vertical. */
|
||
gtk_scrolled_window_set_policy (GTK_SCROLLED_WINDOW (scrolled_window),
|
||
GTK_POLICY_AUTOMATIC, GTK_POLICY_ALWAYS);
|
||
/* The dialog window is created with a vbox packed into it. */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (GTK_DIALOG(window)->vbox), scrolled_window,
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (scrolled_window);
|
||
|
||
/* create a table of 10 by 10 squares. */
|
||
table = gtk_table_new (10, 10, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
/* set the spacing to 10 on x and 10 on y */
|
||
gtk_table_set_row_spacings (GTK_TABLE (table), 10);
|
||
gtk_table_set_col_spacings (GTK_TABLE (table), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* pack the table into the scrolled window */
|
||
gtk_scrolled_window_add_with_viewport (
|
||
GTK_SCROLLED_WINDOW (scrolled_window), table);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (table);
|
||
|
||
/* this simply creates a grid of toggle buttons on the table
|
||
* to demonstrate the scrolled window. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 10; i++)
|
||
for (j = 0; j < 10; j++) {
|
||
sprintf (buffer, "button (%d,%d)\n", i, j);
|
||
button = gtk_toggle_button_new_with_label (buffer);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button,
|
||
i, i+1, j, j+1);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a "close" button to the bottom of the dialog */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("close");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
|
||
/* this makes it so the button is the default. */
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_can_default (button, TRUE);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (GTK_DIALOG (window)->action_area), button, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* This grabs this button to be the default button. Simply hitting
|
||
* the "Enter" key will cause this button to activate. */
|
||
gtk_widget_grab_default (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Try playing with resizing the window. You'll notice how the scrollbars
|
||
react. You may also wish to use the gtk_widget_set_size_request() call to set
|
||
the default size of the window or other widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ButtonBoxes">
|
||
<title>Button Boxes</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Button Boxes are a convenient way to quickly layout a group of
|
||
buttons. They come in both horizontal and vertical flavours. You
|
||
create a new Button Box with one of the following calls, which create
|
||
a horizontal or vertical box, respectively:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_hbutton_box_new( void );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_vbutton_box_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Buttons are added to a Button Box using the usual function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (button_box), child_widget);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's an example that illustrates all the different layout settings
|
||
for Button Boxes.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/buttonbox.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start buttonbox buttonbox.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Create a Button Box with the specified parameters */
|
||
static GtkWidget *create_bbox( gint horizontal,
|
||
char *title,
|
||
gint spacing,
|
||
gint child_w,
|
||
gint child_h,
|
||
gint layout )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *bbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new (title);
|
||
|
||
if (horizontal)
|
||
bbox = gtk_hbutton_box_new ();
|
||
else
|
||
bbox = gtk_vbutton_box_new ();
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (bbox), 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), bbox);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the appearance of the Button Box */
|
||
gtk_button_box_set_layout (GTK_BUTTON_BOX (bbox), layout);
|
||
gtk_box_set_spacing (GTK_BOX (bbox), spacing);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_from_stock (GTK_STOCK_OK);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (bbox), button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_from_stock (GTK_STOCK_CANCEL);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (bbox), button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_from_stock (GTK_STOCK_HELP);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (bbox), button);
|
||
|
||
return frame;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkWidget* window = NULL;
|
||
GtkWidget *main_vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *hbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame_horz;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame_vert;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Button Boxes");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
main_vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), main_vbox);
|
||
|
||
frame_horz = gtk_frame_new ("Horizontal Button Boxes");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), frame_horz, TRUE, TRUE, 10);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), 10);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame_horz), vbox);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox),
|
||
create_bbox (TRUE, "Spread (spacing 40)", 40, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_SPREAD),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox),
|
||
create_bbox (TRUE, "Edge (spacing 30)", 30, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_EDGE),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox),
|
||
create_bbox (TRUE, "Start (spacing 20)", 20, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_START),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox),
|
||
create_bbox (TRUE, "End (spacing 10)", 10, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_END),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
frame_vert = gtk_frame_new ("Vertical Button Boxes");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), frame_vert, TRUE, TRUE, 10);
|
||
|
||
hbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (hbox), 10);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame_vert), hbox);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox),
|
||
create_bbox (FALSE, "Spread (spacing 5)", 5, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_SPREAD),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox),
|
||
create_bbox (FALSE, "Edge (spacing 30)", 30, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_EDGE),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox),
|
||
create_bbox (FALSE, "Start (spacing 20)", 20, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_START),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (hbox),
|
||
create_bbox (FALSE, "End (spacing 20)", 20, 85, 20, GTK_BUTTONBOX_END),
|
||
TRUE, TRUE, 5);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Enter the event loop */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Toolbar">
|
||
<title>Toolbar</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Toolbars are usually used to group some number of widgets in order to
|
||
simplify customization of their look and layout. Typically a toolbar
|
||
consists of buttons with icons, labels and tooltips, but any other
|
||
widget can also be put inside a toolbar. Finally, items can be
|
||
arranged horizontally or vertically and buttons can be displayed with
|
||
icons, labels, or both.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a toolbar is (as one may already suspect) done with the
|
||
following function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toolbar_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>After creating a toolbar one can append, prepend and insert items
|
||
(that means simple text strings) or elements (that means any widget
|
||
types) into the toolbar. To describe an item we need a label text, a
|
||
tooltip text, a private tooltip text, an icon for the button and a
|
||
callback function for it. For example, to append or prepend an item
|
||
you may use the following functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toolbar_append_item( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
const char *text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_private_text,
|
||
GtkWidget *icon,
|
||
GtkSignalFunc callback,
|
||
gpointer user_data );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toolbar_prepend_item( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
const char *text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_private_text,
|
||
GtkWidget *icon,
|
||
GtkSignalFunc callback,
|
||
gpointer user_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you want to use gtk_toolbar_insert_item(), the only additional
|
||
parameter which must be specified is the position in which the item
|
||
should be inserted, thus:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_toolbar_insert_item( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
const char *text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_text,
|
||
const char *tooltip_private_text,
|
||
GtkWidget *icon,
|
||
GtkSignalFunc callback,
|
||
gpointer user_data,
|
||
gint position );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To simplify adding spaces between toolbar items, you may use the
|
||
following functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_append_space( GtkToolbar *toolbar );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_prepend_space( GtkToolbar *toolbar );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_insert_space( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
gint position );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If it's required, the orientation of a toolbar and its style can be
|
||
changed "on the fly" using the following functions:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_set_orientation( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
GtkOrientation orientation );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_set_style( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
GtkToolbarStyle style );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_toolbar_set_tooltips( GtkToolbar *toolbar,
|
||
gint enable );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Where <literal>orientation</literal> is one of <literal>GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL</literal> or
|
||
<literal>GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL</literal>. The <literal>style</literal> is used to set
|
||
appearance of the toolbar items by using one of
|
||
<literal>GTK_TOOLBAR_ICONS</literal>, <literal>GTK_TOOLBAR_TEXT</literal>, or
|
||
<literal>GTK_TOOLBAR_BOTH</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To show some other things that can be done with a toolbar, let's take
|
||
the following program (we'll interrupt the listing with some
|
||
additional explanations):</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* This function is connected to the Close button or
|
||
* closing the window from the WM */
|
||
static gboolean delete_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The above beginning seems for sure familiar to you if it's not your first
|
||
GTK program. There is one additional thing though, we include a nice XPM
|
||
picture to serve as an icon for all of the buttons.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget* close_button; /* This button will emit signal to close
|
||
* application */
|
||
GtkWidget* tooltips_button; /* to enable/disable tooltips */
|
||
GtkWidget* text_button,
|
||
* icon_button,
|
||
* both_button; /* radio buttons for toolbar style */
|
||
GtkWidget* entry; /* a text entry to show packing any widget into
|
||
* toolbar */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>In fact not all of the above widgets are needed here, but to make things
|
||
clearer I put them all together.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* that's easy... when one of the buttons is toggled, we just
|
||
* check which one is active and set the style of the toolbar
|
||
* accordingly
|
||
* ATTENTION: our toolbar is passed as data to callback ! */
|
||
static void radio_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
if (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (text_button)->active)
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (data), GTK_TOOLBAR_TEXT);
|
||
else if (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (icon_button)->active)
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (data), GTK_TOOLBAR_ICONS);
|
||
else if (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (both_button)->active)
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (data), GTK_TOOLBAR_BOTH);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* even easier, just check given toggle button and enable/disable
|
||
* tooltips */
|
||
static void toggle_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_tooltips (GTK_TOOLBAR (data),
|
||
GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget)->active );
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The above are just two callback functions that will be called when
|
||
one of the buttons on a toolbar is pressed. You should already be
|
||
familiar with things like this if you've already used toggle buttons (and
|
||
radio buttons).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
int main (int argc, char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
/* Here is our main window (a dialog) and a handle for the handlebox */
|
||
GtkWidget* dialog;
|
||
GtkWidget* handlebox;
|
||
|
||
/* Ok, we need a toolbar, an icon with a mask (one for all of
|
||
the buttons) and an icon widget to put this icon in (but
|
||
we'll create a separate widget for each button) */
|
||
GtkWidget * toolbar;
|
||
GtkWidget * iconw;
|
||
|
||
/* this is called in all GTK application. */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new window with a given title, and nice size */
|
||
dialog = gtk_dialog_new ();
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (dialog), "GTKToolbar Tutorial");
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (dialog), 600, 300);
|
||
GTK_WINDOW (dialog)->allow_shrink = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* typically we quit if someone tries to close us */
|
||
g_signal_connect (dialog, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* we need to realize the window because we use pixmaps for
|
||
* items on the toolbar in the context of it */
|
||
gtk_widget_realize (dialog);
|
||
|
||
/* to make it nice we'll put the toolbar into the handle box,
|
||
* so that it can be detached from the main window */
|
||
handlebox = gtk_handle_box_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (GTK_DIALOG (dialog)->vbox),
|
||
handlebox, FALSE, FALSE, 5);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The above should be similar to any other GTK application. Just
|
||
initialization of GTK, creating the window, etc. There is only one
|
||
thing that probably needs some explanation: a handle box. A handle box
|
||
is just another box that can be used to pack widgets in to. The
|
||
difference between it and typical boxes is that it can be detached
|
||
from a parent window (or, in fact, the handle box remains in the
|
||
parent, but it is reduced to a very small rectangle, while all of its
|
||
contents are reparented to a new freely floating window). It is
|
||
usually nice to have a detachable toolbar, so these two widgets occur
|
||
together quite often.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* toolbar will be horizontal, with both icons and text, and
|
||
* with 5pxl spaces between items and finally,
|
||
* we'll also put it into our handlebox */
|
||
toolbar = gtk_toolbar_new ();
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_orientation (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar), GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar), GTK_TOOLBAR_BOTH);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (toolbar), 5);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_set_space_size (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar), 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (handlebox), toolbar);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Well, what we do above is just a straightforward initialization of
|
||
the toolbar widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* our first item is <close> button */
|
||
iconw = gtk_image_new_from_file ("gtk.xpm"); /* icon widget */
|
||
close_button =
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar), /* our toolbar */
|
||
"Close", /* button label */
|
||
"Closes this app", /* this button's tooltip */
|
||
"Private", /* tooltip private info */
|
||
iconw, /* icon widget */
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (delete_event), /* a signal */
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_space (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar)); /* space after item */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>In the above code you see the simplest case: adding a button to
|
||
toolbar. Just before appending a new item, we have to construct an
|
||
image widget to serve as an icon for this item; this step will have
|
||
to be repeated for each new item. Just after the item we also add a
|
||
space, so the following items will not touch each other. As you see
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_item() returns a pointer to our newly created button
|
||
widget, so that we can work with it in the normal way.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* now, let's make our radio buttons group... */
|
||
iconw = gtk_image_new_from_file ("gtk.xpm");
|
||
icon_button = gtk_toolbar_append_element (
|
||
GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar),
|
||
GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_RADIOBUTTON, /* a type of element */
|
||
NULL, /* pointer to widget */
|
||
"Icon", /* label */
|
||
"Only icons in toolbar", /* tooltip */
|
||
"Private", /* tooltip private string */
|
||
iconw, /* icon */
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (radio_event), /* signal */
|
||
toolbar); /* data for signal */
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_space (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar));
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here we begin creating a radio buttons group. To do this we use
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_element. In fact, using this function one can also
|
||
+add simple items or even spaces (type = <literal>GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_SPACE</literal>
|
||
or +<literal>GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_BUTTON</literal>). In the above case we start
|
||
creating a radio group. In creating other radio buttons for this group
|
||
a pointer to the previous button in the group is required, so that a
|
||
list of buttons can be easily constructed (see the section on <link
|
||
linkend="sec-RadioButtons">Radio Buttons</link> earlier in this
|
||
tutorial).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* following radio buttons refer to previous ones */
|
||
iconw = gtk_image_new_from_file ("gtk.xpm");
|
||
text_button =
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_element (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar),
|
||
GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_RADIOBUTTON,
|
||
icon_button,
|
||
"Text",
|
||
"Only texts in toolbar",
|
||
"Private",
|
||
iconw,
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (radio_event),
|
||
toolbar);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_space (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar));
|
||
|
||
iconw = gtk_image_new_from_file ("gtk.xpm");
|
||
both_button =
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_element (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar),
|
||
GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_RADIOBUTTON,
|
||
text_button,
|
||
"Both",
|
||
"Icons and text in toolbar",
|
||
"Private",
|
||
iconw,
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (radio_event),
|
||
toolbar);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_space (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar));
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (both_button), TRUE);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>In the end we have to set the state of one of the buttons manually
|
||
(otherwise they all stay in active state, preventing us from switching
|
||
between them).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* here we have just a simple toggle button */
|
||
iconw = gtk_image_new_from_file ("gtk.xpm");
|
||
tooltips_button =
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_element (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar),
|
||
GTK_TOOLBAR_CHILD_TOGGLEBUTTON,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
"Tooltips",
|
||
"Toolbar with or without tips",
|
||
"Private",
|
||
iconw,
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (toggle_event),
|
||
toolbar);
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_space (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar));
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (tooltips_button), TRUE);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>A toggle button can be created in the obvious way (if one knows how to create
|
||
radio buttons already).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* to pack a widget into toolbar, we only have to
|
||
* create it and append it with an appropriate tooltip */
|
||
entry = gtk_entry_new ();
|
||
gtk_toolbar_append_widget (GTK_TOOLBAR (toolbar),
|
||
entry,
|
||
"This is just an entry",
|
||
"Private");
|
||
|
||
/* well, it isn't created within the toolbar, so we must still show it */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (entry);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you see, adding any kind of widget to a toolbar is simple. The
|
||
one thing you have to remember is that this widget must be shown manually
|
||
(contrary to other items which will be shown together with the toolbar).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* that's it ! let's show everything. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (toolbar);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (handlebox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (dialog);
|
||
|
||
/* rest in gtk_main and wait for the fun to begin! */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>So, here we are at the end of toolbar tutorial. Of course, to appreciate
|
||
it in full you need also this nice XPM icon, so here it is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* XPM */
|
||
static char * gtk_xpm[] = {
|
||
"32 39 5 1",
|
||
". c none",
|
||
"+ c black",
|
||
"@ c #3070E0",
|
||
"# c #F05050",
|
||
"$ c #35E035",
|
||
"................+...............",
|
||
"..............+++++.............",
|
||
"............+++++@@++...........",
|
||
"..........+++++@@@@@@++.........",
|
||
"........++++@@@@@@@@@@++........",
|
||
"......++++@@++++++++@@@++.......",
|
||
".....+++@@@+++++++++++@@@++.....",
|
||
"...+++@@@@+++@@@@@@++++@@@@+....",
|
||
"..+++@@@@+++@@@@@@@@+++@@@@@++..",
|
||
".++@@@@@@+++@@@@@@@@@@@@@@@@@@++",
|
||
".+#+@@@@@@++@@@@+++@@@@@@@@@@@@+",
|
||
".+##++@@@@+++@@@+++++@@@@@@@@$@.",
|
||
".+###++@@@@+++@@@+++@@@@@++$$$@.",
|
||
".+####+++@@@+++++++@@@@@+@$$$$@.",
|
||
".+#####+++@@@@+++@@@@++@$$$$$$+.",
|
||
".+######++++@@@@@@@++@$$$$$$$$+.",
|
||
".+#######+##+@@@@+++$$$$$$@@$$+.",
|
||
".+###+++##+##+@@++@$$$$$$++$$$+.",
|
||
".+###++++##+##+@@$$$$$$$@+@$$@+.",
|
||
".+###++++++#+++@$$@+@$$@++$$$@+.",
|
||
".+####+++++++#++$$@+@$$++$$$$+..",
|
||
".++####++++++#++$$@+@$++@$$$$+..",
|
||
".+#####+++++##++$$++@+++$$$$$+..",
|
||
".++####+++##+#++$$+++++@$$$$$+..",
|
||
".++####+++####++$$++++++@$$$@+..",
|
||
".+#####++#####++$$+++@++++@$@+..",
|
||
".+#####++#####++$$++@$$@+++$@@..",
|
||
".++####++#####++$$++$$$$$+@$@++.",
|
||
".++####++#####++$$++$$$$$$$$+++.",
|
||
".+++####+#####++$$++$$$$$$$@+++.",
|
||
"..+++#########+@$$+@$$$$$$+++...",
|
||
"...+++########+@$$$$$$$$@+++....",
|
||
".....+++######+@$$$$$$$+++......",
|
||
"......+++#####+@$$$$$@++........",
|
||
".......+++####+@$$$$+++.........",
|
||
".........++###+$$$@++...........",
|
||
"..........++##+$@+++............",
|
||
"...........+++++++..............",
|
||
".............++++..............."};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Notebooks">
|
||
<title>Notebooks</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The NoteBook Widget is a collection of "pages" that overlap each
|
||
other, each page contains different information with only one page
|
||
visible at a time. This widget has become more common lately in GUI
|
||
programming, and it is a good way to show blocks of similar
|
||
information that warrant separation in their display.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first function call you will need to know, as you can probably
|
||
guess by now, is used to create a new notebook widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_notebook_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once the notebook has been created, there are a number of functions
|
||
that operate on the notebook widget. Let's look at them individually.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first one we will look at is how to position the page indicators.
|
||
These page indicators or "tabs" as they are referred to, can be
|
||
positioned in four ways: top, bottom, left, or right.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_set_tab_pos( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
GtkPositionType pos );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>GtkPositionType will be one of the following, which are pretty self
|
||
explanatory:</para>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_POS_LEFT
|
||
GTK_POS_RIGHT
|
||
GTK_POS_TOP
|
||
GTK_POS_BOTTOM
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>GTK_POS_TOP</literal> is the default.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Next we will look at how to add pages to the notebook. There are three
|
||
ways to add pages to the NoteBook. Let's look at the first two
|
||
together as they are quite similar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_append_page( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
GtkWidget *child,
|
||
GtkWidget *tab_label );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_notebook_prepend_page( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
GtkWidget *child,
|
||
GtkWidget *tab_label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These functions add pages to the notebook by inserting them from the
|
||
back of the notebook (append), or the front of the notebook (prepend).
|
||
<literal>child</literal> is the widget that is placed within the notebook page, and
|
||
<literal>tab_label</literal> is the label for the page being added. The <literal>child</literal>
|
||
widget must be created separately, and is typically a set of options
|
||
setup witin one of the other container widgets, such as a table.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The final function for adding a page to the notebook contains all of
|
||
the properties of the previous two, but it allows you to specify what
|
||
position you want the page to be in the notebook.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_insert_page( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
GtkWidget *child,
|
||
GtkWidget *tab_label,
|
||
gint position );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The parameters are the same as _append_ and _prepend_ except it
|
||
contains an extra parameter, <literal>position</literal>. This parameter is used to
|
||
specify what place this page will be inserted into the first page
|
||
having position zero.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now that we know how to add a page, lets see how we can remove a page
|
||
from the notebook.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_remove_page( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
gint page_num );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This function takes the page specified by <literal>page_num</literal> and removes it
|
||
from the widget pointed to by <literal>notebook</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To find out what the current page is in a notebook use the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint gtk_notebook_get_current_page( GtkNotebook *notebook );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These next two functions are simple calls to move the notebook page
|
||
forward or backward. Simply provide the respective function call with
|
||
the notebook widget you wish to operate on. Note: When the NoteBook is
|
||
currently on the last page, and gtk_notebook_next_page() is called, the
|
||
notebook will wrap back to the first page. Likewise, if the NoteBook
|
||
is on the first page, and gtk_notebook_prev_page() is called, the
|
||
notebook will wrap to the last page.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_next_page( GtkNoteBook *notebook );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_notebook_prev_page( GtkNoteBook *notebook );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This next function sets the "active" page. If you wish the notebook to
|
||
be opened to page 5 for example, you would use this function. Without
|
||
using this function, the notebook defaults to the first page.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_set_current_page( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
gint page_num );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next two functions add or remove the notebook page tabs and the
|
||
notebook border respectively.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_set_show_tabs( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
gboolean show_tabs );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_notebook_set_show_border( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
gboolean show_border );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next function is useful when the you have a large number of pages,
|
||
and the tabs don't fit on the page. It allows the tabs to be scrolled
|
||
through using two arrow buttons.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_notebook_set_scrollable( GtkNotebook *notebook,
|
||
gboolean scrollable );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>show_tabs</literal>, <literal>show_border</literal> and <literal>scrollable</literal> can be either
|
||
TRUE or FALSE.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now let's look at an example, it is expanded from the
|
||
<filename>testgtk.c</filename> code
|
||
that comes with the GTK distribution. This small program creates a
|
||
window with a notebook and six buttons. The notebook contains 11
|
||
pages, added in three different ways, appended, inserted, and
|
||
prepended. The buttons allow you rotate the tab positions, add/remove
|
||
the tabs and border, remove a page, change pages in both a forward and
|
||
backward manner, and exit the program.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/notebook.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start notebook notebook.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* This function rotates the position of the tabs */
|
||
static void rotate_book( GtkButton *button,
|
||
GtkNotebook *notebook )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_notebook_set_tab_pos (notebook, (notebook->tab_pos + 1) % 4);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add/Remove the page tabs and the borders */
|
||
static void tabsborder_book( GtkButton *button,
|
||
GtkNotebook *notebook )
|
||
{
|
||
gint tval = FALSE;
|
||
gint bval = FALSE;
|
||
if (notebook->show_tabs == 0)
|
||
tval = TRUE;
|
||
if (notebook->show_border == 0)
|
||
bval = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
gtk_notebook_set_show_tabs (notebook, tval);
|
||
gtk_notebook_set_show_border (notebook, bval);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove a page from the notebook */
|
||
static void remove_book( GtkButton *button,
|
||
GtkNotebook *notebook )
|
||
{
|
||
gint page;
|
||
|
||
page = gtk_notebook_get_current_page (notebook);
|
||
gtk_notebook_remove_page (notebook, page);
|
||
/* Need to refresh the widget --
|
||
This forces the widget to redraw itself. */
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw (GTK_WIDGET (notebook));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean delete( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkWidget *event,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_main_quit ();
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
GtkWidget *table;
|
||
GtkWidget *notebook;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
GtkWidget *checkbutton;
|
||
int i;
|
||
char bufferf[32];
|
||
char bufferl[32];
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
table = gtk_table_new (3, 6, FALSE);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), table);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new notebook, place the position of the tabs */
|
||
notebook = gtk_notebook_new ();
|
||
gtk_notebook_set_tab_pos (GTK_NOTEBOOK (notebook), GTK_POS_TOP);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), notebook, 0, 6, 0, 1);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (notebook);
|
||
|
||
/* Let's append a bunch of pages to the notebook */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 5; i++) {
|
||
sprintf(bufferf, "Append Frame %d", i + 1);
|
||
sprintf(bufferl, "Page %d", i + 1);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new (bufferf);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), 10);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (frame, 100, 75);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (frame);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new (bufferf);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new (bufferl);
|
||
gtk_notebook_append_page (GTK_NOTEBOOK (notebook), frame, label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now let's add a page to a specific spot */
|
||
checkbutton = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Check me please!");
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (checkbutton, 100, 75);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (checkbutton);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("Add page");
|
||
gtk_notebook_insert_page (GTK_NOTEBOOK (notebook), checkbutton, label, 2);
|
||
|
||
/* Now finally let's prepend pages to the notebook */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 5; i++) {
|
||
sprintf (bufferf, "Prepend Frame %d", i + 1);
|
||
sprintf (bufferl, "PPage %d", i + 1);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new (bufferf);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), 10);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (frame, 100, 75);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (frame);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new (bufferf);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), label);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new (bufferl);
|
||
gtk_notebook_prepend_page (GTK_NOTEBOOK (notebook), frame, label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set what page to start at (page 4) */
|
||
gtk_notebook_set_current_page (GTK_NOTEBOOK (notebook), 3);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a bunch of buttons */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("close");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (delete), NULL);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 0, 1, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("next page");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_notebook_next_page),
|
||
notebook);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 1, 2, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("prev page");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_notebook_prev_page),
|
||
notebook);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 2, 3, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("tab position");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (rotate_book),
|
||
notebook);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 3, 4, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("tabs/border on/off");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (tabsborder_book),
|
||
notebook);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 4, 5, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("remove page");
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (remove_book),
|
||
notebook);
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (table), button, 5, 6, 1, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (table);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>I hope this helps you on your way with creating notebooks for your
|
||
GTK applications.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-MenuWidget">
|
||
<title>Menu Widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are two ways to create menus: there's the easy way, and there's
|
||
the hard way. Both have their uses, but you can usually use the
|
||
Itemfactory (the easy way). The "hard" way is to create all the menus
|
||
using the calls directly. The easy way is to use the gtk_item_factory
|
||
calls. This is much simpler, but there are advantages and
|
||
disadvantages to each approach.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Itemfactory is much easier to use, and to add new menus to,
|
||
although writing a few wrapper functions to create menus using the
|
||
manual method could go a long way towards usability. With the
|
||
Itemfactory, it is not possible to add images or the character '/' to
|
||
the menus.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ManualMenuCreation">
|
||
<title>Manual Menu Creation</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>In the true tradition of teaching, we'll show you the hard way
|
||
first. <literal>:)</literal></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are three widgets that go into making a menubar and submenus:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>a menu item, which is what the user wants to select, e.g.,
|
||
"Save"</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>a menu, which acts as a container for the menu items, and</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>a menubar, which is a container for each of the individual
|
||
menus.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is slightly complicated by the fact that menu item widgets are
|
||
used for two different things. They are both the widgets that are
|
||
packed into the menu, and the widget that is packed into the menubar,
|
||
which, when selected, activates the menu.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Let's look at the functions that are used to create menus and
|
||
menubars. This first function is used to create a new menubar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_menu_bar_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This rather self explanatory function creates a new menubar. You use
|
||
gtk_container_add() to pack this into a window, or the box_pack
|
||
functions to pack it into a box - the same as buttons.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_menu_new( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This function returns a pointer to a new menu; it is never actually
|
||
shown (with gtk_widget_show()), it is just a container for the menu
|
||
items. I hope this will become more clear when you look at the
|
||
example below.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The next three calls are used to create menu items that are packed into
|
||
the menu (and menubar).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_menu_item_new( void );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_menu_item_new_with_label( const char *label );
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *gtk_menu_item_new_with_mnemonic( const char *label );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>These calls are used to create the menu items that are to be
|
||
displayed. Remember to differentiate between a "menu" as created with
|
||
gtk_menu_new() and a "menu item" as created by the gtk_menu_item_new()
|
||
functions. The menu item will be an actual button with an associated
|
||
action, whereas a menu will be a container holding menu items.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The gtk_menu_item_new_with_label() and gtk_menu_item_new() functions are just as
|
||
you'd expect after reading about the buttons. One creates a new menu
|
||
item with a label already packed into it, and the other just creates a
|
||
blank menu item.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once you've created a menu item you have to put it into a menu. This
|
||
is done using the function gtk_menu_shelll_append. In order to capture when
|
||
the item is selected by the user, we need to connect to the
|
||
<literal>activate</literal> signal in the usual way. So, if we wanted to create a
|
||
standard <literal>File</literal> menu, with the options <literal>Open</literal>, <literal>Save</literal>, and
|
||
<literal>Quit</literal>, the code would look something like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
file_menu = gtk_menu_new (); /* Don't need to show menus */
|
||
|
||
/* Create the menu items */
|
||
open_item = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label ("Open");
|
||
save_item = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label ("Save");
|
||
quit_item = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
|
||
/* Add them to the menu */
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (file_menu), open_item);
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (file_menu), save_item);
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (file_menu), quit_item);
|
||
|
||
/* Attach the callback functions to the activate signal */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (open_item, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (menuitem_response),
|
||
(gpointer) "file.open");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (save_item, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (menuitem_response),
|
||
(gpointer) "file.save");
|
||
|
||
/* We can attach the Quit menu item to our exit function */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (quit_item, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (destroy),
|
||
(gpointer) "file.quit");
|
||
|
||
/* We do need to show menu items */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (open_item);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (save_item);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (quit_item);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>At this point we have our menu. Now we need to create a menubar and a
|
||
menu item for the <literal>File</literal> entry, to which we add our menu. The code
|
||
looks like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
menu_bar = gtk_menu_bar_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), menu_bar);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (menu_bar);
|
||
|
||
file_item = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label ("File");
|
||
gtk_widget_show (file_item);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now we need to associate the menu with <literal>file_item</literal>. This is done
|
||
with the function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_menu_item_set_submenu( GtkMenuItem *menu_item,
|
||
GtkWidget *submenu );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>So, our example would continue with</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (file_item), file_menu);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>All that is left to do is to add the menu to the menubar, which is
|
||
accomplished using the function</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_menu_bar_append( GtkMenuBar *menu_bar,
|
||
GtkWidget *menu_item );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>which in our case looks like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_menu_bar_append (GTK_MENU_BAR (menu_bar), file_item);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we wanted the menu right justified on the menubar, such as help
|
||
menus often are, we can use the following function (again on
|
||
<literal>file_item</literal> in the current example) before attaching it to the
|
||
menubar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_menu_item_right_justify( GtkMenuItem *menu_item );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is a summary of the steps needed to create a menu bar with menus
|
||
attached:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Create a new menu using gtk_menu_new()</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Use multiple calls to gtk_menu_item_new() for each item you
|
||
wish to have on your menu. And use gtk_menu_shell_append() to put each of
|
||
these new items on to the menu.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Create a menu item using gtk_menu_item_new(). This will be the
|
||
root of the menu, the text appearing here will be on the menubar
|
||
itself.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Use gtk_menu_item_set_submenu() to attach the menu to the root
|
||
menu item (the one created in the above step).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Create a new menubar using gtk_menu_bar_new. This step only
|
||
needs to be done once when creating a series of menus on one menu bar.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Use gtk_menu_bar_append() to put the root menu onto the menubar.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a popup menu is nearly the same. The difference is that the
|
||
menu is not posted "automatically" by a menubar, but explicitly by
|
||
calling the function gtk_menu_popup() from a button-press event, for
|
||
example. Take these steps:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Create an event handling function. It needs to have the
|
||
prototype</simpara>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean handler( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
<simpara>and it will use the event to find out where to pop up the menu.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>In the event handler, if the event is a mouse button press,
|
||
treat <literal>event</literal> as a button event (which it is) and use it as
|
||
shown in the sample code to pass information to gtk_menu_popup().</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Bind that event handler to a widget with</simpara>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (widget, "event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (handler),
|
||
menu);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
<simpara>where <literal>widget</literal> is the widget you are binding to,
|
||
<literal>handler</literal> is the handling function, and <literal>menu</literal> is a menu
|
||
created with gtk_menu_new(). This can be a menu which is also posted
|
||
by a menu bar, as shown in the sample code.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ManualMenuExample">
|
||
<title>Manual Menu Example</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>That should about do it. Let's take a look at an example to help clarify.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/menu.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start menu menu.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static gboolean button_press (GtkWidget *, GdkEvent *);
|
||
static void menuitem_response (gchar *);
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *menu;
|
||
GtkWidget *menu_bar;
|
||
GtkWidget *root_menu;
|
||
GtkWidget *menu_items;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
char buf[128];
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* create a new window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (window), 200, 100);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "GTK Menu Test");
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "delete-event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Init the menu-widget, and remember -- never
|
||
* gtk_show_widget() the menu widget!!
|
||
* This is the menu that holds the menu items, the one that
|
||
* will pop up when you click on the "Root Menu" in the app */
|
||
menu = gtk_menu_new ();
|
||
|
||
/* Next we make a little loop that makes three menu-entries for "test-menu".
|
||
* Notice the call to gtk_menu_shell_append. Here we are adding a list of
|
||
* menu items to our menu. Normally, we'd also catch the "clicked"
|
||
* signal on each of the menu items and setup a callback for it,
|
||
* but it's omitted here to save space. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 3; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Copy the names to the buf. */
|
||
sprintf (buf, "Test-undermenu - %d", i);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new menu-item with a name... */
|
||
menu_items = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (buf);
|
||
|
||
/* ...and add it to the menu. */
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu), menu_items);
|
||
|
||
/* Do something interesting when the menuitem is selected */
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (menu_items, "activate",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (menuitem_response),
|
||
(gpointer) g_strdup (buf));
|
||
|
||
/* Show the widget */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (menu_items);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This is the root menu, and will be the label
|
||
* displayed on the menu bar. There won't be a signal handler attached,
|
||
* as it only pops up the rest of the menu when pressed. */
|
||
root_menu = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label ("Root Menu");
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (root_menu);
|
||
|
||
/* Now we specify that we want our newly created "menu" to be the menu
|
||
* for the "root menu" */
|
||
gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (root_menu), menu);
|
||
|
||
/* A vbox to put a menu and a button in: */
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a menu-bar to hold the menus and add it to our main window */
|
||
menu_bar = gtk_menu_bar_new ();
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), menu_bar, FALSE, FALSE, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (menu_bar);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a button to which to attach menu as a popup */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("press me");
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (button_press),
|
||
menu);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, TRUE, TRUE, 2);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
/* And finally we append the menu-item to the menu-bar -- this is the
|
||
* "root" menu-item I have been raving about =) */
|
||
gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menu_bar), root_menu);
|
||
|
||
/* always display the window as the last step so it all splashes on
|
||
* the screen at once. */
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Respond to a button-press by posting a menu passed in as widget.
|
||
*
|
||
* Note that the "widget" argument is the menu being posted, NOT
|
||
* the button that was pressed.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
static gboolean button_press( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event )
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
if (event->type == GDK_BUTTON_PRESS) {
|
||
GdkEventButton *bevent = (GdkEventButton *) event;
|
||
gtk_menu_popup (GTK_MENU (widget), NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL,
|
||
bevent->button, bevent->time);
|
||
/* Tell calling code that we have handled this event; the buck
|
||
* stops here. */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Tell calling code that we have not handled this event; pass it on. */
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Print a string when a menu item is selected */
|
||
|
||
static void menuitem_response( gchar *string )
|
||
{
|
||
printf ("%s\n", string);
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You may also set a menu item to be insensitive and, using an accelerator
|
||
table, bind keys to menu functions.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-UsingItemFactory">
|
||
<title>Using ItemFactory</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now that we've shown you the hard way, here's how you do it using the
|
||
gtk_item_factory calls.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>ItemFactory creates a menu out of an array of ItemFactory entries. This
|
||
means you can define your menu in its simplest form and then create the
|
||
menu/menubar widgets with a minimum of function calls.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-ItemFactoryEntries">
|
||
<title>ItemFactory entries</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>At the core of ItemFactory is the ItemFactoryEntry. This structure defines
|
||
one menu item, and when an array of these entries is defined a whole
|
||
menu is formed. The ItemFactory entry struct definition looks like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkItemFactoryEntry
|
||
{
|
||
gchar *path;
|
||
gchar *accelerator;
|
||
|
||
GtkItemFactoryCallback callback;
|
||
guint callback_action;
|
||
|
||
gchar *item_type;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Each field defines part of the menu item.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>*path</literal> is a string which defines both the name and the
|
||
path of a menu item, for example, "/File/Open" would be the name of a menu
|
||
item which would come under the ItemFactory entry with path "/File". Note however
|
||
that "/File/Open" would be displayed in the File menu as "Open". Also note
|
||
since the forward slashes are used to define the path of the menu,
|
||
they cannot be used as part of the name. A letter preceded by an underscore
|
||
indicates an accelerator (shortcut) key once the menu is open.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>*accelerator</literal> is a string that indicates a key combination
|
||
that can be used as a shortcut to that menu item. The string can be made up
|
||
of either a single character, or a combination of modifier keys with a single
|
||
character. It is case insensitive.</para>
|
||
|
||
|
||
<para>The available modifier keys are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
"<ALT> - alt
|
||
"<CTL>" or "<CTRL>" or "<CONTROL>" - control
|
||
"<MOD1>" to "<MOD5>" - modn
|
||
"<SHFT>" or "<SHIFT>" - shift
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Examples:</para>
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
"<ConTroL>a"
|
||
"<SHFT><ALT><CONTROL>X"
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>callback</literal> is the function that is called when the menu item
|
||
emits the "activate" signal. The form of the callback is described
|
||
in the <link linkend="sec-ItemFactoryCallback">Callback Description</link>
|
||
section.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
The value of <literal>callback_action</literal> is passed to the callback
|
||
function. It also affects the function prototype, as shown
|
||
in the <link linkend="sec-ItemFactoryCallback">Callback Description</link>
|
||
section.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>item_type</literal> is a string that defines what type of widget is
|
||
packed into the menu items container. It can be:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
NULL or "" or "<Item>" - create a simple item
|
||
"<Title>" - create a title item
|
||
"<CheckItem>" - create a check item
|
||
"<ToggleItem>" - create a toggle item
|
||
"<RadioItem>" - create a (root) radio item
|
||
"Path" - create a sister radio item
|
||
"<Tearoff>" - create a tearoff
|
||
"<Separator>" - create a separator
|
||
"<Branch>" - create an item to hold submenus (optional)
|
||
"<LastBranch>" - create a right justified branch
|
||
"<StockItem>" - create a simple item with a stock image.
|
||
see <filename>gtkstock.h</filename> for builtin stock items
|
||
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that <LastBranch> is only useful for one submenu of
|
||
a menubar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect3 id="sec-ItemFactoryCallback">
|
||
<title>Callback Description</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
The callback for an ItemFactory entry can take two forms. If
|
||
<literal>callback_action</literal> is zero, it is of the following
|
||
form:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void callback( void )
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>otherwise it is of the form:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void callback( gpointer callback_data,
|
||
guint callback_action,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget )
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>callback_data</literal> is a pointer to an arbitrary piece of data and
|
||
is set during the call to gtk_item_factory_create_items().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>callback_action</literal> is the same value as
|
||
<literal>callback_action</literal> in the ItemFactory entry.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<literal>*widget</literal> is a pointer to a menu item widget
|
||
(described in <link linkend="sec-ManualMenuCreation">Manual Menu Creation</link>).
|
||
</para>
|
||
</sect3>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect3 id="sec-ItemFactoryEntryExamples">
|
||
<title>ItemFactory entry examples</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a simple menu item:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry entry = {"/_File/_Open...", "<CTRL>O", print_hello,
|
||
0, "<Item>"};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This will define a new simple menu entry "/File/Open" (displayed as "Open"),
|
||
under the menu entry "/File". It has the accelerator (shortcut) control+'O'
|
||
that when clicked calls the function print_hello(). print_hello() is of
|
||
the form <literal>void print_hello(void)</literal> since the callback_action
|
||
field is zero. When displayed the 'O' in "Open" will be underlined and if the
|
||
menu item is visible on the screen pressing 'O' will activate the item. Note
|
||
that "File/_Open" could also have been used as the path instead of
|
||
"/_File/_Open".</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating an entry with a more complex callback:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry entry = {"/_View/Display _FPS", NULL, print_state,
|
||
7,"<CheckItem>"};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This defines a new menu item displayed as "Display FPS" which is under
|
||
the menu item "View". When clicked the function print_state() will be called.
|
||
Since <literal>callback_action</literal> is not zero print_state() is of the
|
||
form:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void print_state( gpointer callback_data,
|
||
guint callback_action,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget )
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>with <literal>callback_action</literal> equal to 7.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creating a radio button set:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry entry1 = {"/_View/_Low Resolution", NULL, change_resolution,
|
||
1, "<RadioButton>"};
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry entry2 = {"/_View/_High Resolution", NULL, change_resolution,
|
||
2, "/View/Low Resolution"};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>entry1</literal> defines a lone radio button that when toggled
|
||
calls the function change_resolution() with the parameter
|
||
<literal>callback_action</literal> equal to 1. change_resolution() is of
|
||
the form:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void change_resolution(gpointer callback_data,
|
||
guint callback_action,
|
||
GtkWidget *widget)
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>entry2</literal> defines a radio button that belongs to the
|
||
radio group that entry1 belongs to. It calls the same function when toggled
|
||
but with the parameter <literal>callback_action</literal> equal to 2. Note that
|
||
the item_type of <literal>entry2</literal> is the path of entry1
|
||
<emphasis>without</emphasis> the accelerators ('_'). If another radio button was
|
||
required in the same group then it would be defined in the same way as
|
||
<literal>entry2</literal> was with its <literal>item_type</literal> again
|
||
equal to "/View/Low Resolution".</para>
|
||
</sect3>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect3 id="sec-ItemFactoryEntryArrays">
|
||
<title>ItemFactoryEntry Arrays</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>An ItemFactoryEntry on it's own however isn't useful. An array of
|
||
entries is what's required to define a menu. Below is an example of how
|
||
you'd declare this array.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static GtkItemFactoryEntry entries[] = {
|
||
{ "/_File", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Branch>" },
|
||
{ "/File/tear1", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Tearoff>" },
|
||
{ "/File/_New", "<CTRL>N", new_file, 1, "<Item>" },
|
||
{ "/File/_Open...", "<CTRL>O", open_file, 1, "<Item>" },
|
||
{ "/File/sep1", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Separator>" },
|
||
{ "/File/_Quit", "<CTRL>Q", quit_program, 0, "<StockItem>", GTK_STOCK_QUIT } };
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
</sect3>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-ItemFactoryCreation">
|
||
<title>Creating an ItemFactory</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>An array of GtkItemFactoryEntry items defines a menu. Once this
|
||
array is defined then the item factory can be created. The function that
|
||
does this is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkItemFactory* gtk_item_factory_new( GtkType container_type,
|
||
const gchar *path,
|
||
GtkAccelGroup *accel_group );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>container_type</literal> can be one of:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_TYPE_MENU
|
||
GTK_TYPE_MENU_BAR
|
||
GTK_TYPE_OPTION_MENU
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>container_type</literal> defines what type of menu
|
||
you want, so when you extract it later it is either a menu (for pop-ups
|
||
for instance), a menu bar, or an option menu (like a combo box but with
|
||
a menu of pull downs).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>path</literal> defines the path of the root of the menu.
|
||
Basically it is a unique name for the root of the menu, it must be
|
||
surrounded by "<>". This is important for the naming of the
|
||
accelerators and should be unique. It should be unique both for each
|
||
menu and between each program. For example in a program named 'foo', the
|
||
main menu should be called "<FooMain>", and a pop-up menu
|
||
"<FooImagePopUp>", or similar. What's important is that they're unique.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>accel_group</literal> is a pointer to a gtk_accel_group. The
|
||
item factory sets up the accelerator table while generating menus. New
|
||
accelerator groups are generated by gtk_accel_group_new().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>But this is just the first step. To convert the array of GtkItemFactoryEntry
|
||
information into widgets the following function is used:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_item_factory_create_items( GtkItemFactory *ifactory,
|
||
guint n_entries,
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry *entries,
|
||
gpointer callback_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>*ifactory</literal> a pointer to the above created item factory.</para>
|
||
<para><literal>n_entries</literal> is the number of entries in the
|
||
GtkItemFactoryEntry array.</para>
|
||
<para><literal>*entries</literal> is a pointer to the GtkItemFactoryEntry array.</para>
|
||
<para><literal>callback_data</literal> is what gets passed to all the callback functions
|
||
for all the entries with callback_action != 0.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The accelerator group has now been formed, so you'll probably want
|
||
to attach it to the window the menu is in:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_window_add_accel_group( GtkWindow *window,
|
||
GtkAccelGroup *accel_group);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-UsingMenuandItems">
|
||
<title>Making use of the menu and its menu items</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The last thing to do is make use of the menu. The following function
|
||
extracts the relevant widgets from the ItemFactory:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_item_factory_get_widget( GtkItemFactory *ifactory,
|
||
const gchar *path );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>For instance if an ItemFactory has two entries "/File" and "/File/New",
|
||
using a path of "/File" would retrieve a <emphasis>menu</emphasis> widget from the
|
||
ItemFactory. Using a path of "/File/New" would retrieve a
|
||
<emphasis>menu item</emphasis> widget. This makes it possible to set the initial state
|
||
of menu items. For example to set the default radio
|
||
item to the one with the path "/Shape/Oval" then the following code would
|
||
be used:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_check_menu_item_set_active(
|
||
GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (gtk_item_factory_get_item (item_factory, "/Shape/Oval")),
|
||
TRUE);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Finally to retrieve the root of the menu use gtk_item_factory_get_item()
|
||
with a path of "<main>" (or whatever path was used in
|
||
gtk_item_factory_new()). In the case of the ItemFactory being created with
|
||
type GTK_TYPE_MENU_BAR this returns a menu bar widget. With type GTK_TYPE_MENU
|
||
a menu widget is returned. With type GTK_TYPE_OPTION_MENU an option menu
|
||
widget is returned.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><emphasis>Remember</emphasis> for an entry defined with path "/_File"
|
||
the path here is actually "/File".</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now you have a menubar or menu which can be manipulated in the same
|
||
way as shown in the
|
||
<link linkend="sec-ManualMenuCreation">Manual Menu Creation</link>
|
||
section.</para>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ItemFactoryExample">
|
||
<title>Item Factory Example</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here is an example using the GTK item factory.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start menu itemfactory.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Obligatory basic callback */
|
||
static void print_hello( GtkWidget *w,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_message ("Hello, World!\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For the check button */
|
||
static void print_toggle( gpointer callback_data,
|
||
guint callback_action,
|
||
GtkWidget *menu_item )
|
||
{
|
||
g_message ("Check button state - %d\n",
|
||
GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (menu_item)->active);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For the radio buttons */
|
||
static void print_selected( gpointer callback_data,
|
||
guint callback_action,
|
||
GtkWidget *menu_item )
|
||
{
|
||
if(GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM(menu_item)->active)
|
||
g_message ("Radio button %d selected\n", callback_action);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Our menu, an array of GtkItemFactoryEntry structures that defines each menu item */
|
||
static GtkItemFactoryEntry menu_items[] = {
|
||
{ "/_File", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Branch>" },
|
||
{ "/File/_New", "<control>N", print_hello, 0, "<StockItem>", GTK_STOCK_NEW },
|
||
{ "/File/_Open", "<control>O", print_hello, 0, "<StockItem>", GTK_STOCK_OPEN },
|
||
{ "/File/_Save", "<control>S", print_hello, 0, "<StockItem>", GTK_STOCK_SAVE },
|
||
{ "/File/Save _As", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Item>" },
|
||
{ "/File/sep1", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Separator>" },
|
||
{ "/File/_Quit", "<CTRL>Q", gtk_main_quit, 0, "<StockItem>", GTK_STOCK_QUIT },
|
||
{ "/_Options", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Branch>" },
|
||
{ "/Options/tear", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Tearoff>" },
|
||
{ "/Options/Check", NULL, print_toggle, 1, "<CheckItem>" },
|
||
{ "/Options/sep", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Separator>" },
|
||
{ "/Options/Rad1", NULL, print_selected, 1, "<RadioItem>" },
|
||
{ "/Options/Rad2", NULL, print_selected, 2, "/Options/Rad1" },
|
||
{ "/Options/Rad3", NULL, print_selected, 3, "/Options/Rad1" },
|
||
{ "/_Help", NULL, NULL, 0, "<LastBranch>" },
|
||
{ "/_Help/About", NULL, NULL, 0, "<Item>" },
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static gint nmenu_items = sizeof (menu_items) / sizeof (menu_items[0]);
|
||
|
||
/* Returns a menubar widget made from the above menu */
|
||
static GtkWidget *get_menubar_menu( GtkWidget *window )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkItemFactory *item_factory;
|
||
GtkAccelGroup *accel_group;
|
||
|
||
/* Make an accelerator group (shortcut keys) */
|
||
accel_group = gtk_accel_group_new ();
|
||
|
||
/* Make an ItemFactory (that makes a menubar) */
|
||
item_factory = gtk_item_factory_new (GTK_TYPE_MENU_BAR, "<main>",
|
||
accel_group);
|
||
|
||
/* This function generates the menu items. Pass the item factory,
|
||
the number of items in the array, the array itself, and any
|
||
callback data for the the menu items. */
|
||
gtk_item_factory_create_items (item_factory, nmenu_items, menu_items, NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Attach the new accelerator group to the window. */
|
||
gtk_window_add_accel_group (GTK_WINDOW (window), accel_group);
|
||
|
||
/* Finally, return the actual menu bar created by the item factory. */
|
||
return gtk_item_factory_get_widget (item_factory, "<main>");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Popup the menu when the popup button is pressed */
|
||
static gboolean popup_cb( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEvent *event,
|
||
GtkWidget *menu )
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventButton *bevent = (GdkEventButton *)event;
|
||
|
||
/* Only take button presses */
|
||
if (event->type != GDK_BUTTON_PRESS)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Show the menu */
|
||
gtk_menu_popup (GTK_MENU(menu), NULL, NULL,
|
||
NULL, NULL, bevent->button, bevent->time);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Same as with get_menubar_menu() but just return a button with a signal to
|
||
call a popup menu */
|
||
GtkWidget *get_popup_menu( void )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkItemFactory *item_factory;
|
||
GtkWidget *button, *menu;
|
||
|
||
/* Same as before but don't bother with the accelerators */
|
||
item_factory = gtk_item_factory_new (GTK_TYPE_MENU, "<main>",
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_item_factory_create_items (item_factory, nmenu_items, menu_items, NULL);
|
||
menu = gtk_item_factory_get_widget (item_factory, "<main>");
|
||
|
||
/* Make a button to activate the popup menu */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Popup");
|
||
/* Make the menu popup when clicked */
|
||
g_signal_connect (button,
|
||
"event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK(popup_cb),
|
||
(gpointer) menu);
|
||
|
||
return button;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Same again but return an option menu */
|
||
GtkWidget *get_option_menu( void )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkItemFactory *item_factory;
|
||
GtkWidget *option_menu;
|
||
|
||
/* Same again, not bothering with the accelerators */
|
||
item_factory = gtk_item_factory_new (GTK_TYPE_OPTION_MENU, "<main>",
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_item_factory_create_items (item_factory, nmenu_items, menu_items, NULL);
|
||
option_menu = gtk_item_factory_get_widget (item_factory, "<main>");
|
||
|
||
return option_menu;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* You have to start somewhere */
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *main_vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *menubar, *option_menu, *popup_button;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize GTK */
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Make a window */
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW(window), "Item Factory");
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET(window), 300, 200);
|
||
|
||
/* Make a vbox to put the three menus in */
|
||
main_vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 1);
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (main_vbox), 1);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), main_vbox);
|
||
|
||
/* Get the three types of menu */
|
||
/* Note: all three menus are separately created, so they are not the
|
||
same menu */
|
||
menubar = get_menubar_menu (window);
|
||
popup_button = get_popup_menu ();
|
||
option_menu = get_option_menu ();
|
||
|
||
/* Pack it all together */
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), menubar, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), popup_button, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end (GTK_BOX (main_vbox), option_menu, FALSE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Show the widgets */
|
||
gtk_widget_show_all (window);
|
||
|
||
/* Finished! */
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-UndocWidgets">
|
||
<title>Undocumented Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>These all require authors! :) Please consider contributing to our
|
||
tutorial.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you must use one of these widgets that are undocumented, I strongly
|
||
suggest you take a look at their respective header files in the GTK
|
||
distribution. GTK's function names are very descriptive. Once you
|
||
have an understanding of how things work, it's not difficult to figure
|
||
out how to use a widget simply by looking at its function
|
||
declarations. This, along with a few examples from others' code, and
|
||
it should be no problem.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When you do come to understand all the functions of a new undocumented
|
||
widget, please consider writing a tutorial on it so others may benefit
|
||
from your time.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-AccelLabel">
|
||
<title>Accel Label</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-OptionMenu">
|
||
<title>Option Menu</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-MenuItems">
|
||
<title>Menu Items</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-CheckMenuItem">
|
||
<title>Check Menu Item</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-RadioMenuItem">
|
||
<title>Radio Menu Item</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-SeparatorMenuItem">
|
||
<title>Separator Menu Item</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-TearoffMenuItem">
|
||
<title>Tearoff Menu Item</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Curves">
|
||
<title>Curves</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DrawingArea">
|
||
<title>Drawing Area</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-FontSelectionDialog">
|
||
<title>Font Selection Dialog</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-MessageDialog">
|
||
<title>Message Dialog</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GammaCurve">
|
||
<title>Gamma Curve</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Image">
|
||
<title>Image</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-PlugsAndSockets">
|
||
<title>Plugs and Sockets</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TreeView">
|
||
<title>Tree View</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TextView">
|
||
<title>Text View</title>
|
||
|
||
<para></para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-SettingWidgetAttributes">
|
||
<title>Setting Widget Attributes</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>This describes the functions used to operate on widgets. These can be
|
||
used to set style, padding, size, etc.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>(Maybe I should make a whole section on accelerators.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_widget_activate( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_name( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gchar *name );
|
||
|
||
gchar *gtk_widget_get_name( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_sensitive( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gboolean sensitive );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_style( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkStyle *style );
|
||
|
||
GtkStyle *gtk_widget_get_style( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
|
||
GtkStyle *gtk_widget_get_default_style( void );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_size_request( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint width,
|
||
gint height );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_grab_focus( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_show( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_widget_hide( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Timeouts">
|
||
<title>Timeouts, IO and Idle Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Timeouts">
|
||
<title>Timeouts</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>You may be wondering how you make GTK do useful work when in gtk_main.
|
||
Well, you have several options. Using the following function you can
|
||
create a timeout function that will be called every "interval"
|
||
milliseconds.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint g_timeout_add (guint32 interval,
|
||
GtkFunction function,
|
||
gpointer data);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The first argument is the number of milliseconds between calls to your
|
||
function. The second argument is the function you wish to have called,
|
||
and the third, the data passed to this callback function. The return
|
||
value is an integer "tag" which may be used to stop the timeout by
|
||
calling:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_source_remove (gint tag);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>You may also stop the timeout function by returning zero or FALSE from
|
||
your callback function. Obviously this means if you want your function
|
||
to continue to be called, it should return a non-zero value,
|
||
i.e., TRUE.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The declaration of your callback should look something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint timeout_callback (gpointer data);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-MonitoringIO">
|
||
<title>Monitoring IO</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>A nifty feature of GDK (the library that underlies GTK), is the
|
||
ability to have it check for data on a file descriptor for you (as
|
||
returned by open(2) or socket(2)). This is especially useful for
|
||
networking applications. The function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gint gdk_input_add( gint source,
|
||
GdkInputCondition condition,
|
||
GdkInputFunction function,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Where the first argument is the file descriptor you wish to have
|
||
watched, and the second specifies what you want GDK to look for. This
|
||
may be one of:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>GDK_INPUT_READ</literal> - Call your function when there is data
|
||
ready for reading on your file descriptor.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>GDK_INPUT_WRITE</literal> - Call your function when the file
|
||
descriptor is ready for writing.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>As I'm sure you've figured out already, the third argument is the
|
||
function you wish to have called when the above conditions are
|
||
satisfied, and the fourth is the data to pass to this function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The return value is a tag that may be used to stop GDK from monitoring
|
||
this file descriptor using the following function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gdk_input_remove( gint tag );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The callback function should be declared as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void input_callback( gpointer data,
|
||
gint source,
|
||
GdkInputCondition condition );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Where <literal>source</literal> and <literal>condition</literal> are as specified above.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-IdleFunctions">
|
||
<title>Idle Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<para><!-- TODO: Need to check on idle priorities - TRG -->
|
||
What if you have a function which you want to be called when nothing
|
||
else is happening ?</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
guint g_idle_add( GSourceFunc function,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This causes GTK to call the specified function whenever nothing else
|
||
is happening.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_source_remove( guint tag );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>I won't explain the meaning of the arguments as they follow very much
|
||
like the ones above. The function pointed to by the first argument to
|
||
g_idle_add will be called whenever the opportunity arises. As with
|
||
the others, returning FALSE will stop the idle function from being
|
||
called.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-AdvancedEventsAndSignals">
|
||
<title>Advanced Event and Signal Handling</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SignalFunctions">
|
||
<title>Signal Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Connecting and Disconnecting Signal Handlers</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect( GObject *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer func_data );
|
||
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect_after( GObject *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer func_data );
|
||
|
||
gulong g_signal_connect_swapped( GObject *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
GObject *slot_object );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handler_disconnect( GObject *object,
|
||
gulong handler_id );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func( GObject *object,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Blocking and Unblocking Signal Handlers</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_signal_handler_block( GObject *object,
|
||
gulong handler_id);
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handlers_block_by_func( GObject *object,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handler_unblock( GObject *object,
|
||
gulong handler_id );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_handler_unblock_by_func( GObject *object,
|
||
GCallback func,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Emitting and Stopping Signals</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_signal_emit( GObject *object,
|
||
guint signal_id,
|
||
... );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_emit_by_name( GObject *object,
|
||
const gchar *name,
|
||
... );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_emitv( const GValue *instance_and_params,
|
||
guint signal_id,
|
||
GQuark detail,
|
||
GValue *return_value );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_stop_emission( GObject *object,
|
||
guint signal_id,
|
||
GQuark detail );
|
||
|
||
void g_signal_stop_emission_by_name( GObject *object,
|
||
const gchar *detailed_signal );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SignalEmissionAndPropagation">
|
||
<title>Signal Emission and Propagation</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Signal emission is the process whereby GTK runs all handlers for a
|
||
specific object and signal.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>First, note that the return value from a signal emission is the return
|
||
value of the <emphasis>last</emphasis> handler executed. Since event signals are
|
||
all of type <literal>GTK_RUN_LAST</literal>, this will be the default (GTK supplied)
|
||
handler, unless you connect with gtk_signal_connect_after().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The way an event (say "button_press_event") is handled, is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Start with the widget where the event occured.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Emit the generic "event" signal. If that signal handler returns
|
||
a value of TRUE, stop all processing.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Otherwise, emit a specific, "button_press_event" signal. If that
|
||
returns TRUE, stop all processing.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Otherwise, go to the widget's parent, and repeat the above two
|
||
steps.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Continue until some signal handler returns TRUE, or until the
|
||
top-level widget is reached.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>Some consequences of the above are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Your handler's return value will have no effect if there is a
|
||
default handler, unless you connect with gtk_signal_connect_after().</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>To prevent the default handler from being run, you need to
|
||
connect with gtk_signal_connect() and use
|
||
gtk_signal_emit_stop_by_name() - the return value only affects whether
|
||
the signal is propagated, not the current emission.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- continue GTK+ 2.0 review here -->
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-ManagingSelections">
|
||
<title>Managing Selections</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SelectionsOverview">
|
||
<title>Overview</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>One type of interprocess communication supported by X and GTK is
|
||
<emphasis>selections</emphasis>. A selection identifies a chunk of data, for
|
||
instance, a portion of text, selected by the user in some fashion, for
|
||
instance, by dragging with the mouse. Only one application on a
|
||
display (the <emphasis>owner</emphasis>) can own a particular selection at one
|
||
time, so when a selection is claimed by one application, the previous
|
||
owner must indicate to the user that selection has been
|
||
relinquished. Other applications can request the contents of a
|
||
selection in different forms, called <emphasis>targets</emphasis>. There can be
|
||
any number of selections, but most X applications only handle one, the
|
||
<emphasis>primary selection</emphasis>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In most cases, it isn't necessary for a GTK application to deal with
|
||
selections itself. The standard widgets, such as the Entry widget,
|
||
already have the capability to claim the selection when appropriate
|
||
(e.g., when the user drags over text), and to retrieve the contents of
|
||
the selection owned by another widget or another application (e.g.,
|
||
when the user clicks the second mouse button). However, there may be
|
||
cases in which you want to give other widgets the ability to supply
|
||
the selection, or you wish to retrieve targets not supported by
|
||
default.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A fundamental concept needed to understand selection handling is that
|
||
of the <emphasis>atom</emphasis>. An atom is an integer that uniquely identifies a
|
||
string (on a certain display). Certain atoms are predefined by the X
|
||
server, and in some cases there are constants in <literal>gtk.h</literal>
|
||
corresponding to these atoms. For instance the constant
|
||
<literal>GDK_PRIMARY_SELECTION</literal> corresponds to the string "PRIMARY".
|
||
In other cases, you should use the functions
|
||
<literal>gdk_atom_intern()</literal>, to get the atom corresponding to a string,
|
||
and <literal>gdk_atom_name()</literal>, to get the name of an atom. Both
|
||
selections and targets are identified by atoms.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-RetrievingTheSelection">
|
||
<title>Retrieving the selection</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Retrieving the selection is an asynchronous process. To start the
|
||
process, you call:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gboolean gtk_selection_convert( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkAtom selection,
|
||
GdkAtom target,
|
||
guint32 time );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This <emphasis>converts</emphasis> the selection into the form specified by
|
||
<literal>target</literal>. If at all possible, the time field should be the time
|
||
from the event that triggered the selection. This helps make sure that
|
||
events occur in the order that the user requested them. However, if it
|
||
is not available (for instance, if the conversion was triggered by a
|
||
"clicked" signal), then you can use the constant
|
||
<literal>GDK_CURRENT_TIME</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When the selection owner responds to the request, a
|
||
"selection_received" signal is sent to your application. The handler
|
||
for this signal receives a pointer to a <literal>GtkSelectionData</literal>
|
||
structure, which is defined as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkSelectionData
|
||
{
|
||
GdkAtom selection;
|
||
GdkAtom target;
|
||
GdkAtom type;
|
||
gint format;
|
||
guchar *data;
|
||
gint length;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>selection</literal> and <literal>target</literal> are the values you gave in your
|
||
<literal>gtk_selection_convert()</literal> call. <literal>type</literal> is an atom that
|
||
identifies the type of data returned by the selection owner. Some
|
||
possible values are "STRING", a string of latin-1 characters, "ATOM",
|
||
a series of atoms, "INTEGER", an integer, etc. Most targets can only
|
||
return one type. <literal>format</literal> gives the length of the units (for
|
||
instance characters) in bits. Usually, you don't care about this when
|
||
receiving data. <literal>data</literal> is a pointer to the returned data, and
|
||
<literal>length</literal> gives the length of the returned data, in bytes. If
|
||
<literal>length</literal> is negative, then an error occurred and the selection
|
||
could not be retrieved. This might happen if no application owned the
|
||
selection, or if you requested a target that the application didn't
|
||
support. The buffer is actually guaranteed to be one byte longer than
|
||
<literal>length</literal>; the extra byte will always be zero, so it isn't
|
||
necessary to make a copy of strings just to nul-terminate them.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In the following example, we retrieve the special target "TARGETS",
|
||
which is a list of all targets into which the selection can be
|
||
converted.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start selection gettargets.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
static void selection_received( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
/* Signal handler invoked when user clicks on the "Get Targets" button */
|
||
static void get_targets( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
static GdkAtom targets_atom = GDK_NONE;
|
||
GtkWidget *window = (GtkWidget *)data;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the atom corresponding to the string "TARGETS" */
|
||
if (targets_atom == GDK_NONE)
|
||
targets_atom = gdk_atom_intern ("TARGETS", FALSE);
|
||
|
||
/* And request the "TARGETS" target for the primary selection */
|
||
gtk_selection_convert (window, GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY, targets_atom,
|
||
GDK_CURRENT_TIME);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Signal handler called when the selections owner returns the data */
|
||
static void selection_received( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
GdkAtom *atoms;
|
||
GList *item_list;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
/* **** IMPORTANT **** Check to see if retrieval succeeded */
|
||
if (selection_data->length < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Selection retrieval failed\n");
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Make sure we got the data in the expected form */
|
||
if (selection_data->type != GDK_SELECTION_TYPE_ATOM)
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Selection \"TARGETS\" was not returned as atoms!\n");
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print out the atoms we received */
|
||
atoms = (GdkAtom *)selection_data->data;
|
||
|
||
item_list = NULL;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < selection_data->length / sizeof(GdkAtom); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
char *name;
|
||
name = gdk_atom_name (atoms[i]);
|
||
if (name != NULL)
|
||
g_print ("%s\n",name);
|
||
else
|
||
g_print ("(bad atom)\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the toplevel window */
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Event Box");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a button the user can click to get targets */
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Get Targets");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), button);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (get_targets), (gpointer) window);
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "selection_received",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (selection_received), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SupplyingTheSelection">
|
||
<title>Supplying the selection</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Supplying the selection is a bit more complicated. You must register
|
||
handlers that will be called when your selection is requested. For
|
||
each selection/target pair you will handle, you make a call to:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_selection_add_target( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkAtom selection,
|
||
GdkAtom target,
|
||
guint info );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>widget</literal>, <literal>selection</literal>, and <literal>target</literal> identify the requests
|
||
this handler will manage. When a request for a selection is received,
|
||
the "selection_get" signal will be called. <literal>info</literal> can be used as an
|
||
enumerator to identify the specific target within the callback function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The callback function has the signature:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void "selection_get"( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
|
||
guint info,
|
||
guint time );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GtkSelectionData is the same as above, but this time, we're
|
||
responsible for filling in the fields <literal>type</literal>, <literal>format</literal>,
|
||
<literal>data</literal>, and <literal>length</literal>. (The <literal>format</literal> field is actually
|
||
important here - the X server uses it to figure out whether the data
|
||
needs to be byte-swapped or not. Usually it will be 8 - <emphasis>i.e.</emphasis> a
|
||
character - or 32 - <emphasis>i.e.</emphasis> an integer.) This is done by calling the
|
||
function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_selection_data_set( GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
|
||
GdkAtom type,
|
||
gint format,
|
||
guchar *data,
|
||
gint length );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This function takes care of properly making a copy of the data so that
|
||
you don't have to worry about keeping it around. (You should not fill
|
||
in the fields of the GtkSelectionData structure by hand.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When prompted by the user, you claim ownership of the selection by
|
||
calling:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gboolean gtk_selection_owner_set( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkAtom selection,
|
||
guint32 time );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>If another application claims ownership of the selection, you will
|
||
receive a "selection_clear_event".</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As an example of supplying the selection, the following program adds
|
||
selection functionality to a toggle button. When the toggle button is
|
||
depressed, the program claims the primary selection. The only target
|
||
supported (aside from certain targets like "TARGETS" supplied by GTK
|
||
itself), is the "STRING" target. When this target is requested, a
|
||
string representation of the time is returned.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start selection setselection.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
#include <time.h>
|
||
#include <string.h>
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *selection_button;
|
||
GtkWidget *selection_widget;
|
||
|
||
/* Callback when the user toggles the selection */
|
||
static void selection_toggled( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint *have_selection )
|
||
{
|
||
if (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget)->active)
|
||
{
|
||
*have_selection = gtk_selection_owner_set (selection_widget,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY,
|
||
GDK_CURRENT_TIME);
|
||
/* if claiming the selection failed, we return the button to
|
||
the out state */
|
||
if (!*have_selection)
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (widget), FALSE);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (*have_selection)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Before clearing the selection by setting the owner to NULL,
|
||
we check if we are the actual owner */
|
||
if (gdk_selection_owner_get (GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY) == widget->window)
|
||
gtk_selection_owner_set (NULL, GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY,
|
||
GDK_CURRENT_TIME);
|
||
*have_selection = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Called when another application claims the selection */
|
||
static gboolean selection_clear( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventSelection *event,
|
||
gint *have_selection )
|
||
{
|
||
*have_selection = FALSE;
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (selection_button), FALSE);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Supplies the current time as the selection. */
|
||
static void selection_handle( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
|
||
guint info,
|
||
guint time_stamp,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
gchar *timestr;
|
||
time_t current_time;
|
||
|
||
current_time = time (NULL);
|
||
timestr = asctime (localtime (&current_time));
|
||
/* When we return a single string, it should not be null terminated.
|
||
That will be done for us */
|
||
|
||
gtk_selection_data_set (selection_data, GDK_SELECTION_TYPE_STRING,
|
||
8, timestr, strlen (timestr));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
|
||
static int have_selection = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the toplevel window */
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Event Box");
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a toggle button to act as the selection */
|
||
|
||
selection_widget = gtk_invisible_new ();
|
||
selection_button = gtk_toggle_button_new_with_label ("Claim Selection");
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), selection_button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (selection_button);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (selection_button, "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (selection_toggled), (gpointer) &have_selection);
|
||
g_signal_connect (selection_widget, "selection_clear_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (selection_clear), (gpointer) &have_selection);
|
||
|
||
gtk_selection_add_target (selection_widget,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_TYPE_STRING,
|
||
1);
|
||
g_signal_connect (selection_widget, "selection_get",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (selection_handle), (gpointer) &have_selection);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (selection_button);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-DragAngDrop">
|
||
<title>Drag-and-drop (DND)</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK+ has a high level set of functions for doing inter-process
|
||
communication via the drag-and-drop system. GTK+ can perform
|
||
drag-and-drop on top of the low level Xdnd and Motif drag-and-drop
|
||
protocols.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DragAndDropOverview">
|
||
<title>Overview</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>An application capable of GTK+ drag-and-drop first defines and sets up
|
||
the GTK+ widget(s) for drag-and-drop. Each widget can be a source
|
||
and/or destination for drag-and-drop. Note that these GTK+ widgets must have
|
||
an associated X Window, check using GTK_WIDGET_NO_WINDOW(widget)).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Source widgets can send out drag data, thus allowing the user to drag
|
||
things off of them, while destination widgets can receive drag data.
|
||
Drag-and-drop destinations can limit who they accept drag data from,
|
||
e.g. the same application or any application (including itself).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Sending and receiving drop data makes use of GTK+ signals.
|
||
Dropping an item to a destination widget requires both a data
|
||
request (for the source widget) and data received signal handler (for
|
||
the target widget). Additional signal handers can be connected if you
|
||
want to know when a drag begins (at the very instant it starts), to
|
||
when a drop is made, and when the entire drag-and-drop procedure has
|
||
ended (successfully or not).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Your application will need to provide data for source widgets when
|
||
requested, that involves having a drag data request signal handler. For
|
||
destination widgets they will need a drop data received signal
|
||
handler. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para>So a typical drag-and-drop cycle would look as follows:</para>
|
||
<orderedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drag begins.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drag data request (when a drop occurs).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drop data received (may be on same or different
|
||
application).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drag data delete (if the drag was a move).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drag-and-drop procedure done.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</orderedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are a few minor steps that go in between here and there, but we
|
||
will get into detail about that later.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DragAndDropProperties">
|
||
<title>Properties</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Drag data has the following properties:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Drag action type (ie GDK_ACTION_COPY, GDK_ACTION_MOVE).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Client specified arbitrary drag-and-drop type (a name and number pair).</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Sent and received data format type.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>Drag actions are quite obvious, they specify if the widget can
|
||
drag with the specified action(s), e.g. GDK_ACTION_COPY and/or
|
||
GDK_ACTION_MOVE. A GDK_ACTION_COPY would be a typical drag-and-drop
|
||
without the source data being deleted while GDK_ACTION_MOVE would be
|
||
just like GDK_ACTION_COPY but the source data will be 'suggested' to be
|
||
deleted after the received signal handler is called. There are
|
||
additional drag actions including GDK_ACTION_LINK which you may want to
|
||
look into when you get to more advanced levels of drag-and-drop.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The client specified arbitrary drag-and-drop type is much more
|
||
flexible, because your application will be defining and checking for
|
||
that specifically. You will need to set up your destination widgets to
|
||
receive certain drag-and-drop types by specifying a name and/or number.
|
||
It would be more reliable to use a name since another application may
|
||
just happen to use the same number for an entirely different
|
||
meaning.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Sent and received data format types (<emphasis>selection
|
||
target</emphasis>) come into play only in your request and received
|
||
data handler functions. The term <emphasis>selection target</emphasis>
|
||
is somewhat misleading. It is a term adapted from GTK+ selection
|
||
(cut/copy and paste). What <emphasis>selection target</emphasis>
|
||
actually means is the data's format type (i.e. GdkAtom, integer, or
|
||
string) that being sent or received. Your request data handler function
|
||
needs to specify the type (<emphasis>selection target</emphasis>) of
|
||
data that it sends out and your received data handler needs to handle
|
||
the type (<emphasis>selection target</emphasis>) of data
|
||
received.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DragAndDropFunctions">
|
||
<title>Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-DNDSourceWidgets">
|
||
<title>Setting up the source widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function <literal>gtk_drag_source_set()</literal> specifies a
|
||
set of target types for a drag operation on a widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_drag_source_set( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkModifierType start_button_mask,
|
||
const GtkTargetEntry *targets,
|
||
gint n_targets,
|
||
GdkDragAction actions );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The parameters signify the following:</para>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>widget</literal> specifies the drag source
|
||
widget</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>start_button_mask</literal> specifies a
|
||
bitmask of buttons that can start the drag (e.g. GDK_BUTTON1_MASK)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>targets</literal> specifies a table of
|
||
target data types the drag will support</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>n_targets</literal> specifies the number of
|
||
targets above</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara><literal>actions</literal> specifies a bitmask of
|
||
possible actions for a drag from this window</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>targets</literal> parameter is an array of the
|
||
following structure:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct GtkTargetEntry {
|
||
gchar *target;
|
||
guint flags;
|
||
guint info;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The fields specify a string representing the drag type, optional
|
||
flags and application assigned integer identifier.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If a widget is no longer required to act as a source for
|
||
drag-and-drop operations, the function
|
||
<literal>gtk_drag_source_unset()</literal> can be used to remove a set
|
||
of drag-and-drop target types.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_drag_source_unset( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-SignalsOnSourceWidgets">
|
||
<title>Signals on the source widget:</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The source widget is sent the following signals during a
|
||
drag-and-drop operation.</para>
|
||
|
||
<table pgwide="1">
|
||
<title>Source widget signals</title>
|
||
<tgroup cols="2">
|
||
<colspec colname="Name" colwidth="150">
|
||
<colspec colname="Prototype">
|
||
<tbody>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_begin</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>void (*drag_begin)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_motion</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>gboolean (*drag_motion)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gint x, gint y, guint t, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_data_get</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>void (*drag_data_get)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, GtkSelectionData *selection_data, guint info, guint t, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_data_delete</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>void (*drag_data_delete)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_drop</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>gboolean (*drag_drop)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gint x, gint y, guint t, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_end</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>void (*drag_end)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
</tbody>
|
||
</tgroup>
|
||
</table>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-DNDDestWidgets">
|
||
<title>Setting up a destination widget:</title>
|
||
|
||
<para> <literal> gtk_drag_dest_set()</literal> specifies
|
||
that this widget can receive drops and specifies what types of drops it
|
||
can receive.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para> <literal> gtk_drag_dest_unset()</literal> specifies
|
||
that the widget can no longer receive drops.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_drag_dest_set( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkDestDefaults flags,
|
||
const GtkTargetEntry *targets,
|
||
gint n_targets,
|
||
GdkDragAction actions );
|
||
|
||
void gtk_drag_dest_unset( GtkWidget *widget );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-SignalsOnDestWidgets">
|
||
<title>Signals on the destination widget:</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The destination widget is sent the following signals during a
|
||
drag-and-drop operation.</para>
|
||
|
||
<table pgwide="1">
|
||
<title>Destination widget signals</title>
|
||
<tgroup cols="2">
|
||
<colspec colname="Name" colwidth="150">
|
||
<colspec colname="Prototype">
|
||
<tbody>
|
||
<row>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle">drag_data_received</entry>
|
||
<entry align="left" valign="middle"><literal>void (*drag_data_received)(GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkDragContext *dc, gint x, gint y, GtkSelectionData *selection_data, guint info, guint t,
|
||
gpointer data)</literal></entry>
|
||
</row>
|
||
</tbody>
|
||
</tgroup>
|
||
</table>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-GLib">
|
||
<title>GLib</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GLib is a lower-level library that provides many useful definitions
|
||
and functions available for use when creating GDK and GTK
|
||
applications. These include definitions for basic types and their
|
||
limits, standard macros, type conversions, byte order, memory
|
||
allocation, warnings and assertions, message logging, timers, string
|
||
utilities, hook functions, a lexical scanner, dynamic loading of
|
||
modules, and automatic string completion. A number of data structures
|
||
(and their related operations) are also defined, including memory
|
||
chunks, doubly-linked lists, singly-linked lists, hash tables, strings
|
||
(which can grow dynamically), string chunks (groups of strings),
|
||
arrays (which can grow in size as elements are added), balanced binary
|
||
trees, N-ary trees, quarks (a two-way association of a string and a
|
||
unique integer identifier), keyed data lists (lists of data elements
|
||
accessible by a string or integer id), relations and tuples (tables of
|
||
data which can be indexed on any number of fields), and caches.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A summary of some of GLib's capabilities follows; not every function,
|
||
data structure, or operation is covered here. For more complete
|
||
information about the GLib routines, see the GLib documentation. One
|
||
source of GLib documentation is <ulink url="http://www.gtk.org/">http://www.gtk.org/</ulink>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you are using a language other than C, you should consult your
|
||
language's binding documentation. In some cases your language may
|
||
have equivalent functionality built-in, while in other cases it may
|
||
not.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Definitions">
|
||
<title>Definitions</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Definitions for the extremes of many of the standard types are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
G_MINFLOAT
|
||
G_MAXFLOAT
|
||
G_MINDOUBLE
|
||
G_MAXDOUBLE
|
||
G_MINSHORT
|
||
G_MAXSHORT
|
||
G_MAXUSHORT
|
||
G_MININT
|
||
G_MAXINT
|
||
G_MAXUINT
|
||
G_MINLONG
|
||
G_MAXLONG
|
||
G_MAXULONG
|
||
G_MININT64
|
||
G_MAXINT64
|
||
G_MAXUINT64
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Also, the following typedefs. The ones left unspecified are dynamically set
|
||
depending on the architecture. Remember to avoid counting on the size of a
|
||
pointer if you want to be portable! E.g., a pointer on an Alpha is 8
|
||
bytes, but 4 on Intel 80x86 family CPUs.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
char gchar;
|
||
short gshort;
|
||
long glong;
|
||
int gint;
|
||
int gboolean;
|
||
|
||
unsigned char guchar;
|
||
unsigned short gushort;
|
||
unsigned long gulong;
|
||
unsigned int guint;
|
||
|
||
float gfloat;
|
||
double gdouble;
|
||
|
||
unsigned int gsize;
|
||
signed int gssize;
|
||
|
||
void* gpointer;
|
||
const void* gconstpointer;
|
||
|
||
gint8
|
||
guint8
|
||
gint16
|
||
guint16
|
||
gint32
|
||
guint32
|
||
gint64
|
||
guint64
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-DoublyLinkedLists">
|
||
<title>Doubly Linked Lists</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following functions are used to create, manage, and destroy
|
||
standard doubly linked lists. Each element in the list contains a
|
||
piece of data, together with pointers which link to the previous and
|
||
next elements in the list. This enables easy movement in either
|
||
direction through the list. The data item is of type "gpointer",
|
||
which means the data can be a pointer to your real data or (through
|
||
casting) a numeric value (but do not assume that int and gpointer have
|
||
the same size!). These routines internally allocate list elements in
|
||
blocks, which is more efficient than allocating elements individually.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There is no function to specifically create a list. Instead, simply
|
||
create a variable of type GList* and set its value to NULL; NULL is
|
||
considered to be the empty list.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To add elements to a list, use the g_list_append(), g_list_prepend(),
|
||
g_list_insert(), or g_list_insert_sorted() routines. In all cases
|
||
they accept a pointer to the beginning of the list, and return the
|
||
(possibly changed) pointer to the beginning of the list. Thus, for
|
||
all of the operations that add or remove elements, be sure to save the
|
||
returned value!</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_append( GList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This adds a new element (with value <literal>data</literal>) onto the end of the
|
||
list.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_prepend( GList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This adds a new element (with value <literal>data</literal>) to the beginning of the
|
||
list.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_insert( GList *list,
|
||
gpointer data,
|
||
gint position );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This inserts a new element (with value data) into the list at the
|
||
given position. If position is 0, this is just like g_list_prepend();
|
||
if position is less than 0, this is just like g_list_append().</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_remove( GList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This removes the element in the list with the value <literal>data</literal>;
|
||
if the element isn't there, the list is unchanged.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_list_free( GList *list );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This frees all of the memory used by a GList. If the list elements
|
||
refer to dynamically-allocated memory, then they should be freed
|
||
first.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are many other GLib functions that support doubly linked lists;
|
||
see the glib documentation for more information. Here are a few of
|
||
the more useful functions' signatures:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *g_list_remove_link( GList *list,
|
||
GList *link );
|
||
|
||
GList *g_list_reverse( GList *list );
|
||
|
||
GList *g_list_nth( GList *list,
|
||
gint n );
|
||
|
||
GList *g_list_find( GList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
GList *g_list_last( GList *list );
|
||
|
||
GList *g_list_first( GList *list );
|
||
|
||
gint g_list_length( GList *list );
|
||
|
||
void g_list_foreach( GList *list,
|
||
GFunc func,
|
||
gpointer user_data );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-SinglyLinkedLists">
|
||
<title>Singly Linked Lists</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Many of the above functions for singly linked lists are identical to the
|
||
above. Here is a list of some of their operations:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GSList *g_slist_append( GSList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_prepend( GSList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_insert( GSList *list,
|
||
gpointer data,
|
||
gint position );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_remove( GSList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_remove_link( GSList *list,
|
||
GSList *link );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_reverse( GSList *list );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_nth( GSList *list,
|
||
gint n );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_find( GSList *list,
|
||
gpointer data );
|
||
|
||
GSList *g_slist_last( GSList *list );
|
||
|
||
gint g_slist_length( GSList *list );
|
||
|
||
void g_slist_foreach( GSList *list,
|
||
GFunc func,
|
||
gpointer user_data );
|
||
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-MemoryManagement">
|
||
<title>Memory Management</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gpointer g_malloc( gulong size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is a replacement for malloc(). You do not need to check the return
|
||
value as it is done for you in this function. If the memory allocation
|
||
fails for whatever reasons, your applications will be terminated.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gpointer g_malloc0( gulong size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Same as above, but zeroes the memory before returning a pointer to it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gpointer g_realloc( gpointer mem,
|
||
gulong size );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Relocates "size" bytes of memory starting at "mem". Obviously, the
|
||
memory should have been previously allocated.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_free( gpointer mem );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Frees memory. Easy one. If <literal>mem</literal> is NULL it simply returns.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_mem_profile( void );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Dumps a profile of used memory, but requires that you add <literal>#define
|
||
MEM_PROFILE</literal> to the top of glib/gmem.c and re-make and make install.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_mem_check( gpointer mem );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Checks that a memory location is valid. Requires you add <literal>#define
|
||
MEM_CHECK</literal> to the top of gmem.c and re-make and make install.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Timers">
|
||
<title>Timers</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Timer functions can be used to time operations (e.g., to see how much
|
||
time has elapsed). First, you create a new timer with g_timer_new().
|
||
You can then use g_timer_start() to start timing an operation,
|
||
g_timer_stop() to stop timing an operation, and g_timer_elapsed() to
|
||
determine the elapsed time.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTimer *g_timer_new( void );
|
||
|
||
void g_timer_destroy( GTimer *timer );
|
||
|
||
void g_timer_start( GTimer *timer );
|
||
|
||
void g_timer_stop( GTimer *timer );
|
||
|
||
void g_timer_reset( GTimer *timer );
|
||
|
||
gdouble g_timer_elapsed( GTimer *timer,
|
||
gulong *microseconds );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-StringHandling">
|
||
<title>String Handling</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GLib defines a new type called a GString, which is similar to a
|
||
standard C string but one that grows automatically. Its string data
|
||
is null-terminated. What this gives you is protection from buffer
|
||
overflow programming errors within your program. This is a very
|
||
important feature, and hence I recommend that you make use of
|
||
GStrings. GString itself has a simple public definition:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct GString
|
||
{
|
||
gchar *str; /* Points to the string's current \0-terminated value. */
|
||
gint len; /* Current length */
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you might expect, there are a number of operations you can do with
|
||
a GString.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GString *g_string_new( gchar *init );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This constructs a GString, copying the string value of <literal>init</literal>
|
||
into the GString and returning a pointer to it. NULL may be given as
|
||
the argument for an initially empty GString.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_string_free( GString *string,
|
||
gint free_segment );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This frees the memory for the given GString. If <literal>free_segment</literal> is
|
||
TRUE, then this also frees its character data.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GString *g_string_assign( GString *lval,
|
||
const gchar *rval );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This copies the characters from rval into lval, destroying the
|
||
previous contents of lval. Note that lval will be lengthened as
|
||
necessary to hold the string's contents, unlike the standard strcpy()
|
||
function.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The rest of these functions should be relatively obvious (the _c
|
||
versions accept a character instead of a string):</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GString *g_string_truncate( GString *string,
|
||
gint len );
|
||
|
||
GString *g_string_append( GString *string,
|
||
gchar *val );
|
||
|
||
GString *g_string_append_c( GString *string,
|
||
gchar c );
|
||
|
||
GString *g_string_prepend( GString *string,
|
||
gchar *val );
|
||
|
||
GString *g_string_prepend_c( GString *string,
|
||
gchar c );
|
||
|
||
void g_string_sprintf( GString *string,
|
||
gchar *fmt,
|
||
...);
|
||
|
||
void g_string_sprintfa ( GString *string,
|
||
gchar *fmt,
|
||
... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-UtilityAndErrorFunctions">
|
||
<title>Utility and Error Functions</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *g_strdup( const gchar *str );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Replacement strdup function. Copies the original strings contents to
|
||
newly allocated memory, and returns a pointer to it.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *g_strerror( gint errnum );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>I recommend using this for all error messages. It's much nicer, and more
|
||
portable than perror() or others. The output is usually of the form:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
program name:function that failed:file or further description:strerror
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Here's an example of one such call used in our hello_world program:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
g_print("hello_world:open:%s:%s\n", filename, g_strerror(errno));
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_error( gchar *format, ... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Prints an error message. The format is just like printf, but it
|
||
prepends "** ERROR **: " to your message, and exits the program.
|
||
Use only for fatal errors.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_warning( gchar *format, ... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Same as above, but prepends "** WARNING **: ", and does not exit the
|
||
program.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_message( gchar *format, ... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Prints "message: " prepended to the string you pass in.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void g_print( gchar *format, ... );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Replacement for printf().</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>And our last function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gchar *g_strsignal( gint signum );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Prints out the name of the Unix system signal given the signal number.
|
||
Useful in generic signal handling functions.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>All of the above are more or less just stolen from glib.h. If anyone cares
|
||
to document any function, just send me an email!</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-GTKRCFiles">
|
||
<title>GTK's rc Files</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK has its own way of dealing with application defaults, by using rc
|
||
files. These can be used to set the colors of just about any widget, and
|
||
can also be used to tile pixmaps onto the background of some widgets. </para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-FunctionsForRCFiles">
|
||
<title>Functions For rc Files</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>When your application starts, you should include a call to:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_rc_parse( char *filename );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Passing in the filename of your rc file. This will cause GTK to parse
|
||
this file, and use the style settings for the widget types defined
|
||
there.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you wish to have a special set of widgets that can take on a
|
||
different style from others, or any other logical division of widgets,
|
||
use a call to:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_name( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gchar *name );
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Passing your newly created widget as the first argument, and the name
|
||
you wish to give it as the second. This will allow you to change the
|
||
attributes of this widget by name through the rc file.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we use a call something like this:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Special Button");
|
||
gtk_widget_set_name (button, "special button");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Then this button is given the name "special button" and may be addressed by
|
||
name in the rc file as "special button.GtkButton". [<--- Verify ME!]</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The example rc file below, sets the properties of the main window, and lets
|
||
all children of that main window inherit the style described by the "main
|
||
button" style. The code used in the application is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_name (window, "main window");
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And then the style is defined in the rc file using:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
widget "main window.*GtkButton*" style "main_button"
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Which sets all the Button widgets in the "main window" to the
|
||
"main_buttons" style as defined in the rc file.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>As you can see, this is a fairly powerful and flexible system. Use your
|
||
imagination as to how best to take advantage of this.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GTKsRCFileFormat">
|
||
<title>GTK's rc File Format</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The format of the GTK file is illustrated in the example below. This is
|
||
the testgtkrc file from the GTK distribution, but I've added a
|
||
few comments and things. You may wish to include this explanation in
|
||
your application to allow the user to fine tune his application.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are several directives to change the attributes of a widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>fg - Sets the foreground color of a widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>bg - Sets the background color of a widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>bg_pixmap - Sets the background of a widget to a tiled pixmap.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>font - Sets the font to be used with the given widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>In addition to this, there are several states a widget can be in, and you
|
||
can set different colors, pixmaps and fonts for each state. These states are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>NORMAL - The normal state of a widget, without the mouse over top of
|
||
it, and not being pressed, etc.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>PRELIGHT - When the mouse is over top of the widget, colors defined
|
||
using this state will be in effect.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>ACTIVE - When the widget is pressed or clicked it will be active, and
|
||
the attributes assigned by this tag will be in effect.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>INSENSITIVE - When a widget is set insensitive, and cannot be
|
||
activated, it will take these attributes.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>SELECTED - When an object is selected, it takes these attributes.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>When using the "fg" and "bg" keywords to set the colors of widgets, the
|
||
format is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
fg[<STATE>] = { Red, Green, Blue }
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Where STATE is one of the above states (PRELIGHT, ACTIVE, etc), and the Red,
|
||
Green and Blue are values in the range of 0 - 1.0, { 1.0, 1.0, 1.0 } being
|
||
white. They must be in float form, or they will register as 0, so a straight
|
||
"1" will not work, it must be "1.0". A straight "0" is fine because it
|
||
doesn't matter if it's not recognized. Unrecognized values are set to 0.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>bg_pixmap is very similar to the above, except the colors are replaced by a
|
||
filename.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>pixmap_path is a list of paths separated by ":"'s. These paths will be
|
||
searched for any pixmap you specify.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The font directive is simply:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
font = "<font name>"
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The only hard part is figuring out the font string. Using xfontsel or
|
||
a similar utility should help.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The "widget_class" sets the style of a class of widgets. These classes are
|
||
listed in the widget overview on the class hierarchy.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The "widget" directive sets a specifically named set of widgets to a
|
||
given style, overriding any style set for the given widget class.
|
||
These widgets are registered inside the application using the
|
||
gtk_widget_set_name() call. This allows you to specify the attributes of a
|
||
widget on a per widget basis, rather than setting the attributes of an
|
||
entire widget class. I urge you to document any of these special widgets so
|
||
users may customize them.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When the keyword <literal>parent</> is used as an attribute, the widget will take on
|
||
the attributes of its parent in the application.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When defining a style, you may assign the attributes of a previously defined
|
||
style to this new one.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
style "main_button" = "button"
|
||
{
|
||
font = "-adobe-helvetica-medium-r-normal--*-100-*-*-*-*-*-*"
|
||
bg[PRELIGHT] = { 0.75, 0, 0 }
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This example takes the "button" style, and creates a new "main_button" style
|
||
simply by changing the font and prelight background color of the "button"
|
||
style.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Of course, many of these attributes don't apply to all widgets. It's a
|
||
simple matter of common sense really. Anything that could apply, should.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ExampleRCFile">
|
||
<title>Example rc file</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
# pixmap_path "<dir 1>:<dir 2>:<dir 3>:..."
|
||
#
|
||
pixmap_path "/usr/include/X11R6/pixmaps:/home/imain/pixmaps"
|
||
#
|
||
# style <name> [= <name>]
|
||
# {
|
||
# <option>
|
||
# }
|
||
#
|
||
# widget <widget_set> style <style_name>
|
||
# widget_class <widget_class_set> style <style_name>
|
||
|
||
# Here is a list of all the possible states. Note that some do not apply to
|
||
# certain widgets.
|
||
#
|
||
# NORMAL - The normal state of a widget, without the mouse over top of
|
||
# it, and not being pressed, etc.
|
||
#
|
||
# PRELIGHT - When the mouse is over top of the widget, colors defined
|
||
# using this state will be in effect.
|
||
#
|
||
# ACTIVE - When the widget is pressed or clicked it will be active, and
|
||
# the attributes assigned by this tag will be in effect.
|
||
#
|
||
# INSENSITIVE - When a widget is set insensitive, and cannot be
|
||
# activated, it will take these attributes.
|
||
#
|
||
# SELECTED - When an object is selected, it takes these attributes.
|
||
#
|
||
# Given these states, we can set the attributes of the widgets in each of
|
||
# these states using the following directives.
|
||
#
|
||
# fg - Sets the foreground color of a widget.
|
||
# fg - Sets the background color of a widget.
|
||
# bg_pixmap - Sets the background of a widget to a tiled pixmap.
|
||
# font - Sets the font to be used with the given widget.
|
||
#
|
||
|
||
# This sets a style called "button". The name is not really important, as
|
||
# it is assigned to the actual widgets at the bottom of the file.
|
||
|
||
style "window"
|
||
{
|
||
#This sets the padding around the window to the pixmap specified.
|
||
#bg_pixmap[<STATE>] = "<pixmap filename>"
|
||
bg_pixmap[NORMAL] = "warning.xpm"
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
style "scale"
|
||
{
|
||
#Sets the foreground color (font color) to red when in the "NORMAL"
|
||
#state.
|
||
|
||
fg[NORMAL] = { 1.0, 0, 0 }
|
||
|
||
#Sets the background pixmap of this widget to that of its parent.
|
||
bg_pixmap[NORMAL] = "<parent>"
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
style "button"
|
||
{
|
||
# This shows all the possible states for a button. The only one that
|
||
# doesn't apply is the SELECTED state.
|
||
|
||
fg[PRELIGHT] = { 0, 1.0, 1.0 }
|
||
bg[PRELIGHT] = { 0, 0, 1.0 }
|
||
bg[ACTIVE] = { 1.0, 0, 0 }
|
||
fg[ACTIVE] = { 0, 1.0, 0 }
|
||
bg[NORMAL] = { 1.0, 1.0, 0 }
|
||
fg[NORMAL] = { .99, 0, .99 }
|
||
bg[INSENSITIVE] = { 1.0, 1.0, 1.0 }
|
||
fg[INSENSITIVE] = { 1.0, 0, 1.0 }
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
# In this example, we inherit the attributes of the "button" style and then
|
||
# override the font and background color when prelit to create a new
|
||
# "main_button" style.
|
||
|
||
style "main_button" = "button"
|
||
{
|
||
font = "-adobe-helvetica-medium-r-normal--*-100-*-*-*-*-*-*"
|
||
bg[PRELIGHT] = { 0.75, 0, 0 }
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
style "toggle_button" = "button"
|
||
{
|
||
fg[NORMAL] = { 1.0, 0, 0 }
|
||
fg[ACTIVE] = { 1.0, 0, 0 }
|
||
|
||
# This sets the background pixmap of the toggle_button to that of its
|
||
# parent widget (as defined in the application).
|
||
bg_pixmap[NORMAL] = "<parent>"
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
style "text"
|
||
{
|
||
bg_pixmap[NORMAL] = "marble.xpm"
|
||
fg[NORMAL] = { 1.0, 1.0, 1.0 }
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
style "ruler"
|
||
{
|
||
font = "-adobe-helvetica-medium-r-normal--*-80-*-*-*-*-*-*"
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
# pixmap_path "~/.pixmaps"
|
||
|
||
# These set the widget types to use the styles defined above.
|
||
# The widget types are listed in the class hierarchy, but could probably be
|
||
# just listed in this document for the users reference.
|
||
|
||
widget_class "GtkWindow" style "window"
|
||
widget_class "GtkDialog" style "window"
|
||
widget_class "GtkFileSelection" style "window"
|
||
widget_class "*Gtk*Scale" style "scale"
|
||
widget_class "*GtkCheckButton*" style "toggle_button"
|
||
widget_class "*GtkRadioButton*" style "toggle_button"
|
||
widget_class "*GtkButton*" style "button"
|
||
widget_class "*Ruler" style "ruler"
|
||
widget_class "*GtkText" style "text"
|
||
|
||
# This sets all the buttons that are children of the "main window" to
|
||
# the main_button style. These must be documented to be taken advantage of.
|
||
widget "main window.*GtkButton*" style "main_button"
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-WritingYourOwnWidgets">
|
||
<title>Writing Your Own Widgets</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-WidgetsOverview">
|
||
<title>Overview</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Although the GTK distribution comes with many types of widgets that
|
||
should cover most basic needs, there may come a time when you need to
|
||
create your own new widget type. Since GTK uses widget inheritance
|
||
extensively, and there is already a widget that is close to what you want,
|
||
it is often possible to make a useful new widget type in
|
||
just a few lines of code. But before starting work on a new widget, check
|
||
around first to make sure that someone has not already written
|
||
it. This will prevent duplication of effort and keep the number of
|
||
GTK widgets out there to a minimum, which will help keep both the code
|
||
and the interface of different applications consistent. As a flip side
|
||
to this, once you finish your widget, announce it to the world so
|
||
other people can benefit. The best place to do this is probably the
|
||
<literal>gtk-list</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Complete sources for the example widgets are available at the place you
|
||
got this tutorial, or from:</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><ulink url="http://www.gtk.org/~otaylor/gtk/tutorial/">http://www.gtk.org/~otaylor/gtk/tutorial/</ulink></para>
|
||
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheAnatomyOfAWidget">
|
||
<title>The Anatomy Of A Widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>In order to create a new widget, it is important to have an
|
||
understanding of how GTK objects work. This section is just meant as a
|
||
brief overview. See the reference documentation for the details. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para>GTK widgets are implemented in an object oriented fashion. However,
|
||
they are implemented in standard C. This greatly improves portability
|
||
and stability over using current generation C++ compilers; however,
|
||
it does mean that the widget writer has to pay attention to some of
|
||
the implementation details. The information common to all instances of
|
||
one class of widgets (e.g., to all Button widgets) is stored in the
|
||
<emphasis>class structure</emphasis>. There is only one copy of this in
|
||
which is stored information about the class's signals
|
||
(which act like virtual functions in C). To support inheritance, the
|
||
first field in the class structure must be a copy of the parent's
|
||
class structure. The declaration of the class structure of GtkButtton
|
||
looks like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkButtonClass
|
||
{
|
||
GtkContainerClass parent_class;
|
||
|
||
void (* pressed) (GtkButton *button);
|
||
void (* released) (GtkButton *button);
|
||
void (* clicked) (GtkButton *button);
|
||
void (* enter) (GtkButton *button);
|
||
void (* leave) (GtkButton *button);
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>When a button is treated as a container (for instance, when it is
|
||
resized), its class structure can be cast to GtkContainerClass, and
|
||
the relevant fields used to handle the signals.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There is also a structure for each widget that is created on a
|
||
per-instance basis. This structure has fields to store information that
|
||
is different for each instance of the widget. We'll call this
|
||
structure the <emphasis>object structure</emphasis>. For the Button class, it looks
|
||
like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GtkButton
|
||
{
|
||
GtkContainer container;
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *child;
|
||
|
||
guint in_button : 1;
|
||
guint button_down : 1;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that, similar to the class structure, the first field is the
|
||
object structure of the parent class, so that this structure can be
|
||
cast to the parent class' object structure as needed.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-CreatingACompositeWidget">
|
||
<title>Creating a Composite widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Introduction</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>One type of widget that you may be interested in creating is a
|
||
widget that is merely an aggregate of other GTK widgets. This type of
|
||
widget does nothing that couldn't be done without creating new
|
||
widgets, but provides a convenient way of packaging user interface
|
||
elements for reuse. The FileSelection and ColorSelection widgets in
|
||
the standard distribution are examples of this type of widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The example widget that we'll create in this section is the Tictactoe
|
||
widget, a 3x3 array of toggle buttons which triggers a signal when all
|
||
three buttons in a row, column, or on one of the diagonals are
|
||
depressed. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para><emphasis>Note: the full source code for the Tictactoe example described
|
||
below is in the <link linkend="sec-Tictactoe">Code Examples Appendix</link>
|
||
</emphasis></para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/tictactoe.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Choosing a parent class</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The parent class for a composite widget is typically the container
|
||
class that holds all of the elements of the composite widget. For
|
||
example, the parent class of the FileSelection widget is the
|
||
Dialog class. Since our buttons will be arranged in a table, it
|
||
is natural to make our parent class the Table class.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The header file</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Each GObject class has a header file which declares the object and
|
||
class structures for that object, along with public functions.
|
||
A couple of features are worth pointing out. To prevent duplicate
|
||
definitions, we wrap the entire header file in:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#ifndef __TICTACTOE_H__
|
||
#define __TICTACTOE_H__
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
#endif /* __TICTACTOE_H__ */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And to keep C++ programs that include the header file happy, in:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#include <glib.h>
|
||
|
||
G_BEGIN_DECLS
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
.
|
||
G_END_DECLS
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Along with the functions and structures, we declare five standard
|
||
macros in our header file, <literal>TICTACTOE_TYPE</literal>,
|
||
<literal>TICTACTOE(obj)</literal>,
|
||
<literal>TICTACTOE_CLASS(klass)</literal>,
|
||
<literal>IS_TICTACTOE(obj)</literal>, and
|
||
<literal>IS_TICTACTOE_CLASS(klass)</literal>, which cast a
|
||
pointer into a pointer to the object or class structure, and check
|
||
if an object is a Tictactoe widget respectively.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The <literal>_get_type()</literal> function</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>We now continue on to the implementation of our widget. A core
|
||
function for every object is the function
|
||
<literal>WIDGETNAME_get_type()</literal>. This function, when first called, tells
|
||
Glib about the new class, and gets an ID that uniquely identifies
|
||
the class. Upon subsequent calls, it just returns the ID.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GType
|
||
tictactoe_get_type (void)
|
||
{
|
||
static GType ttt_type = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (!ttt_type)
|
||
{
|
||
const GTypeInfo ttt_info =
|
||
{
|
||
sizeof (TictactoeClass),
|
||
NULL, /* base_init */
|
||
NULL, /* base_finalize */
|
||
(GClassInitFunc) tictactoe_class_init,
|
||
NULL, /* class_finalize */
|
||
NULL, /* class_data */
|
||
sizeof (Tictactoe),
|
||
0, /* n_preallocs */
|
||
(GInstanceInitFunc) tictactoe_init,
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
ttt_type = g_type_register_static (GTK_TYPE_TABLE,
|
||
"Tictactoe",
|
||
&ttt_info,
|
||
0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ttt_type;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GTypeInfo structure has the following definition:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GTypeInfo
|
||
{
|
||
/* interface types, classed types, instantiated types */
|
||
guint16 class_size;
|
||
|
||
GBaseInitFunc base_init;
|
||
GBaseFinalizeFunc base_finalize;
|
||
|
||
/* classed types, instantiated types */
|
||
GClassInitFunc class_init;
|
||
GClassFinalizeFunc class_finalize;
|
||
gconstpointer class_data;
|
||
|
||
/* instantiated types */
|
||
guint16 instance_size;
|
||
guint16 n_preallocs;
|
||
GInstanceInitFunc instance_init;
|
||
|
||
/* value handling */
|
||
const GTypeValueTable *value_table;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The important fields of this structure are pretty self-explanatory.
|
||
We'll ignore the <literal>base_init</literal> and
|
||
<literal>base_finalize</literal> as well as the <literal>value_table</literal>
|
||
fields here. Once Glib has a correctly filled in copy of
|
||
this structure, it knows how to create objects of a particular type. </para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The <literal>_class_init()</literal> function</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>WIDGETNAME_class_init()</literal> function initializes the fields of
|
||
the widget's class structure, and sets up any signals for the
|
||
class. For our Tictactoe widget it looks like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
enum {
|
||
TICTACTOE_SIGNAL,
|
||
LAST_SIGNAL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
static guint tictactoe_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 };
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_class_init (TictactoeClass *klass)
|
||
{
|
||
tictactoe_signals[TICTACTOE_SIGNAL] =
|
||
g_signal_new ("tictactoe",
|
||
G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
|
||
G_STRUCT_OFFSET (TictactoeClass, tictactoe),
|
||
NULL, NULL,
|
||
g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Our widget has just one signal, the <literal>tictactoe</literal> signal that is
|
||
invoked when a row, column, or diagonal is completely filled in. Not
|
||
every composite widget needs signals, so if you are reading this for
|
||
the first time, you may want to skip to the next section now, as
|
||
things are going to get a bit complicated.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
guint g_signal_new( const gchar *signal_name,
|
||
GType itype,
|
||
GSignalFlags signal_flags,
|
||
guint class_offset,
|
||
GSignalAccumulator *accumulator,
|
||
gpointer accu_data,
|
||
GSignalCMarshaller *c_marshaller,
|
||
GType return_type,
|
||
guint n_params,
|
||
...);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Creates a new signal. The parameters are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>signal_name</literal>: The name of the signal.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>itype</literal>: The ID of the object that this signal applies
|
||
to. (It will also apply to that objects descendants.)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>signal_flags</literal>: Whether the default handler runs before or after
|
||
user handlers and other flags. Usually this will be one of
|
||
<literal>G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST</literal> or <literal>G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST</literal>,
|
||
although there are other possibilities. The flag
|
||
<literal>G_SIGNAL_ACTION</literal> specifies that no extra code needs to
|
||
run that performs special pre or post emission adjustments. This means that
|
||
the signal can also be emitted from object external code.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>class_offset</literal>: The offset within the class structure of
|
||
a pointer to the default handler.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>accumulator</literal>: For most classes this can
|
||
be set to NULL.</simpara></listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>accu_data</literal>: User data that will be handed
|
||
to the accumulator function.</simpara></listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>c_marshaller</literal>: A function that is used to invoke the signal
|
||
handler. For signal handlers that have no arguments other than the
|
||
object that emitted the signal and user data, we can use the
|
||
pre-supplied marshaller function <literal>g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID</literal>.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>return_type</literal>: The type of the return value.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>n_params</literal>: The number of parameters of the signal handler
|
||
(other than the two default ones mentioned above)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>...</literal>: The types of the parameters.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>When specifying types, the following standard types can be used:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
G_TYPE_INVALID
|
||
G_TYPE_NONE
|
||
G_TYPE_INTERFACE
|
||
G_TYPE_CHAR
|
||
G_TYPE_UCHAR
|
||
G_TYPE_BOOLEAN
|
||
G_TYPE_INT
|
||
G_TYPE_UINT
|
||
G_TYPE_LONG
|
||
G_TYPE_ULONG
|
||
G_TYPE_INT64
|
||
G_TYPE_UINT64
|
||
G_TYPE_ENUM
|
||
G_TYPE_FLAGS
|
||
G_TYPE_FLOAT
|
||
G_TYPE_DOUBLE
|
||
G_TYPE_STRING
|
||
G_TYPE_POINTER
|
||
G_TYPE_BOXED
|
||
G_TYPE_PARAM
|
||
G_TYPE_OBJECT
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>g_signal_new()</literal> returns a unique integer identifier for the
|
||
signal, that we store in the <literal>tictactoe_signals</literal> array, which we
|
||
index using an enumeration. (Conventionally, the enumeration elements
|
||
are the signal name, uppercased, but here there would be a conflict
|
||
with the <literal>TICTACTOE()</literal> macro, so we called it <literal>TICTACTOE_SIGNAL</literal>
|
||
instead.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The <literal>_init()</literal> function</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Each class also needs a function to initialize the object
|
||
structure. Usually, this function has the fairly limited role of
|
||
setting the fields of the structure to default values. For composite
|
||
widgets, however, this function also creates the component widgets.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_init (Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
gint i,j;
|
||
|
||
gtk_table_resize (GTK_TABLE (ttt), 3, 3);
|
||
gtk_table_set_homogeneous (GTK_TABLE (ttt), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
for (i=0;i<3; i++)
|
||
for (j=0;j<3; j++)
|
||
{
|
||
ttt->buttons[i][j] = gtk_toggle_button_new ();
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (ttt), ttt->buttons[i][j],
|
||
i, i+1, j, j+1);
|
||
g_signal_connect (ttt->buttons[i][j], "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (tictactoe_toggle), ttt);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (ttt->buttons[i][j], 20, 20);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (ttt->buttons[i][j]);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>And the rest...</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>There is one more function that every object (except for abstract
|
||
classes like Bin that cannot be instantiated) needs to have - the
|
||
function that the user calls to create an object of that type. This is
|
||
conventionally called <literal>OBJECTNAME_new()</literal>. In some
|
||
widgets, though not for the Tictactoe widgets, this function takes
|
||
arguments, and does some setup based on the arguments. The other two
|
||
functions are specific to the Tictactoe widget. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>tictactoe_clear()</literal> is a public function that resets all the
|
||
buttons in the widget to the up position. Note the use of
|
||
<literal>g_signal_handlers_block_matched()</literal> to keep our signal handler for
|
||
button toggles from being triggered unnecessarily.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>tictactoe_toggle()</literal> is the signal handler that is invoked when the
|
||
user clicks on a button. It checks to see if there are any winning
|
||
combinations that involve the toggled button, and if so, emits
|
||
the "tictactoe" signal.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget*
|
||
tictactoe_new (void)
|
||
{
|
||
return GTK_WIDGET ( g_object_new (TICTACTOE_TYPE, NULL));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
tictactoe_clear (Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
int i,j;
|
||
|
||
for (i=0;i<3;i++)
|
||
for (j=0;j<3;j++)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_handlers_block_matched (G_OBJECT (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_MATCH_DATA,
|
||
0, 0, NULL, NULL, ttt);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
FALSE);
|
||
g_signal_handlers_unblock_matched (G_OBJECT (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_MATCH_DATA,
|
||
0, 0, NULL, NULL, ttt);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_toggle (GtkWidget *widget, Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
int i,k;
|
||
|
||
static int rwins[8][3] = { { 0, 0, 0 }, { 1, 1, 1 }, { 2, 2, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 } };
|
||
static int cwins[8][3] = { { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 0, 0 }, { 1, 1, 1 }, { 2, 2, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 2, 1, 0 } };
|
||
|
||
int success, found;
|
||
|
||
for (k=0; k<8; k++)
|
||
{
|
||
success = TRUE;
|
||
found = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
for (i=0;i<3;i++)
|
||
{
|
||
success = success &&
|
||
GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON(ttt->buttons[rwins[k][i]][cwins[k][i]])->active;
|
||
found = found ||
|
||
ttt->buttons[rwins[k][i]][cwins[k][i]] == widget;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (success && found)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_emit (ttt,
|
||
tictactoe_signals[TICTACTOE_SIGNAL], 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>And finally, an example program using our Tictactoe widget:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
#include "tictactoe.h"
|
||
|
||
/* Invoked when a row, column or diagonal is completed */
|
||
void
|
||
win (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Yay!\n");
|
||
tictactoe_clear (TICTACTOE (widget));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
main (int argc, char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *ttt;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Aspect Frame");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new Tictactoe widget */
|
||
ttt = tictactoe_new ();
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), ttt);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (ttt);
|
||
|
||
/* And attach to its "tictactoe" signal */
|
||
g_signal_connect (ttt, "tictactoe",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (win), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-CreatingAWidgetFromScratch">
|
||
<title>Creating a widget from scratch</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Introduction</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>In this section, we'll learn more about how widgets display themselves
|
||
on the screen and interact with events. As an example of this, we'll
|
||
create an analog dial widget with a pointer that the user can drag to
|
||
set the value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/gtkdial.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Displaying a widget on the screen</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are several steps that are involved in displaying on the screen.
|
||
After the widget is created with a call to <literal>WIDGETNAME_new()</literal>,
|
||
several more functions are needed:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>WIDGETNAME_realize()</literal> is responsible for creating an X
|
||
window for the widget if it has one.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>WIDGETNAME_map()</literal> is invoked after the user calls
|
||
<literal>gtk_widget_show()</literal>. It is responsible for making sure the widget
|
||
is actually drawn on the screen (<emphasis>mapped</emphasis>). For a container class,
|
||
it must also make calls to <literal>map()</literal> functions of any child widgets.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>WIDGETNAME_draw()</literal> is invoked when <literal>gtk_widget_draw()</literal>
|
||
is called for the widget or one of its ancestors. It makes the actual
|
||
calls to the drawing functions to draw the widget on the screen. For
|
||
container widgets, this function must make calls to
|
||
<literal>gtk_widget_draw()</literal> for its child widgets.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> <literal>WIDGETNAME_expose()</literal> is a handler for expose events for the
|
||
widget. It makes the necessary calls to the drawing functions to draw
|
||
the exposed portion on the screen. For container widgets, this
|
||
function must generate expose events for its child widgets which don't
|
||
have their own windows. (If they have their own windows, then X will
|
||
generate the necessary expose events.)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>You might notice that the last two functions are quite similar - each
|
||
is responsible for drawing the widget on the screen. In fact many
|
||
types of widgets don't really care about the difference between the
|
||
two. The default <literal>draw()</literal> function in the widget class simply
|
||
generates a synthetic expose event for the redrawn area. However, some
|
||
types of widgets can save work by distinguishing between the two
|
||
functions. For instance, if a widget has multiple X windows, then
|
||
since expose events identify the exposed window, it can redraw only
|
||
the affected window, which is not possible for calls to <literal>draw()</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Container widgets, even if they don't care about the difference for
|
||
themselves, can't simply use the default <literal>draw()</literal> function because
|
||
their child widgets might care about the difference. However,
|
||
it would be wasteful to duplicate the drawing code between the two
|
||
functions. The convention is that such widgets have a function called
|
||
<literal>WIDGETNAME_paint()</literal> that does the actual work of drawing the
|
||
widget, that is then called by the <literal>draw()</literal> and <literal>expose()</literal>
|
||
functions.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>In our example approach, since the dial widget is not a container
|
||
widget, and only has a single window, we can take the simplest
|
||
approach and use the default <literal>draw()</literal> function and only implement
|
||
an <literal>expose()</literal> function.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The origins of the Dial Widget</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Just as all land animals are just variants on the first amphibian that
|
||
crawled up out of the mud, GTK widgets tend to start off as variants
|
||
of some other, previously written widget. Thus, although this section
|
||
is entitled "Creating a Widget from Scratch", the Dial widget really
|
||
began with the source code for the Range widget. This was picked as a
|
||
starting point because it would be nice if our Dial had the same
|
||
interface as the Scale widgets which are just specialized descendants
|
||
of the Range widget. So, though the source code is presented below in
|
||
finished form, it should not be implied that it was written, <emphasis>ab
|
||
initio</emphasis> in this fashion. Also, if you aren't yet familiar with
|
||
how scale widgets work from the application writer's point of view, it
|
||
would be a good idea to look them over before continuing.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>The Basics</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Quite a bit of our widget should look pretty familiar from the
|
||
Tictactoe widget. First, we have a header file:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the Free
|
||
* Software Foundation, Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
#ifndef __GTK_DIAL_H__
|
||
#define __GTK_DIAL_H__
|
||
|
||
#include <gdk/gdk.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkadjustment.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkwidget.h>
|
||
|
||
|
||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||
extern "C" {
|
||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||
|
||
|
||
#define GTK_DIAL(obj) GTK_CHECK_CAST (obj, gtk_dial_get_type (), GtkDial)
|
||
#define GTK_DIAL_CLASS(klass) GTK_CHECK_CLASS_CAST (klass, gtk_dial_get_type (), GtkDialClass)
|
||
#define GTK_IS_DIAL(obj) GTK_CHECK_TYPE (obj, gtk_dial_get_type ())
|
||
|
||
|
||
typedef struct _GtkDial GtkDial;
|
||
typedef struct _GtkDialClass GtkDialClass;
|
||
|
||
struct _GtkDial
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget widget;
|
||
|
||
/* update policy (GTK_UPDATE_[CONTINUOUS/DELAYED/DISCONTINUOUS]) */
|
||
guint policy : 2;
|
||
|
||
/* Button currently pressed or 0 if none */
|
||
guint8 button;
|
||
|
||
/* Dimensions of dial components */
|
||
gint radius;
|
||
gint pointer_width;
|
||
|
||
/* ID of update timer, or 0 if none */
|
||
guint32 timer;
|
||
|
||
/* Current angle */
|
||
gfloat angle;
|
||
|
||
/* Old values from adjustment stored so we know when something changes */
|
||
gfloat old_value;
|
||
gfloat old_lower;
|
||
gfloat old_upper;
|
||
|
||
/* The adjustment object that stores the data for this dial */
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GtkDialClass
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidgetClass parent_class;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_dial_new (GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
GtkType gtk_dial_get_type (void);
|
||
GtkAdjustment* gtk_dial_get_adjustment (GtkDial *dial);
|
||
void gtk_dial_set_update_policy (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy);
|
||
|
||
void gtk_dial_set_adjustment (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||
|
||
|
||
#endif /* __GTK_DIAL_H__ */
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Since there is quite a bit more going on in this widget than the last
|
||
one, we have more fields in the data structure, but otherwise things
|
||
are pretty similar.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Next, after including header files and declaring a few constants,
|
||
we have some functions to provide information about the widget
|
||
and initialize it:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
#include <math.h>
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkmain.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtksignal.h>
|
||
|
||
#include "gtkdial.h"
|
||
|
||
#define SCROLL_DELAY_LENGTH 300
|
||
#define DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE 100
|
||
|
||
/* Forward declarations */
|
||
|
||
[ omitted to save space ]
|
||
|
||
/* Local data */
|
||
|
||
static GtkWidgetClass *parent_class = NULL;
|
||
|
||
GtkType
|
||
gtk_dial_get_type ()
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkType dial_type = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (!dial_type)
|
||
{
|
||
static const GtkTypeInfo dial_info =
|
||
{
|
||
"GtkDial",
|
||
sizeof (GtkDial),
|
||
sizeof (GtkDialClass),
|
||
(GtkClassInitFunc) gtk_dial_class_init,
|
||
(GtkObjectInitFunc) gtk_dial_init,
|
||
/* reserved_1 */ NULL,
|
||
/* reserved_1 */ NULL,
|
||
(GtkClassInitFunc) NULL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
dial_type = gtk_type_unique (GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, &dial_info);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return dial_type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_class_init (GtkDialClass *class)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkObjectClass *object_class;
|
||
GtkWidgetClass *widget_class;
|
||
|
||
object_class = (GtkObjectClass*) class;
|
||
widget_class = (GtkWidgetClass*) class;
|
||
|
||
parent_class = gtk_type_class (gtk_widget_get_type ());
|
||
|
||
object_class->destroy = gtk_dial_destroy;
|
||
|
||
widget_class->realize = gtk_dial_realize;
|
||
widget_class->expose_event = gtk_dial_expose;
|
||
widget_class->size_request = gtk_dial_size_request;
|
||
widget_class->size_allocate = gtk_dial_size_allocate;
|
||
widget_class->button_press_event = gtk_dial_button_press;
|
||
widget_class->button_release_event = gtk_dial_button_release;
|
||
widget_class->motion_notify_event = gtk_dial_motion_notify;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_init (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
dial->button = 0;
|
||
dial->policy = GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS;
|
||
dial->timer = 0;
|
||
dial->radius = 0;
|
||
dial->pointer_width = 0;
|
||
dial->angle = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_value = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_lower = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_upper = 0.0;
|
||
dial->adjustment = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget*
|
||
gtk_dial_new (GtkAdjustment *adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
dial = gtk_type_new (gtk_dial_get_type ());
|
||
|
||
if (!adjustment)
|
||
adjustment = (GtkAdjustment*) gtk_adjustment_new (0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_set_adjustment (dial, adjustment);
|
||
|
||
return GTK_WIDGET (dial);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_destroy (GtkObject *object)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (object != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (object));
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (object);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment)
|
||
gtk_object_unref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
|
||
if (GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy)
|
||
(* GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy) (object);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Note that this <literal>init()</literal> function does less than for the Tictactoe
|
||
widget, since this is not a composite widget, and the <literal>new()</literal>
|
||
function does more, since it now has an argument. Also, note that when
|
||
we store a pointer to the Adjustment object, we increment its
|
||
reference count, (and correspondingly decrement it when we no longer
|
||
use it) so that GTK can keep track of when it can be safely destroyed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Also, there are a few function to manipulate the widget's options:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAdjustment*
|
||
gtk_dial_get_adjustment (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (dial != NULL, NULL);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial), NULL);
|
||
|
||
return dial->adjustment;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
gtk_dial_set_update_policy (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
dial->policy = policy;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
gtk_dial_set_adjustment (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_signal_disconnect_by_data (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), (gpointer) dial);
|
||
gtk_object_unref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dial->adjustment = adjustment;
|
||
gtk_object_ref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (adjustment), "changed",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) gtk_dial_adjustment_changed,
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (adjustment), "value_changed",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) gtk_dial_adjustment_value_changed,
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->old_lower = adjustment->lower;
|
||
dial->old_upper = adjustment->upper;
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title><literal>gtk_dial_realize()</literal></title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Now we come to some new types of functions. First, we have a function
|
||
that does the work of creating the X window. Notice that a mask is
|
||
passed to the function <literal>gdk_window_new()</literal> which specifies which fields of
|
||
the GdkWindowAttr structure actually have data in them (the remaining
|
||
fields will be given default values). Also worth noting is the way the
|
||
event mask of the widget is created. We call
|
||
<literal>gtk_widget_get_events()</literal> to retrieve the event mask that the user
|
||
has specified for this widget (with <literal>gtk_widget_set_events()</literal>), and
|
||
add the events that we are interested in ourselves.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>After creating the window, we set its style and background, and put a
|
||
pointer to the widget in the user data field of the GdkWindow. This
|
||
last step allows GTK to dispatch events for this window to the correct
|
||
widget.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_realize (GtkWidget *widget)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkWindowAttr attributes;
|
||
gint attributes_mask;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (widget != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget));
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, TRUE);
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
attributes.x = widget->allocation.x;
|
||
attributes.y = widget->allocation.y;
|
||
attributes.width = widget->allocation.width;
|
||
attributes.height = widget->allocation.height;
|
||
attributes.wclass = GDK_INPUT_OUTPUT;
|
||
attributes.window_type = GDK_WINDOW_CHILD;
|
||
attributes.event_mask = gtk_widget_get_events (widget) |
|
||
GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK |
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK |
|
||
GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK;
|
||
attributes.visual = gtk_widget_get_visual (widget);
|
||
attributes.colormap = gtk_widget_get_colormap (widget);
|
||
|
||
attributes_mask = GDK_WA_X | GDK_WA_Y | GDK_WA_VISUAL | GDK_WA_COLORMAP;
|
||
widget->window = gdk_window_new (gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget), &attributes, attributes_mask);
|
||
|
||
widget->style = gtk_style_attach (widget->style, widget->window);
|
||
|
||
gdk_window_set_user_data (widget->window, widget);
|
||
|
||
gtk_style_set_background (widget->style, widget->window, GTK_STATE_ACTIVE);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Size negotiation</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Before the first time that the window containing a widget is
|
||
displayed, and whenever the layout of the window changes, GTK asks
|
||
each child widget for its desired size. This request is handled by the
|
||
function <literal>gtk_dial_size_request()</literal>. Since our widget isn't a
|
||
container widget, and has no real constraints on its size, we just
|
||
return a reasonable default value.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkRequisition *requisition)
|
||
{
|
||
requisition->width = DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE;
|
||
requisition->height = DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>After all the widgets have requested an ideal size, the layout of the
|
||
window is computed and each child widget is notified of its actual
|
||
size. Usually, this will be at least as large as the requested size,
|
||
but if for instance the user has resized the window, it may
|
||
occasionally be smaller than the requested size. The size notification
|
||
is handled by the function <literal>gtk_dial_size_allocate()</literal>. Notice that
|
||
as well as computing the sizes of some component pieces for future
|
||
use, this routine also does the grunt work of moving the widget's X
|
||
window into the new position and size.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkAllocation *allocation)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (widget != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget));
|
||
g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL);
|
||
|
||
widget->allocation = *allocation;
|
||
if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
|
||
{
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
gdk_window_move_resize (widget->window,
|
||
allocation->x, allocation->y,
|
||
allocation->width, allocation->height);
|
||
|
||
dial->radius = MAX(allocation->width,allocation->height) * 0.45;
|
||
dial->pointer_width = dial->radius / 5;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title><literal>gtk_dial_expose()</literal></title>
|
||
|
||
<para>As mentioned above, all the drawing of this widget is done in the
|
||
handler for expose events. There's not much to remark on here except
|
||
the use of the function <literal>gtk_draw_polygon</literal> to draw the pointer with
|
||
three dimensional shading according to the colors stored in the
|
||
widget's style.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_expose( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventExpose *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkPoint points[3];
|
||
gdouble s,c;
|
||
gdouble theta;
|
||
gint xc, yc;
|
||
gint tick_length;
|
||
gint i;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
if (event->count > 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
gdk_window_clear_area (widget->window,
|
||
0, 0,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height);
|
||
|
||
xc = widget->allocation.width/2;
|
||
yc = widget->allocation.height/2;
|
||
|
||
/* Draw ticks */
|
||
|
||
for (i=0; i<25; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
theta = (i*M_PI/18. - M_PI/6.);
|
||
s = sin(theta);
|
||
c = cos(theta);
|
||
|
||
tick_length = (i%6 == 0) ? dial->pointer_width : dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
|
||
gdk_draw_line (widget->window,
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[widget->state],
|
||
xc + c*(dial->radius - tick_length),
|
||
yc - s*(dial->radius - tick_length),
|
||
xc + c*dial->radius,
|
||
yc - s*dial->radius);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Draw pointer */
|
||
|
||
s = sin(dial->angle);
|
||
c = cos(dial->angle);
|
||
|
||
|
||
points[0].x = xc + s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[0].y = yc + c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[1].x = xc + c*dial->radius;
|
||
points[1].y = yc - s*dial->radius;
|
||
points[2].x = xc - s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[2].y = yc - c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
|
||
gtk_draw_polygon (widget->style,
|
||
widget->window,
|
||
GTK_STATE_NORMAL,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT,
|
||
points, 3,
|
||
TRUE);
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Event handling</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The rest of the widget's code handles various types of events, and
|
||
isn't too different from what would be found in many GTK
|
||
applications. Two types of events can occur - either the user can
|
||
click on the widget with the mouse and drag to move the pointer, or
|
||
the value of the Adjustment object can change due to some external
|
||
circumstance.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When the user clicks on the widget, we check to see if the click was
|
||
appropriately near the pointer, and if so, store the button that the
|
||
user clicked with in the <literal>button</literal> field of the widget
|
||
structure, and grab all mouse events with a call to
|
||
<literal>gtk_grab_add()</literal>. Subsequent motion of the mouse causes the
|
||
value of the control to be recomputed (by the function
|
||
<literal>gtk_dial_update_mouse</literal>). Depending on the policy that has been
|
||
set, "value_changed" events are either generated instantly
|
||
(<literal>GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS</literal>), after a delay in a timer added with
|
||
<literal>g_timeout_add()</literal> (<literal>GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED</literal>), or only when the
|
||
button is released (<literal>GTK_UPDATE_DISCONTINUOUS</literal>).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_button_press( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
gint dx, dy;
|
||
double s, c;
|
||
double d_parallel;
|
||
double d_perpendicular;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
/* Determine if button press was within pointer region - we
|
||
do this by computing the parallel and perpendicular distance of
|
||
the point where the mouse was pressed from the line passing through
|
||
the pointer */
|
||
|
||
dx = event->x - widget->allocation.width / 2;
|
||
dy = widget->allocation.height / 2 - event->y;
|
||
|
||
s = sin(dial->angle);
|
||
c = cos(dial->angle);
|
||
|
||
d_parallel = s*dy + c*dx;
|
||
d_perpendicular = fabs(s*dx - c*dy);
|
||
|
||
if (!dial->button &&
|
||
(d_perpendicular < dial->pointer_width/2) &&
|
||
(d_parallel > - dial->pointer_width))
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_grab_add (widget);
|
||
|
||
dial->button = event->button;
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse (dial, event->x, event->y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_button_release( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->button == event->button)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_grab_remove (widget);
|
||
|
||
dial->button = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
g_source_remove (dial->timer);
|
||
|
||
if ((dial->policy != GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS) &&
|
||
(dial->old_value != dial->adjustment->value))
|
||
gtk_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_motion_notify( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventMotion *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkModifierType mods;
|
||
gint x, y, mask;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->button != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint || (event->window != widget->window))
|
||
gdk_window_get_pointer (widget->window, &x, &y, &mods);
|
||
|
||
switch (dial->button)
|
||
{
|
||
case 1:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON1_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 2:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON2_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 3:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON3_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
mask = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (mods & mask)
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse (dial, x,y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_timer( GtkDial *dial )
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (dial != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial), FALSE);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
gtk_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse (GtkDial *dial, gint x, gint y)
|
||
{
|
||
gint xc, yc;
|
||
gfloat old_value;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
xc = GTK_WIDGET(dial)->allocation.width / 2;
|
||
yc = GTK_WIDGET(dial)->allocation.height / 2;
|
||
|
||
old_value = dial->adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->angle = atan2(yc-y, x-xc);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle < -M_PI/2.)
|
||
dial->angle += 2*M_PI;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle < -M_PI/6)
|
||
dial->angle = -M_PI/6;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle > 7.*M_PI/6.)
|
||
dial->angle = 7.*M_PI/6.;
|
||
|
||
dial->adjustment->value = dial->adjustment->lower + (7.*M_PI/6 - dial->angle) *
|
||
(dial->adjustment->upper - dial->adjustment->lower) / (4.*M_PI/3.);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment->value != old_value)
|
||
{
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_widget_draw (GTK_WIDGET(dial), NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
{
|
||
if (dial->timer)
|
||
g_source_remove (dial->timer);
|
||
|
||
dial->timer = g_timeout_add (SCROLL_DELAY_LENGTH,
|
||
(GtkFunction) gtk_dial_timer,
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Changes to the Adjustment by external means are communicated to our
|
||
widget by the "changed" and "value_changed" signals. The handlers
|
||
for these functions call <literal>gtk_dial_update()</literal> to validate the
|
||
arguments, compute the new pointer angle, and redraw the widget (by
|
||
calling <literal>gtk_widget_draw()</literal>).</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_update (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
gfloat new_value;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->value;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value < dial->adjustment->lower)
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->lower;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value > dial->adjustment->upper)
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->upper;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value != dial->adjustment->value)
|
||
{
|
||
dial->adjustment->value = new_value;
|
||
gtk_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dial->angle = 7.*M_PI/6. - (new_value - dial->adjustment->lower) * 4.*M_PI/3. /
|
||
(dial->adjustment->upper - dial->adjustment->lower);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_draw (GTK_WIDGET(dial), NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_adjustment_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (adjustment != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (data != NULL);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (data);
|
||
|
||
if ((dial->old_value != adjustment->value) ||
|
||
(dial->old_lower != adjustment->lower) ||
|
||
(dial->old_upper != adjustment->upper))
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->old_lower = adjustment->lower;
|
||
dial->old_upper = adjustment->upper;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_adjustment_value_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (adjustment != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (data != NULL);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (data);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->old_value != adjustment->value)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Possible Enhancements</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The Dial widget as we've described it so far runs about 670 lines of
|
||
code. Although that might sound like a fair bit, we've really
|
||
accomplished quite a bit with that much code, especially since much of
|
||
that length is headers and boilerplate. However, there are quite a few
|
||
more enhancements that could be made to this widget:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> If you try this widget out, you'll find that there is some
|
||
flashing as the pointer is dragged around. This is because the entire
|
||
widget is erased every time the pointer is moved before being
|
||
redrawn. Often, the best way to handle this problem is to draw to an
|
||
offscreen pixmap, then copy the final results onto the screen in one
|
||
step. (The ProgressBar widget draws itself in this fashion.)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> The user should be able to use the up and down arrow keys to
|
||
increase and decrease the value.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> It would be nice if the widget had buttons to increase and
|
||
decrease the value in small or large steps. Although it would be
|
||
possible to use embedded Button widgets for this, we would also like
|
||
the buttons to auto-repeat when held down, as the arrows on a
|
||
scrollbar do. Most of the code to implement this type of behavior can
|
||
be found in the Range widget.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> The Dial widget could be made into a container widget with a
|
||
single child widget positioned at the bottom between the buttons
|
||
mentioned above. The user could then add their choice of a label or
|
||
entry widget to display the current value of the dial.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-LearningMore">
|
||
<title>Learning More</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Only a small part of the many details involved in creating widgets
|
||
could be described above. If you want to write your own widgets, the
|
||
best source of examples is the GTK source itself. Ask yourself some
|
||
questions about the widget you want to write: IS it a Container
|
||
widget? Does it have its own window? Is it a modification of an
|
||
existing widget? Then find a similar widget, and start making changes.
|
||
Good luck!</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Scribble">
|
||
<title>Scribble, A Simple Example Drawing Program</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-ScribbleOverview">
|
||
<title>Overview</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>In this section, we will build a simple drawing program. In the
|
||
process, we will examine how to handle mouse events, how to draw in a
|
||
window, and how to do drawing better by using a backing pixmap. After
|
||
creating the simple drawing program, we will extend it by adding
|
||
support for XInput devices, such as drawing tablets. GTK provides
|
||
support routines which makes getting extended information, such as
|
||
pressure and tilt, from such devices quite easy.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>
|
||
<inlinemediaobject>
|
||
<imageobject>
|
||
<imagedata fileref="images/scribble.png" format="png">
|
||
</imageobject>
|
||
</inlinemediaobject>
|
||
</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-EventHandling">
|
||
<title>Event Handling</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GTK signals we have already discussed are for high-level actions,
|
||
such as a menu item being selected. However, sometimes it is useful to
|
||
learn about lower-level occurrences, such as the mouse being moved, or
|
||
a key being pressed. There are also GTK signals corresponding to these
|
||
low-level <emphasis>events</emphasis>. The handlers for these signals have an
|
||
extra parameter which is a pointer to a structure containing
|
||
information about the event. For instance, motion event handlers are
|
||
passed a pointer to a GdkEventMotion structure which looks (in part)
|
||
like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GdkEventMotion
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
gdouble x;
|
||
gdouble y;
|
||
...
|
||
guint state;
|
||
...
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>type</literal> will be set to the event type, in this case
|
||
<literal>GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY</literal>, window is the window in which the event
|
||
occurred. <literal>x</literal> and <literal>y</literal> give the coordinates of the event.
|
||
<literal>state</literal> specifies the modifier state when the event
|
||
occurred (that is, it specifies which modifier keys and mouse buttons
|
||
were pressed). It is the bitwise OR of some of the following:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GDK_SHIFT_MASK
|
||
GDK_LOCK_MASK
|
||
GDK_CONTROL_MASK
|
||
GDK_MOD1_MASK
|
||
GDK_MOD2_MASK
|
||
GDK_MOD3_MASK
|
||
GDK_MOD4_MASK
|
||
GDK_MOD5_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON1_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON2_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON3_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON4_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON5_MASK
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>As for other signals, to determine what happens when an event occurs
|
||
we call <literal>gtk_signal_connect()</literal>. But we also need let GTK
|
||
know which events we want to be notified about. To do this, we call
|
||
the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_widget_set_events (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint events);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The second field specifies the events we are interested in. It
|
||
is the bitwise OR of constants that specify different types
|
||
of events. For future reference the event types are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK
|
||
GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK
|
||
GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_MOTION_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON1_MOTION_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON2_MOTION_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON3_MOTION_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK
|
||
GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK
|
||
GDK_KEY_RELEASE_MASK
|
||
GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK
|
||
GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK
|
||
GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK
|
||
GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK
|
||
GDK_PROPERTY_CHANGE_MASK
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_IN_MASK
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT_MASK
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>There are a few subtle points that have to be observed when calling
|
||
<literal>gtk_widget_set_events()</literal>. First, it must be called before the X window
|
||
for a GTK widget is created. In practical terms, this means you
|
||
should call it immediately after creating the widget. Second, the
|
||
widget must have an associated X window. For efficiency, many widget
|
||
types do not have their own window, but draw in their parent's window.
|
||
These widgets are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkAlignment
|
||
GtkArrow
|
||
GtkBin
|
||
GtkBox
|
||
GtkImage
|
||
GtkItem
|
||
GtkLabel
|
||
GtkPixmap
|
||
GtkScrolledWindow
|
||
GtkSeparator
|
||
GtkTable
|
||
GtkAspectFrame
|
||
GtkFrame
|
||
GtkVBox
|
||
GtkHBox
|
||
GtkVSeparator
|
||
GtkHSeparator
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>To capture events for these widgets, you need to use an EventBox
|
||
widget. See the section on the <link linkend="sec-EventBox">EventBox</link> widget for details.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>For our drawing program, we want to know when the mouse button is
|
||
pressed and when the mouse is moved, so we specify
|
||
<literal>GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK</literal> and <literal>GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK</literal>. We also
|
||
want to know when we need to redraw our window, so we specify
|
||
<literal>GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK</literal>. Although we want to be notified via a
|
||
Configure event when our window size changes, we don't have to specify
|
||
the corresponding <literal>GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK</literal> flag, because it is
|
||
automatically specified for all windows.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>It turns out, however, that there is a problem with just specifying
|
||
<literal>GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK</literal>. This will cause the server to add a new
|
||
motion event to the event queue every time the user moves the mouse.
|
||
Imagine that it takes us 0.1 seconds to handle a motion event, but the
|
||
X server queues a new motion event every 0.05 seconds. We will soon
|
||
get way behind the users drawing. If the user draws for 5 seconds,
|
||
it will take us another 5 seconds to catch up after they release
|
||
the mouse button! What we would like is to only get one motion
|
||
event for each event we process. The way to do this is to
|
||
specify <literal>GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK</literal>. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When we specify <literal>GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK</literal>, the server sends
|
||
us a motion event the first time the pointer moves after entering
|
||
our window, or after a button press or release event. Subsequent
|
||
motion events will be suppressed until we explicitly ask for
|
||
the position of the pointer using the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GdkWindow* gdk_window_get_pointer (GdkWindow *window,
|
||
gint *x,
|
||
gint *y,
|
||
GdkModifierType *mask);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>(There is another function, <literal>gtk_widget_get_pointer()</literal> which
|
||
has a simpler interface, but turns out not to be very useful, since
|
||
it only retrieves the position of the mouse, not whether the buttons
|
||
are pressed.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The code to set the events for our window then looks like:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (drawing_area), "expose_event",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) expose_event, NULL);
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT(drawing_area),"configure_event",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) configure_event, NULL);
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (drawing_area), "motion_notify_event",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) motion_notify_event, NULL);
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (drawing_area), "button_press_event",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc) button_press_event, NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (drawing_area, GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK
|
||
| GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK
|
||
| GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>We'll save the "expose_event" and "configure_event" handlers for
|
||
later. The "motion_notify_event" and "button_press_event" handlers
|
||
are pretty simple:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
button_press_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
if (event->button == 1 && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->x, event->y);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
motion_notify_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event )
|
||
{
|
||
int x, y;
|
||
GdkModifierType state;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint)
|
||
gdk_window_get_pointer (event->window, &x, &y, &state);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
state = event->state;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, x, y);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-TheDrawingAreaWidget">
|
||
<title>The DrawingArea Widget, And Drawing</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>We now turn to the process of drawing on the screen. The
|
||
widget we use for this is the DrawingArea widget. A drawing area
|
||
widget is essentially an X window and nothing more. It is a blank
|
||
canvas in which we can draw whatever we like. A drawing area
|
||
is created using the call:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_drawing_area_new (void);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>A default size for the widget can be specified by calling:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_drawing_area_size (GtkDrawingArea *darea,
|
||
gint width,
|
||
gint height);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>This default size can be overridden, as is true for all widgets,
|
||
by calling <literal>gtk_widget_set_size_request()</literal>, and that, in turn, can
|
||
be overridden if the user manually resizes the the window containing
|
||
the drawing area.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>It should be noted that when we create a DrawingArea widget, we are
|
||
<emphasis>completely</emphasis> responsible for drawing the contents. If our
|
||
window is obscured then uncovered, we get an exposure event and must
|
||
redraw what was previously hidden.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Having to remember everything that was drawn on the screen so we
|
||
can properly redraw it can, to say the least, be a nuisance. In
|
||
addition, it can be visually distracting if portions of the
|
||
window are cleared, then redrawn step by step. The solution to
|
||
this problem is to use an offscreen <emphasis>backing pixmap</emphasis>.
|
||
Instead of drawing directly to the screen, we draw to an image
|
||
stored in server memory but not displayed, then when the image
|
||
changes or new portions of the image are displayed, we copy the
|
||
relevant portions onto the screen.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To create an offscreen pixmap, we call the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GdkPixmap* gdk_pixmap_new (GdkWindow *window,
|
||
gint width,
|
||
gint height,
|
||
gint depth);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The <literal>window</literal> parameter specifies a GDK window that this pixmap
|
||
takes some of its properties from. <literal>width</literal> and <literal>height</literal>
|
||
specify the size of the pixmap. <literal>depth</literal> specifies the <emphasis>color
|
||
depth</emphasis>, that is the number of bits per pixel, for the new window.
|
||
If the depth is specified as <literal>-1</literal>, it will match the depth
|
||
of <literal>window</literal>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>We create the pixmap in our "configure_event" handler. This event
|
||
is generated whenever the window changes size, including when it
|
||
is originally created.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* Backing pixmap for drawing area */
|
||
static GdkPixmap *pixmap = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new backing pixmap of the appropriate size */
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
configure_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventConfigure *event )
|
||
{
|
||
if (pixmap)
|
||
g_object_unref(pixmap);
|
||
|
||
pixmap = gdk_pixmap_new(widget->window,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height,
|
||
-1);
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap,
|
||
widget->style->white_gc,
|
||
TRUE,
|
||
0, 0,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The call to <literal>gdk_draw_rectangle()</literal> clears the pixmap
|
||
initially to white. We'll say more about that in a moment.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Our exposure event handler then simply copies the relevant portion
|
||
of the pixmap onto the screen (we determine the area we need
|
||
to redraw by using the event->area field of the exposure event):</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* Redraw the screen from the backing pixmap */
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
expose_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventExpose *event )
|
||
{
|
||
gdk_draw_drawable(widget->window,
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)],
|
||
pixmap,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.width, event->area.height);
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>We've now seen how to keep the screen up to date with our pixmap, but
|
||
how do we actually draw interesting stuff on our pixmap? There are a
|
||
large number of calls in GTK's GDK library for drawing on
|
||
<emphasis>drawables</emphasis>. A drawable is simply something that can be drawn
|
||
upon. It can be a window, a pixmap, or a bitmap (a black and white
|
||
image). We've already seen two such calls above,
|
||
<literal>gdk_draw_rectangle()</literal> and <literal>gdk_draw_drawable()</literal>. The
|
||
complete list is:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gdk_draw_point ()
|
||
gdk_draw_line ()
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle ()
|
||
gdk_draw_arc ()
|
||
gdk_draw_polygon ()
|
||
gdk_draw_pixmap ()
|
||
gdk_draw_bitmap ()
|
||
gdk_draw_image ()
|
||
gdk_draw_points ()
|
||
gdk_draw_segments ()
|
||
gdk_draw_lines ()
|
||
gdk_draw_pixbuf ()
|
||
gdk_draw_glyphs ()
|
||
gdk_draw_layout_line ()
|
||
gdk_draw_layout ()
|
||
gdk_draw_layout_line_with_colors ()
|
||
gdk_draw_layout_with_colors ()
|
||
gdk_draw_glyphs_transformed ()
|
||
gdk_draw_glyphs_trapezoids ()
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>See the reference documentation or the header file
|
||
<literal><gdk/gdkdrawable.h></literal> for further details on these functions.
|
||
These functions all share the same first two arguments. The first
|
||
argument is the drawable to draw upon, the second argument is a
|
||
<emphasis>graphics context</emphasis> (GC).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>A graphics context encapsulates information about things such as
|
||
foreground and background color and line width. GDK has a full set of
|
||
functions for creating and modifying graphics contexts, but to keep
|
||
things simple we'll just use predefined graphics contexts. Each widget
|
||
has an associated style. (Which can be modified in a gtkrc file, see
|
||
the section GTK's rc file.) This, among other things, stores a number
|
||
of graphics contexts. Some examples of accessing these graphics
|
||
contexts are:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
widget->style->white_gc
|
||
widget->style->black_gc
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL]
|
||
widget->style->bg_gc[gtk_widget_get_state(widget)]
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The fields <literal>fg_gc</literal>, <literal>bg_gc</literal>, <literal>dark_gc</literal>, and
|
||
<literal>light_gc</literal> are indexed by a parameter of type
|
||
<literal>GtkStateType</literal> which can take on the values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GTK_STATE_NORMAL,
|
||
GTK_STATE_ACTIVE,
|
||
GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT,
|
||
GTK_STATE_SELECTED,
|
||
GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>For instance, for <literal>GTK_STATE_SELECTED</literal> the default foreground
|
||
color is white and the default background color, dark blue.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Our function <literal>draw_brush()</literal>, which does the actual drawing
|
||
on the screen, is then:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* Draw a rectangle on the screen */
|
||
static void
|
||
draw_brush (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble x, gdouble y)
|
||
{
|
||
GdkRectangle update_rect;
|
||
|
||
update_rect.x = x - 5;
|
||
update_rect.y = y - 5;
|
||
update_rect.width = 10;
|
||
update_rect.height = 10;
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap,
|
||
widget->style->black_gc,
|
||
TRUE,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>After we draw the rectangle representing the brush onto the pixmap,
|
||
we call the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gint x,
|
||
gint y,
|
||
gint width,
|
||
gint height)
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>which notifies X that the area given by the <literal>x</literal>,
|
||
<literal>y</literal>, <literal>width</literal> and <literal>height</literal> parameters
|
||
needs to be updated. X will eventually generate an expose event
|
||
(possibly combining the areas passed in several calls to
|
||
<literal>gtk_widget_queue_draw_area()</literal>) which will cause our expose event handler
|
||
to copy the relevant portions to the screen.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>We have now covered the entire drawing program except for a few
|
||
mundane details like creating the main window.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-AddingXInputSupport">
|
||
<title>Adding XInput support</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>It is now possible to buy quite inexpensive input devices such
|
||
as drawing tablets, which allow drawing with a much greater
|
||
ease of artistic expression than does a mouse. The simplest way
|
||
to use such devices is simply as a replacement for the mouse,
|
||
but that misses out many of the advantages of these devices,
|
||
such as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Pressure sensitivity</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Tilt reporting</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Sub-pixel positioning</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> Multiple inputs (for example, a stylus with a point and eraser)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>For information about the XInput extension, see the <ulink
|
||
url="http://www.gtk.org/~otaylor/xinput/howto/index.html">XInput HOWTO</ulink>.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If we examine the full definition of, for example, the GdkEventMotion
|
||
structure, we see that it has fields to support extended device
|
||
information.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GdkEventMotion
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
gdouble x;
|
||
gdouble y;
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
gdouble xtilt;
|
||
gdouble ytilt;
|
||
guint state;
|
||
gint16 is_hint;
|
||
GdkInputSource source;
|
||
guint32 deviceid;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>pressure</literal> gives the pressure as a floating point number between
|
||
0 and 1. <literal>xtilt</literal> and <literal>ytilt</literal> can take on values between
|
||
-1 and 1, corresponding to the degree of tilt in each direction.
|
||
<literal>source</literal> and <literal>deviceid</literal> specify the device for which the
|
||
event occurred in two different ways. <literal>source</literal> gives some simple
|
||
information about the type of device. It can take the enumeration
|
||
values:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GDK_SOURCE_MOUSE
|
||
GDK_SOURCE_PEN
|
||
GDK_SOURCE_ERASER
|
||
GDK_SOURCE_CURSOR
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para><literal>deviceid</literal> specifies a unique numeric ID for the device. This can
|
||
be used to find out further information about the device using the
|
||
<literal>gdk_input_list_devices()</literal> call (see below). The special value
|
||
<literal>GDK_CORE_POINTER</literal> is used for the core pointer device. (Usually
|
||
the mouse.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Enabling extended device information</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>To let GTK know about our interest in the extended device information,
|
||
we merely have to add a single line to our program:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gtk_widget_set_extension_events (drawing_area, GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_CURSOR);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>By giving the value <literal>GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_CURSOR</literal> we say that
|
||
we are interested in extension events, but only if we don't have
|
||
to draw our own cursor. See the section <link
|
||
linkend="sec-FurtherSophistications"> Further Sophistications </link> below
|
||
for more information about drawing the cursor. We could also
|
||
give the values <literal>GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_ALL</literal> if we were willing
|
||
to draw our own cursor, or <literal>GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_NONE</literal> to revert
|
||
back to the default condition.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>This is not completely the end of the story however. By default,
|
||
no extension devices are enabled. We need a mechanism to allow
|
||
users to enable and configure their extension devices. GTK provides
|
||
the InputDialog widget to automate this process. The following
|
||
procedure manages an InputDialog widget. It creates the dialog if
|
||
it isn't present, and raises it to the top otherwise.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void
|
||
input_dialog_destroy (GtkWidget *w, gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
*((GtkWidget **)data) = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
create_input_dialog ()
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkWidget *inputd = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (!inputd)
|
||
{
|
||
inputd = gtk_input_dialog_new();
|
||
|
||
gtk_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT(inputd), "destroy",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc)input_dialog_destroy, &inputd);
|
||
gtk_signal_connect_object (GTK_OBJECT(GTK_INPUT_DIALOG(inputd)->close_button),
|
||
"clicked",
|
||
(GtkSignalFunc)gtk_widget_hide,
|
||
GTK_OBJECT(inputd));
|
||
gtk_widget_hide ( GTK_INPUT_DIALOG(inputd)->save_button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (inputd);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped(inputd))
|
||
gtk_widget_show(inputd);
|
||
else
|
||
gdk_window_raise(inputd->window);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>(You might want to take note of the way we handle this dialog. By
|
||
connecting to the "destroy" signal, we make sure that we don't keep a
|
||
pointer to dialog around after it is destroyed - that could lead to a
|
||
segfault.)</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>The InputDialog has two buttons "Close" and "Save", which by default
|
||
have no actions assigned to them. In the above function we make
|
||
"Close" hide the dialog, hide the "Save" button, since we don't
|
||
implement saving of XInput options in this program.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Using extended device information</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once we've enabled the device, we can just use the extended
|
||
device information in the extra fields of the event structures.
|
||
In fact, it is always safe to use this information since these
|
||
fields will have reasonable default values even when extended
|
||
events are not enabled.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Once change we do have to make is to call
|
||
<literal>gdk_input_window_get_pointer()</literal> instead of
|
||
<literal>gdk_window_get_pointer</literal>. This is necessary because
|
||
<literal>gdk_window_get_pointer</literal> doesn't return the extended device
|
||
information.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void gdk_input_window_get_pointer( GdkWindow *window,
|
||
guint32 deviceid,
|
||
gdouble *x,
|
||
gdouble *y,
|
||
gdouble *pressure,
|
||
gdouble *xtilt,
|
||
gdouble *ytilt,
|
||
GdkModifierType *mask);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>When calling this function, we need to specify the device ID as
|
||
well as the window. Usually, we'll get the device ID from the
|
||
<literal>deviceid</literal> field of an event structure. Again, this function
|
||
will return reasonable values when extension events are not
|
||
enabled. (In this case, <literal>event->deviceid</literal> will have the value
|
||
<literal>GDK_CORE_POINTER</literal>).</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>So the basic structure of our button-press and motion event handlers
|
||
doesn't change much - we just need to add code to deal with the
|
||
extended information.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
button_press_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
print_button_press (event->deviceid);
|
||
|
||
if (event->button == 1 && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->source, event->x, event->y, event->pressure);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
motion_notify_event( GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event )
|
||
{
|
||
gdouble x, y;
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
GdkModifierType state;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint)
|
||
gdk_input_window_get_pointer (event->window, event->deviceid,
|
||
&x, &y, &pressure, NULL, NULL, &state);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
pressure = event->pressure;
|
||
state = event->state;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->source, x, y, pressure);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>We also need to do something with the new information. Our new
|
||
<literal>draw_brush()</literal> function draws with a different color for
|
||
each <literal>event->source</literal> and changes the brush size depending
|
||
on the pressure.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
/* Draw a rectangle on the screen, size depending on pressure,
|
||
and color on the type of device */
|
||
static void
|
||
draw_brush (GtkWidget *widget, GdkInputSource source,
|
||
gdouble x, gdouble y, gdouble pressure)
|
||
{
|
||
GdkGC *gc;
|
||
GdkRectangle update_rect;
|
||
|
||
switch (source)
|
||
{
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_MOUSE:
|
||
gc = widget->style->dark_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)];
|
||
break;
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_PEN:
|
||
gc = widget->style->black_gc;
|
||
break;
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_ERASER:
|
||
gc = widget->style->white_gc;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
gc = widget->style->light_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
update_rect.x = x - 10 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.y = y - 10 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.width = 20 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.height = 20 * pressure;
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap, gc, TRUE,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
gtk_widget_draw (widget, &update_rect);
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>Finding out more about a device</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>As an example of how to find out more about a device, our program
|
||
will print the name of the device that generates each button
|
||
press. To find out the name of a device, we call the function:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
GList *gdk_input_list_devices (void);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>which returns a GList (a linked list type from the GLib library)
|
||
of GdkDeviceInfo structures. The GdkDeviceInfo structure is defined
|
||
as:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GdkDeviceInfo
|
||
{
|
||
guint32 deviceid;
|
||
gchar *name;
|
||
GdkInputSource source;
|
||
GdkInputMode mode;
|
||
gint has_cursor;
|
||
gint num_axes;
|
||
GdkAxisUse *axes;
|
||
gint num_keys;
|
||
GdkDeviceKey *keys;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>Most of these fields are configuration information that you can ignore
|
||
unless you are implementing XInput configuration saving. The fieldwe
|
||
are interested in here is <literal>name</literal> which is simply the name that X
|
||
assigns to the device. The other field that isn't configuration
|
||
information is <literal>has_cursor</literal>. If <literal>has_cursor</literal> is false, then we
|
||
we need to draw our own cursor. But since we've specified
|
||
<literal>GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_CURSOR</literal>, we don't have to worry about this.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Our <literal>print_button_press()</literal> function simply iterates through
|
||
the returned list until it finds a match, then prints out
|
||
the name of the device.</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
static void
|
||
print_button_press (guint32 deviceid)
|
||
{
|
||
GList *tmp_list;
|
||
|
||
/* gdk_input_list_devices returns an internal list, so we shouldn't
|
||
free it afterwards */
|
||
tmp_list = gdk_input_list_devices();
|
||
|
||
while (tmp_list)
|
||
{
|
||
GdkDeviceInfo *info = (GdkDeviceInfo *)tmp_list->data;
|
||
|
||
if (info->deviceid == deviceid)
|
||
{
|
||
printf("Button press on device '%s'\n", info->name);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
tmp_list = tmp_list->next;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>That completes the changes to "XInputize" our program.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2 id="sec-FurtherSophistications">
|
||
<title>Further sophistications</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Although our program now supports XInput quite well, it lacks some
|
||
features we would want in a full-featured application. First, the user
|
||
probably doesn't want to have to configure their device each time they
|
||
run the program, so we should allow them to save the device
|
||
configuration. This is done by iterating through the return of
|
||
<literal>gdk_input_list_devices()</literal> and writing out the configuration to a
|
||
file.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>To restore the state next time the program is run, GDK provides
|
||
functions to change device configuration:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
gdk_input_set_extension_events()
|
||
gdk_input_set_source()
|
||
gdk_input_set_mode()
|
||
gdk_input_set_axes()
|
||
gdk_input_set_key()
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>(The list returned from <literal>gdk_input_list_devices()</literal> should not be
|
||
modified directly.) An example of doing this can be found in the
|
||
drawing program gsumi. (Available from <ulink
|
||
url="http://www.msc.cornell.edu/~otaylor/gsumi/">http://www.msc.cornell.edu/~otaylor/gsumi/</ulink>) Eventually, it
|
||
would be nice to have a standard way of doing this for all
|
||
applications. This probably belongs at a slightly higher level than
|
||
GTK, perhaps in the GNOME library.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Another major omission that we have mentioned above is the lack of
|
||
cursor drawing. Platforms other than XFree86 currently do not allow
|
||
simultaneously using a device as both the core pointer and directly by
|
||
an application. See the <ulink
|
||
url="http://www.msc.cornell.edu/~otaylor/xinput/XInput-HOWTO.html">XInput-HOWTO</ulink> for more information about this. This means that
|
||
applications that want to support the widest audience need to draw
|
||
their own cursor.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>An application that draws its own cursor needs to do two things:
|
||
determine if the current device needs a cursor drawn or not, and
|
||
determine if the current device is in proximity. (If the current
|
||
device is a drawing tablet, it's a nice touch to make the cursor
|
||
disappear when the stylus is lifted from the tablet. When the
|
||
device is touching the stylus, that is called "in proximity.")
|
||
The first is done by searching the device list, as we did
|
||
to find out the device name. The second is achieved by selecting
|
||
"proximity_out" events. An example of drawing one's own cursor is
|
||
found in the "testinput" program found in the GTK distribution.</para>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Tips">
|
||
<title>Tips For Writing GTK Applications</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>This section is simply a gathering of wisdom, general style guidelines
|
||
and hints to creating good GTK applications. Currently this section
|
||
is very short, but I hope it will get longer in future editions of
|
||
this tutorial.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Use GNU autoconf and automake! They are your friends :) Automake
|
||
examines C files, determines how they depend on each other, and
|
||
generates a Makefile so the files can be compiled in the correct
|
||
order. Autoconf permits automatic configuration of software
|
||
installation, handling a large number of system quirks to increase
|
||
portability. I am planning to make a quick intro on them here.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>When writing C code, use only C comments (beginning with "/*" and
|
||
ending with "*/"), and don't use C++-style comments ("//"). Although
|
||
many C compilers understand C++ comments, others don't, and the ANSI C
|
||
standard does not require that C++-style comments be processed as
|
||
comments.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Contributing">
|
||
<title>Contributing</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>This document, like so much other great software out there, was
|
||
created for free by volunteers. If you are at all knowledgeable about
|
||
any aspect of GTK that does not already have documentation, please
|
||
consider contributing to this document.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you do decide to contribute, please mail your text to Tony Gale,
|
||
<literal><ulink url="mailto:gale@gtk.org">gale@gtk.org</ulink></literal>. Also, be aware that the entirety of this
|
||
document is free, and any addition by you provide must also be
|
||
free. That is, people may use any portion of your examples in their
|
||
programs, and copies of this document may be distributed at will, etc.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Thank you.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Credits">
|
||
<title>Credits</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>We would like to thank the following for their contributions to this text.</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Bawer Dagdeviren, <literal><ulink url="mailto:chamele0n@geocities.com">chamele0n@geocities.com</ulink></literal> for the menus tutorial.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Raph Levien, <literal><ulink url="mailto:raph@acm.org">raph@acm.org</ulink></literal>
|
||
for hello world ala GTK, widget packing, and general all around wisdom.
|
||
He's also generously donated a home for this tutorial.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Peter Mattis, <literal><ulink url="mailto:petm@xcf.berkeley.edu">petm@xcf.berkeley.edu</ulink></literal> for the simplest GTK program..
|
||
and the ability to make it :)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Werner Koch <literal><ulink url="mailto:werner.koch@guug.de">werner.koch@guug.de</ulink></literal> for converting the original plain text to
|
||
SGML, and the widget class hierarchy.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Mark Crichton <literal><ulink
|
||
url="mailto:crichton@expert.cc.purdue.edu">crichton@expert.cc.purdue.edu</ulink></literal> for the menu factory code,
|
||
and the table packing tutorial.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Owen Taylor <literal><ulink url="mailto:owt1@cornell.edu">owt1@cornell.edu</ulink></literal> for the EventBox widget section (and the
|
||
patch to the distro). He's also responsible for the selections code
|
||
and tutorial, as well as the sections on writing your own GTK widgets,
|
||
and the example application. Thanks a lot Owen for all you help!</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Mark VanderBoom <literal><ulink url="mailto:mvboom42@calvin.edu">mvboom42@calvin.edu</ulink></literal> for his wonderful work on the
|
||
Notebook, Progress Bar, Dialogs, and File selection widgets. Thanks a
|
||
lot Mark! You've been a great help.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Tim Janik <literal><ulink url="mailto:timj@gtk.org">timj@gtk.org</ulink></literal> for his great job on the Lists
|
||
Widget. His excellent work on automatically extracting the widget tree
|
||
and signal information from GTK. Thanks Tim :)</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Rajat Datta <literal><ulink url="mailto:rajat@ix.netcom.com">rajat@ix.netcom.com</ulink>
|
||
</literal> for the excellent job on the Pixmap
|
||
tutorial.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Michael K. Johnson <literal><ulink url="mailto:johnsonm@redhat.com">johnsonm@redhat.com</ulink></literal> for info and code for popup menus.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>David Huggins-Daines <literal><ulink
|
||
url="mailto:bn711@freenet.carleton.ca">bn711@freenet.carleton.ca</ulink></literal> for the Range Widgets and Tree
|
||
Widget sections.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>Stefan Mars <literal><ulink url="mailto:mars@lysator.liu.se">mars@lysator.liu.se</ulink></literal> for the CList section.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>David A. Wheeler <literal><ulink url="mailto:dwheeler@ida.org">dwheeler@ida.org</ulink></literal> for portions of the text on GLib
|
||
and various tutorial fixups and improvements.
|
||
The GLib text was in turn based on material developed by Damon Chaplin
|
||
<literal><ulink url="mailto:DAChaplin@msn.com">DAChaplin@msn.com</ulink></literal></simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara>David King for style checking the entire document.</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>And to all of you who commented on and helped refine this document.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Thanks.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<chapter id="ch-Copyright">
|
||
<title>Tutorial Copyright and Permissions Notice</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The GTK Tutorial is Copyright (C) 1997 Ian Main. </para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Copyright (C) 1998-2002 Tony Gale.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
|
||
manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
|
||
preserved on all copies.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
|
||
this document under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
|
||
this copyright notice is included exactly as in the original,
|
||
and that the entire resulting derived work is distributed under
|
||
the terms of a permission notice identical to this one.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
|
||
document into another language, under the above conditions for modified
|
||
versions.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>If you are intending to incorporate this document into a published
|
||
work, please contact the maintainer, and we will make an effort
|
||
to ensure that you have the most up to date information available.</para>
|
||
|
||
<para>There is no guarantee that this document lives up to its intended
|
||
purpose. This is simply provided as a free resource. As such,
|
||
the authors and maintainers of the information provided within can
|
||
not make any guarantee that the information is even accurate.</para>
|
||
|
||
</chapter>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<appendix id="app-GTKSignals">
|
||
<title>GTK Signals</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>As GTK is an object oriented widget set, it has a hierarchy of
|
||
inheritance. This inheritance mechanism applies for
|
||
signals. Therefore, you should refer to the widget hierarchy tree when
|
||
using the signals listed in this section.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkObject">
|
||
<title>GtkObject</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkObject::destroy (GtkObject *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkWidget">
|
||
<title>GtkWidget</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkWidget::show (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::hide (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::map (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::unmap (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::realize (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::unrealize (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::draw (GtkWidget *,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::draw-focus (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::draw-default (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::size-request (GtkWidget *,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::size-allocate (GtkWidget *,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::state-changed (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkStateType,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::parent-set (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkObject *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::style-set (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkStyle *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::add-accelerator (GtkWidget *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
GtkAccelGroup *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
GdkModifierType,
|
||
GtkAccelFlags,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::remove-accelerator (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkAccelGroup *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
GdkModifierType,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::button-press-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::button-release-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::motion-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::delete-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::destroy-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::expose-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::key-press-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::key-release-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::enter-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::leave-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::configure-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::focus-in-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::focus-out-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::map-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::unmap-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::property-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::selection-clear-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::selection-request-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::selection-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::selection-get (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::selection-received (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::proximity-in-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::proximity-out-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-begin (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-end (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-data-delete (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-leave (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::drag-motion (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::drag-drop (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-data-get (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::drag-data-received (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkDragContext *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
GtkSelectionData *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::client-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::no-expose-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
gboolean GtkWidget::visibility-notify-event (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GdkEvent *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkWidget::debug-msg (GtkWidget *,
|
||
GtkString *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkData">
|
||
<title>GtkData</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkData::disconnect (GtkData *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkContainer">
|
||
<title>GtkContainer</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkContainer::add (GtkContainer *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkContainer::remove (GtkContainer *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkContainer::check-resize (GtkContainer *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
GtkDirectionType GtkContainer::focus (GtkContainer *,
|
||
GtkDirectionType,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkContainer::set-focus-child (GtkContainer *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkCalendar">
|
||
<title>GtkCalendar</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkCalendar::month-changed (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::day-selected (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::day-selected-double-click (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::prev-month (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::next-month (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::prev-year (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkCalendar::next-year (GtkCalendar *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkEditable">
|
||
<title>GtkEditable</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkEditable::changed (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::insert-text (GtkEditable *,
|
||
GtkString *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::delete-text (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::activate (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::set-editable (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gboolean,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::move-cursor (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::move-word (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::move-page (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::move-to-row (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::move-to-column (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::kill-char (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::kill-word (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::kill-line (GtkEditable *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::cut-clipboard (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::copy-clipboard (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkEditable::paste-clipboard (GtkEditable *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkNotebook">
|
||
<title>GtkNotebook</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkNotebook::switch-page (GtkNotebook *,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkList">
|
||
<title>GtkList</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkList::selection-changed (GtkList *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkList::select-child (GtkList *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkList::unselect-child (GtkList *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkMenuShell">
|
||
<title>GtkMenuShell</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkMenuShell::deactivate (GtkMenuShell *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkMenuShell::selection-done (GtkMenuShell *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkMenuShell::move-current (GtkMenuShell *,
|
||
GtkMenuDirectionType,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkMenuShell::activate-current (GtkMenuShell *,
|
||
gboolean,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkMenuShell::cancel (GtkMenuShell *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkToolbar">
|
||
<title>GtkToolbar</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkToolbar::orientation-changed (GtkToolbar *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkToolbar::style-changed (GtkToolbar *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkButton">
|
||
<title>GtkButton</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkButton::pressed (GtkButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkButton::released (GtkButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkButton::clicked (GtkButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkButton::enter (GtkButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkButton::leave (GtkButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkItem">
|
||
<title>GtkItem</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkItem::select (GtkItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkItem::deselect (GtkItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkItem::toggle (GtkItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkWindow">
|
||
<title>GtkWindow</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkWindow::set-focus (GtkWindow *,
|
||
ggpointer,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkHandleBox">
|
||
<title>GtkHandleBox</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkHandleBox::child-attached (GtkHandleBox *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkHandleBox::child-detached (GtkHandleBox *,
|
||
GtkWidget *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkToggleButton">
|
||
<title>GtkToggleButton</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkToggleButton::toggled (GtkToggleButton *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkMenuItem">
|
||
<title>GtkMenuItem</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkMenuItem::activate (GtkMenuItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkMenuItem::activate-item (GtkMenuItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkCheckMenuItem">
|
||
<title>GtkCheckMenuItem</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkCheckMenuItem::toggled (GtkCheckMenuItem *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkInputDialog">
|
||
<title>GtkInputDialog</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkInputDialog::enable-device (GtkInputDialog *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkInputDialog::disable-device (GtkInputDialog *,
|
||
ggint,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkColorSelection">
|
||
<title>GtkColorSelection</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkColorSelection::color-changed (GtkColorSelection *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkStatusBar">
|
||
<title>GtkStatusBar</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkStatusbar::text-pushed (GtkStatusbar *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
GtkString *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkStatusbar::text-popped (GtkStatusbar *,
|
||
gguint,
|
||
GtkString *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkAdjustment">
|
||
<title>GtkAdjustment</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
void GtkAdjustment::changed (GtkAdjustment *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
void GtkAdjustment::value-changed (GtkAdjustment *,
|
||
gpointer);
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
</appendix>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<appendix id="app-GDKEventTypes">
|
||
<title>GDK Event Types</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>The following data types are passed into event handlers by GTK+. For
|
||
each data type listed, the signals that use this data type are listed.</para>
|
||
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEvent</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drag_end_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventType<</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventAny</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>delete_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>destroy_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>map_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>unmap_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>no_expose_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventExpose</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>expose_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventNoExpose</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventVisibility</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventMotion</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>motion_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventButton</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>button_press_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>button_release_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventKey</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>key_press_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>key_release_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventCrossing</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>enter_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>leave_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventFocus</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>focus_in_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>focus_out_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventConfigure</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>configure_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventProperty</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>property_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventSelection</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>selection_clear_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>selection_request_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>selection_notify_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventProximity</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>proximity_in_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>proximity_out_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventDragBegin</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drag_begin_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventDragRequest</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drag_request_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventDropEnter</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drop_enter_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventDropLeave</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drop_leave_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventDropDataAvailable</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>drop_data_available_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventClient</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>client_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
|
||
<listitem><simpara> GdkEventOther</simpara>
|
||
<itemizedlist>
|
||
<listitem><simpara>other_event</simpara>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
</listitem>
|
||
</itemizedlist>
|
||
|
||
<para>The data type <literal>GdkEventType</literal> is a special data type that is used by
|
||
all the other data types as an indicator of the data type being passed
|
||
to the signal handler. As you will see below, each of the event data
|
||
structures has a member of this type. It is defined as an enumeration
|
||
type as follows:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
typedef enum
|
||
{
|
||
GDK_NOTHING = -1,
|
||
GDK_DELETE = 0,
|
||
GDK_DESTROY = 1,
|
||
GDK_EXPOSE = 2,
|
||
GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY = 3,
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_PRESS = 4,
|
||
GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS = 5,
|
||
GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS = 6,
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE = 7,
|
||
GDK_KEY_PRESS = 8,
|
||
GDK_KEY_RELEASE = 9,
|
||
GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY = 10,
|
||
GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY = 11,
|
||
GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE = 12,
|
||
GDK_CONFIGURE = 13,
|
||
GDK_MAP = 14,
|
||
GDK_UNMAP = 15,
|
||
GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY = 16,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_CLEAR = 17,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_REQUEST = 18,
|
||
GDK_SELECTION_NOTIFY = 19,
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_IN = 20,
|
||
GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT = 21,
|
||
GDK_DRAG_BEGIN = 22,
|
||
GDK_DRAG_REQUEST = 23,
|
||
GDK_DROP_ENTER = 24,
|
||
GDK_DROP_LEAVE = 25,
|
||
GDK_DROP_DATA_AVAIL = 26,
|
||
GDK_CLIENT_EVENT = 27,
|
||
GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY = 28,
|
||
GDK_NO_EXPOSE = 29,
|
||
GDK_OTHER_EVENT = 9999 /* Deprecated, use filters instead */
|
||
} GdkEventType;
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
<para>The other event type that is different from the others is
|
||
<literal>GdkEvent</literal> itself. This is a union of all the other
|
||
data types, which allows it to be cast to a specific
|
||
event data type within a signal handler.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- Just a big list for now, needs expanding upon - TRG -->
|
||
<para>So, the event data types are defined as follows:</para>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
struct _GdkEventAny
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventExpose
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkRectangle area;
|
||
gint count; /* If non-zero, how many more events follow. */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventNoExpose
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
/* XXX: does anyone need the X major_code or minor_code fields? */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventVisibility
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkVisibilityState state;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventMotion
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
gdouble x;
|
||
gdouble y;
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
gdouble xtilt;
|
||
gdouble ytilt;
|
||
guint state;
|
||
gint16 is_hint;
|
||
GdkInputSource source;
|
||
guint32 deviceid;
|
||
gdouble x_root, y_root;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventButton
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
gdouble x;
|
||
gdouble y;
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
gdouble xtilt;
|
||
gdouble ytilt;
|
||
guint state;
|
||
guint button;
|
||
GdkInputSource source;
|
||
guint32 deviceid;
|
||
gdouble x_root, y_root;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventKey
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
guint state;
|
||
guint keyval;
|
||
gint length;
|
||
gchar *string;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventCrossing
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkWindow *subwindow;
|
||
GdkNotifyType detail;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventFocus
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
gint16 in;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventConfigure
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
gint16 x, y;
|
||
gint16 width;
|
||
gint16 height;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventProperty
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkAtom atom;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
guint state;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventSelection
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkAtom selection;
|
||
GdkAtom target;
|
||
GdkAtom property;
|
||
guint32 requestor;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* This event type will be used pretty rarely. It only is important
|
||
for XInput aware programs that are drawing their own cursor */
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventProximity
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 time;
|
||
GdkInputSource source;
|
||
guint32 deviceid;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventDragRequest
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 requestor;
|
||
union {
|
||
struct {
|
||
guint protocol_version:4;
|
||
guint sendreply:1;
|
||
guint willaccept:1;
|
||
guint delete_data:1; /* Do *not* delete if link is sent, only
|
||
if data is sent */
|
||
guint senddata:1;
|
||
guint reserved:22;
|
||
} flags;
|
||
glong allflags;
|
||
} u;
|
||
guint8 isdrop; /* This gdk event can be generated by a couple of
|
||
X events - this lets the app know whether the
|
||
drop really occurred or we just set the data */
|
||
|
||
GdkPoint drop_coords;
|
||
gchar *data_type;
|
||
guint32 timestamp;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventDragBegin
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
union {
|
||
struct {
|
||
guint protocol_version:4;
|
||
guint reserved:28;
|
||
} flags;
|
||
glong allflags;
|
||
} u;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventDropEnter
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 requestor;
|
||
union {
|
||
struct {
|
||
guint protocol_version:4;
|
||
guint sendreply:1;
|
||
guint extended_typelist:1;
|
||
guint reserved:26;
|
||
} flags;
|
||
glong allflags;
|
||
} u;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventDropLeave
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 requestor;
|
||
union {
|
||
struct {
|
||
guint protocol_version:4;
|
||
guint reserved:28;
|
||
} flags;
|
||
glong allflags;
|
||
} u;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventDropDataAvailable
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
guint32 requestor;
|
||
union {
|
||
struct {
|
||
guint protocol_version:4;
|
||
guint isdrop:1;
|
||
guint reserved:25;
|
||
} flags;
|
||
glong allflags;
|
||
} u;
|
||
gchar *data_type; /* MIME type */
|
||
gulong data_numbytes;
|
||
gpointer data;
|
||
guint32 timestamp;
|
||
GdkPoint coords;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventClient
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkAtom message_type;
|
||
gushort data_format;
|
||
union {
|
||
char b[20];
|
||
short s[10];
|
||
long l[5];
|
||
} data;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GdkEventOther
|
||
{
|
||
GdkEventType type;
|
||
GdkWindow *window;
|
||
gint8 send_event;
|
||
GdkXEvent *xevent;
|
||
};
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</appendix>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ***************************************************************** -->
|
||
<appendix id="app-CodeExamples">
|
||
<title>Code Examples</title>
|
||
|
||
<para>Below are the code examples that are used in the above text
|
||
which are not included in complete form elsewhere.</para>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Tictactoe">
|
||
<title>Tictactoe</title>
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>tictactoe.h</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start tictactoe tictactoe.h -->
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
#ifndef __TICTACTOE_H__
|
||
#define __TICTACTOE_H__
|
||
|
||
|
||
#include <glib.h>
|
||
#include <glib-object.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtktable.h>
|
||
|
||
|
||
G_BEGIN_DECLS
|
||
|
||
#define TICTACTOE_TYPE (tictactoe_get_type ())
|
||
#define TICTACTOE(obj) (G_TYPE_CHECK_INSTANCE_CAST ((obj), TICTACTOE_TYPE, Tictactoe))
|
||
#define TICTACTOE_CLASS(klass) (G_TYPE_CHECK_CLASS_CAST ((klass), TICTACTOE_TYPE, TictactoeClass))
|
||
#define IS_TICTACTOE(obj) (G_TYPE_CHECK_INSTANCE_TYPE ((obj), TICTACTOE_TYPE))
|
||
#define IS_TICTACTOE_CLASS(klass) (G_TYPE_CHECK_CLASS_TYPE ((klass), TICTACTOE_TYPE))
|
||
|
||
|
||
typedef struct _Tictactoe Tictactoe;
|
||
typedef struct _TictactoeClass TictactoeClass;
|
||
|
||
struct _Tictactoe
|
||
{
|
||
GtkTable table;
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *buttons[3][3];
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _TictactoeClass
|
||
{
|
||
GtkTableClass parent_class;
|
||
|
||
void (* tictactoe) (Tictactoe *ttt);
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
GType tictactoe_get_type (void);
|
||
GtkWidget* tictactoe_new (void);
|
||
void tictactoe_clear (Tictactoe *ttt);
|
||
|
||
G_END_DECLS
|
||
|
||
#endif /* __TICTACTOE_H__ */
|
||
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>tictactoe.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start tictactoe tictactoe.c -->
|
||
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
#include <gtk/gtksignal.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtktable.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtktogglebutton.h>
|
||
#include "tictactoe.h"
|
||
|
||
enum {
|
||
TICTACTOE_SIGNAL,
|
||
LAST_SIGNAL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static void tictactoe_class_init (TictactoeClass *klass);
|
||
static void tictactoe_init (Tictactoe *ttt);
|
||
static void tictactoe_toggle (GtkWidget *widget, Tictactoe *ttt);
|
||
|
||
static guint tictactoe_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 };
|
||
|
||
GType
|
||
tictactoe_get_type (void)
|
||
{
|
||
static GType ttt_type = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (!ttt_type)
|
||
{
|
||
const GTypeInfo ttt_info =
|
||
{
|
||
sizeof (TictactoeClass),
|
||
NULL, /* base_init */
|
||
NULL, /* base_finalize */
|
||
(GClassInitFunc) tictactoe_class_init,
|
||
NULL, /* class_finalize */
|
||
NULL, /* class_data */
|
||
sizeof (Tictactoe),
|
||
0,
|
||
(GInstanceInitFunc) tictactoe_init,
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
ttt_type = g_type_register_static (GTK_TYPE_TABLE, "Tictactoe", &ttt_info, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ttt_type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_class_init (TictactoeClass *klass)
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
tictactoe_signals[TICTACTOE_SIGNAL] = g_signal_new ("tictactoe",
|
||
G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
|
||
G_STRUCT_OFFSET (TictactoeClass, tictactoe),
|
||
NULL,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID,
|
||
G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
|
||
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_init (Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
gint i,j;
|
||
|
||
gtk_table_resize (GTK_TABLE (ttt), 3, 3);
|
||
gtk_table_set_homogeneous (GTK_TABLE (ttt), TRUE);
|
||
|
||
for (i=0;i<3; i++)
|
||
for (j=0;j<3; j++) {
|
||
ttt->buttons[i][j] = gtk_toggle_button_new ();
|
||
gtk_table_attach_defaults (GTK_TABLE (ttt), ttt->buttons[i][j],
|
||
i, i+1, j, j+1);
|
||
g_signal_connect (ttt->buttons[i][j], "toggled",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (tictactoe_toggle), (gpointer) ttt);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (ttt->buttons[i][j], 20, 20);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (ttt->buttons[i][j]);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget*
|
||
tictactoe_new ()
|
||
{
|
||
return GTK_WIDGET (g_object_new (tictactoe_get_type (), NULL));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
tictactoe_clear (Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
int i,j;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i<3; i++)
|
||
for (j = 0; j<3; j++)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_handlers_block_matched (G_OBJECT (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_MATCH_DATA,
|
||
0, 0, NULL, NULL, ttt);
|
||
gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
FALSE);
|
||
g_signal_handlers_unblock_matched (G_OBJECT (ttt->buttons[i][j]),
|
||
G_SIGNAL_MATCH_DATA,
|
||
0, 0, NULL, NULL, ttt);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tictactoe_toggle (GtkWidget *widget, Tictactoe *ttt)
|
||
{
|
||
int i,k;
|
||
|
||
static int rwins[8][3] = { { 0, 0, 0 }, { 1, 1, 1 }, { 2, 2, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 } };
|
||
static int cwins[8][3] = { { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 }, { 0, 1, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 0, 0 }, { 1, 1, 1 }, { 2, 2, 2 },
|
||
{ 0, 1, 2 }, { 2, 1, 0 } };
|
||
|
||
int success, found;
|
||
|
||
for (k = 0; k<8; k++)
|
||
{
|
||
success = TRUE;
|
||
found = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i<3; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
success = success &&
|
||
GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (ttt->buttons[rwins[k][i]][cwins[k][i]])->active;
|
||
found = found ||
|
||
ttt->buttons[rwins[k][i]][cwins[k][i]] == widget;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (success && found)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_emit (ttt,
|
||
tictactoe_signals[TICTACTOE_SIGNAL], 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>ttt_test.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start tictactoe ttt_test.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
#include "tictactoe.h"
|
||
|
||
void win( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gpointer data )
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Yay!\n");
|
||
tictactoe_clear (TICTACTOE (widget));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *ttt;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Aspect Frame");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
ttt = tictactoe_new ();
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), ttt);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (ttt);
|
||
|
||
/* And attach to its "tictactoe" signal */
|
||
g_signal_connect (ttt, "tictactoe",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (win), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-GtkDial">
|
||
<title>GtkDial</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>gtkdial.h</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start gtkdial gtkdial.h -->
|
||
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
#ifndef __GTK_DIAL_H__
|
||
#define __GTK_DIAL_H__
|
||
|
||
|
||
#include <gdk/gdk.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkadjustment.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkwidget.h>
|
||
|
||
|
||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||
extern "C" {
|
||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||
|
||
|
||
#define GTK_DIAL(obj) GTK_CHECK_CAST (obj, gtk_dial_get_type (), GtkDial)
|
||
#define GTK_DIAL_CLASS(klass) GTK_CHECK_CLASS_CAST (klass, gtk_dial_get_type (), GtkDialClass)
|
||
#define GTK_IS_DIAL(obj) GTK_CHECK_TYPE (obj, gtk_dial_get_type ())
|
||
|
||
|
||
typedef struct _GtkDial GtkDial;
|
||
typedef struct _GtkDialClass GtkDialClass;
|
||
|
||
struct _GtkDial
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget widget;
|
||
|
||
/* update policy (GTK_UPDATE_[CONTINUOUS/DELAYED/DISCONTINUOUS]) */
|
||
guint policy : 2;
|
||
|
||
/* Button currently pressed or 0 if none */
|
||
guint8 button;
|
||
|
||
/* Dimensions of dial components */
|
||
gint radius;
|
||
gint pointer_width;
|
||
|
||
/* ID of update timer, or 0 if none */
|
||
guint32 timer;
|
||
|
||
/* Current angle */
|
||
gfloat angle;
|
||
gfloat last_angle;
|
||
|
||
/* Old values from adjustment stored so we know when something changes */
|
||
gfloat old_value;
|
||
gfloat old_lower;
|
||
gfloat old_upper;
|
||
|
||
/* The adjustment object that stores the data for this dial */
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _GtkDialClass
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidgetClass parent_class;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget* gtk_dial_new (GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
GtkType gtk_dial_get_type (void);
|
||
GtkAdjustment* gtk_dial_get_adjustment (GtkDial *dial);
|
||
void gtk_dial_set_update_policy (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy);
|
||
|
||
void gtk_dial_set_adjustment (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment);
|
||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||
|
||
|
||
#endif /* __GTK_DIAL_H__ */
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>gtkdial.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start gtkdial gtkdial.c -->
|
||
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
#include <math.h>
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtkmain.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtksignal.h>
|
||
|
||
#include "gtkdial.h"
|
||
|
||
#define SCROLL_DELAY_LENGTH 300
|
||
#define DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE 100
|
||
|
||
/* Forward declarations */
|
||
|
||
static void gtk_dial_class_init (GtkDialClass *klass);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_init (GtkDial *dial);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_destroy (GtkObject *object);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_realize (GtkWidget *widget);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkRequisition *requisition);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkAllocation *allocation);
|
||
static gboolean gtk_dial_expose (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventExpose *event);
|
||
static gboolean gtk_dial_button_press (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event);
|
||
static gboolean gtk_dial_button_release (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event);
|
||
static gboolean gtk_dial_motion_notify (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventMotion *event);
|
||
static gboolean gtk_dial_timer (GtkDial *dial);
|
||
|
||
static void gtk_dial_update_mouse (GtkDial *dial, gint x, gint y);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_update (GtkDial *dial);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_adjustment_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data);
|
||
static void gtk_dial_adjustment_value_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data);
|
||
|
||
/* Local data */
|
||
|
||
static GtkWidgetClass *parent_class = NULL;
|
||
|
||
GType
|
||
gtk_dial_get_type ()
|
||
{
|
||
static GType dial_type = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (!dial_type)
|
||
{
|
||
const GTypeInfo dial_info =
|
||
{
|
||
sizeof (GtkDialClass),
|
||
NULL,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
(GClassInitFunc) gtk_dial_class_init,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
sizeof (GtkDial),
|
||
0,
|
||
(GInstanceInitFunc) gtk_dial_init,
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
dial_type = g_type_register_static (GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, "GtkDial", &dial_info, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return dial_type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_class_init (GtkDialClass *class)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkObjectClass *object_class;
|
||
GtkWidgetClass *widget_class;
|
||
|
||
object_class = (GtkObjectClass*) class;
|
||
widget_class = (GtkWidgetClass*) class;
|
||
|
||
parent_class = gtk_type_class (gtk_widget_get_type ());
|
||
|
||
object_class->destroy = gtk_dial_destroy;
|
||
|
||
widget_class->realize = gtk_dial_realize;
|
||
widget_class->expose_event = gtk_dial_expose;
|
||
widget_class->size_request = gtk_dial_size_request;
|
||
widget_class->size_allocate = gtk_dial_size_allocate;
|
||
widget_class->button_press_event = gtk_dial_button_press;
|
||
widget_class->button_release_event = gtk_dial_button_release;
|
||
widget_class->motion_notify_event = gtk_dial_motion_notify;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_init (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
dial->button = 0;
|
||
dial->policy = GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS;
|
||
dial->timer = 0;
|
||
dial->radius = 0;
|
||
dial->pointer_width = 0;
|
||
dial->angle = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_value = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_lower = 0.0;
|
||
dial->old_upper = 0.0;
|
||
dial->adjustment = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget*
|
||
gtk_dial_new (GtkAdjustment *adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
dial = g_object_new (gtk_dial_get_type (), NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (!adjustment)
|
||
adjustment = (GtkAdjustment*) gtk_adjustment_new (0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0, 0.0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_set_adjustment (dial, adjustment);
|
||
|
||
return GTK_WIDGET (dial);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_destroy (GtkObject *object)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (object != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (object));
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (object);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
g_object_unref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
dial->adjustment = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy)
|
||
(* GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy) (object);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
GtkAdjustment*
|
||
gtk_dial_get_adjustment (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (dial != NULL, NULL);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial), NULL);
|
||
|
||
return dial->adjustment;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
gtk_dial_set_update_policy (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkUpdateType policy)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
dial->policy = policy;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
gtk_dial_set_adjustment (GtkDial *dial,
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), NULL, (gpointer) dial);
|
||
g_object_unref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dial->adjustment = adjustment;
|
||
g_object_ref (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment));
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (adjustment), "changed",
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (gtk_dial_adjustment_changed),
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
g_signal_connect (GTK_OBJECT (adjustment), "value_changed",
|
||
GTK_SIGNAL_FUNC (gtk_dial_adjustment_value_changed),
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->old_lower = adjustment->lower;
|
||
dial->old_upper = adjustment->upper;
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_realize (GtkWidget *widget)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkWindowAttr attributes;
|
||
gint attributes_mask;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (widget != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget));
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, TRUE);
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
attributes.x = widget->allocation.x;
|
||
attributes.y = widget->allocation.y;
|
||
attributes.width = widget->allocation.width;
|
||
attributes.height = widget->allocation.height;
|
||
attributes.wclass = GDK_INPUT_OUTPUT;
|
||
attributes.window_type = GDK_WINDOW_CHILD;
|
||
attributes.event_mask = gtk_widget_get_events (widget) |
|
||
GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK |
|
||
GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK |
|
||
GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK;
|
||
attributes.visual = gtk_widget_get_visual (widget);
|
||
attributes.colormap = gtk_widget_get_colormap (widget);
|
||
|
||
attributes_mask = GDK_WA_X | GDK_WA_Y | GDK_WA_VISUAL | GDK_WA_COLORMAP;
|
||
widget->window = gdk_window_new (widget->parent->window, &attributes, attributes_mask);
|
||
|
||
widget->style = gtk_style_attach (widget->style, widget->window);
|
||
|
||
gdk_window_set_user_data (widget->window, widget);
|
||
|
||
gtk_style_set_background (widget->style, widget->window, GTK_STATE_ACTIVE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkRequisition *requisition)
|
||
{
|
||
requisition->width = DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE;
|
||
requisition->height = DIAL_DEFAULT_SIZE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GtkAllocation *allocation)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (widget != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget));
|
||
g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL);
|
||
|
||
widget->allocation = *allocation;
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
gdk_window_move_resize (widget->window,
|
||
allocation->x, allocation->y,
|
||
allocation->width, allocation->height);
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
dial->radius = MIN (allocation->width, allocation->height) * 0.45;
|
||
dial->pointer_width = dial->radius / 5;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_expose( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventExpose *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkPoint points[6];
|
||
gdouble s,c;
|
||
gdouble theta, last, increment;
|
||
GtkStyle *blankstyle;
|
||
gint xc, yc;
|
||
gint upper, lower;
|
||
gint tick_length;
|
||
gint i, inc;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
if (event->count > 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
/* gdk_window_clear_area (widget->window,
|
||
0, 0,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height);
|
||
*/
|
||
xc = widget->allocation.width / 2;
|
||
yc = widget->allocation.height / 2;
|
||
|
||
upper = dial->adjustment->upper;
|
||
lower = dial->adjustment->lower;
|
||
|
||
/* Erase old pointer */
|
||
|
||
s = sin (dial->last_angle);
|
||
c = cos (dial->last_angle);
|
||
dial->last_angle = dial->angle;
|
||
|
||
points[0].x = xc + s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[0].y = yc + c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[1].x = xc + c*dial->radius;
|
||
points[1].y = yc - s*dial->radius;
|
||
points[2].x = xc - s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[2].y = yc - c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[3].x = xc - c*dial->radius/10;
|
||
points[3].y = yc + s*dial->radius/10;
|
||
points[4].x = points[0].x;
|
||
points[4].y = points[0].y;
|
||
|
||
blankstyle = gtk_style_new ();
|
||
blankstyle->bg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] =
|
||
widget->style->bg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL];
|
||
blankstyle->dark_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] =
|
||
widget->style->bg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL];
|
||
blankstyle->light_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] =
|
||
widget->style->bg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL];
|
||
blankstyle->black_gc =
|
||
widget->style->bg_gc[GTK_STATE_NORMAL];
|
||
|
||
gtk_paint_polygon (blankstyle,
|
||
widget->window,
|
||
GTK_STATE_NORMAL,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
widget,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
points, 5,
|
||
FALSE);
|
||
|
||
g_object_unref (blankstyle);
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Draw ticks */
|
||
|
||
if ((upper - lower) == 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
increment = (100*M_PI) / (dial->radius*dial->radius);
|
||
|
||
inc = (upper - lower);
|
||
|
||
while (inc < 100) inc *= 10;
|
||
while (inc >= 1000) inc /= 10;
|
||
last = -1;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i <= inc; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
theta = ((gfloat)i*M_PI / (18*inc/24.) - M_PI/6.);
|
||
|
||
if ((theta - last) < (increment))
|
||
continue;
|
||
last = theta;
|
||
|
||
s = sin (theta);
|
||
c = cos (theta);
|
||
|
||
tick_length = (i%(inc/10) == 0) ? dial->pointer_width : dial->pointer_width / 2;
|
||
|
||
gdk_draw_line (widget->window,
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[widget->state],
|
||
xc + c*(dial->radius - tick_length),
|
||
yc - s*(dial->radius - tick_length),
|
||
xc + c*dial->radius,
|
||
yc - s*dial->radius);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Draw pointer */
|
||
|
||
s = sin (dial->angle);
|
||
c = cos (dial->angle);
|
||
dial->last_angle = dial->angle;
|
||
|
||
points[0].x = xc + s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[0].y = yc + c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[1].x = xc + c*dial->radius;
|
||
points[1].y = yc - s*dial->radius;
|
||
points[2].x = xc - s*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[2].y = yc - c*dial->pointer_width/2;
|
||
points[3].x = xc - c*dial->radius/10;
|
||
points[3].y = yc + s*dial->radius/10;
|
||
points[4].x = points[0].x;
|
||
points[4].y = points[0].y;
|
||
|
||
|
||
gtk_paint_polygon (widget->style,
|
||
widget->window,
|
||
GTK_STATE_NORMAL,
|
||
GTK_SHADOW_OUT,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
widget,
|
||
NULL,
|
||
points, 5,
|
||
TRUE);
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_button_press( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
gint dx, dy;
|
||
double s, c;
|
||
double d_parallel;
|
||
double d_perpendicular;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
/* Determine if button press was within pointer region - we
|
||
do this by computing the parallel and perpendicular distance of
|
||
the point where the mouse was pressed from the line passing through
|
||
the pointer */
|
||
|
||
dx = event->x - widget->allocation.width / 2;
|
||
dy = widget->allocation.height / 2 - event->y;
|
||
|
||
s = sin (dial->angle);
|
||
c = cos (dial->angle);
|
||
|
||
d_parallel = s*dy + c*dx;
|
||
d_perpendicular = fabs (s*dx - c*dy);
|
||
|
||
if (!dial->button &&
|
||
(d_perpendicular < dial->pointer_width/2) &&
|
||
(d_parallel > - dial->pointer_width))
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_grab_add (widget);
|
||
|
||
dial->button = event->button;
|
||
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse (dial, event->x, event->y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_button_release( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->button == event->button)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_grab_remove (widget);
|
||
|
||
dial->button = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
g_source_remove (dial->timer);
|
||
|
||
if ((dial->policy != GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS) &&
|
||
(dial->old_value != dial->adjustment->value))
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_motion_notify( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventMotion *event )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
GdkModifierType mods;
|
||
gint x, y, mask;
|
||
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (widget), FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (widget);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->button != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint || (event->window != widget->window))
|
||
gdk_window_get_pointer (widget->window, &x, &y, &mods);
|
||
|
||
switch (dial->button)
|
||
{
|
||
case 1:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON1_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 2:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON2_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 3:
|
||
mask = GDK_BUTTON3_MASK;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
mask = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (mods & mask)
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse (dial, x,y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
gtk_dial_timer( GtkDial *dial )
|
||
{
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (dial != NULL, FALSE);
|
||
g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial), FALSE);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_update_mouse( GtkDial *dial, gint x, gint y )
|
||
{
|
||
gint xc, yc;
|
||
gfloat old_value;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
xc = GTK_WIDGET(dial)->allocation.width / 2;
|
||
yc = GTK_WIDGET(dial)->allocation.height / 2;
|
||
|
||
old_value = dial->adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->angle = atan2(yc-y, x-xc);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle < -M_PI/2.)
|
||
dial->angle += 2*M_PI;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle < -M_PI/6)
|
||
dial->angle = -M_PI/6;
|
||
|
||
if (dial->angle > 7.*M_PI/6.)
|
||
dial->angle = 7.*M_PI/6.;
|
||
|
||
dial->adjustment->value = dial->adjustment->lower + (7.*M_PI/6 - dial->angle) *
|
||
(dial->adjustment->upper - dial->adjustment->lower) / (4.*M_PI/3.);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->adjustment->value != old_value)
|
||
{
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS)
|
||
{
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw (GTK_WIDGET (dial));
|
||
|
||
if (dial->policy == GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED)
|
||
{
|
||
if (dial->timer)
|
||
g_source_remove (dial->timer);
|
||
|
||
dial->timer = g_timeout_add (SCROLL_DELAY_LENGTH,
|
||
(GtkFunction) gtk_dial_timer,
|
||
(gpointer) dial);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_update (GtkDial *dial)
|
||
{
|
||
gfloat new_value;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (dial != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_DIAL (dial));
|
||
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->value;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value < dial->adjustment->lower)
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->lower;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value > dial->adjustment->upper)
|
||
new_value = dial->adjustment->upper;
|
||
|
||
if (new_value != dial->adjustment->value)
|
||
{
|
||
dial->adjustment->value = new_value;
|
||
g_signal_emit_by_name (GTK_OBJECT (dial->adjustment), "value_changed");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dial->angle = 7.*M_PI/6. - (new_value - dial->adjustment->lower) * 4.*M_PI/3. /
|
||
(dial->adjustment->upper - dial->adjustment->lower);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw (GTK_WIDGET (dial));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_adjustment_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (adjustment != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (data != NULL);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (data);
|
||
|
||
if ((dial->old_value != adjustment->value) ||
|
||
(dial->old_lower != adjustment->lower) ||
|
||
(dial->old_upper != adjustment->upper))
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
dial->old_lower = adjustment->lower;
|
||
dial->old_upper = adjustment->upper;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gtk_dial_adjustment_value_changed (GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
GtkDial *dial;
|
||
|
||
g_return_if_fail (adjustment != NULL);
|
||
g_return_if_fail (data != NULL);
|
||
|
||
dial = GTK_DIAL (data);
|
||
|
||
if (dial->old_value != adjustment->value)
|
||
{
|
||
gtk_dial_update (dial);
|
||
|
||
dial->old_value = adjustment->value;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>dial_test.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start gtkdial dial_test.c -->
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
#include "gtkdial.h"
|
||
|
||
void value_changed( GtkAdjustment *adjustment,
|
||
GtkWidget *label )
|
||
{
|
||
char buffer[16];
|
||
|
||
sprintf(buffer,"%4.2f",adjustment->value);
|
||
gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (label), buffer);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkAdjustment *adjustment;
|
||
GtkWidget *dial;
|
||
GtkWidget *frame;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
GtkWidget *label;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (window), "Dial");
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (exit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_set_border_width (GTK_CONTAINER (window), 10);
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 5);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
frame = gtk_frame_new (NULL);
|
||
gtk_frame_set_shadow_type (GTK_FRAME (frame), GTK_SHADOW_IN);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (vbox), frame);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (frame);
|
||
|
||
adjustment = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_adjustment_new (0, 0, 100, 0.01, 0.1, 0));
|
||
|
||
dial = gtk_dial_new (adjustment);
|
||
gtk_dial_set_update_policy (GTK_DIAL (dial), GTK_UPDATE_DELAYED);
|
||
/* gtk_widget_set_size_request (dial, 100, 100); */
|
||
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (frame), dial);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (dial);
|
||
|
||
label = gtk_label_new ("0.00");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_end (GTK_BOX (vbox), label, 0, 0, 0);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (label);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (adjustment, "value_changed",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (value_changed), (gpointer) label);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect1 id="sec-Scribble">
|
||
<title>Scribble</title>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>scribble-simple.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start scribble-simple scribble-simple.c -->
|
||
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Backing pixmap for drawing area */
|
||
static GdkPixmap *pixmap = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new backing pixmap of the appropriate size */
|
||
static gboolean configure_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventConfigure *event )
|
||
{
|
||
if (pixmap)
|
||
g_object_unref (pixmap);
|
||
|
||
pixmap = gdk_pixmap_new (widget->window,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height,
|
||
-1);
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap,
|
||
widget->style->white_gc,
|
||
TRUE,
|
||
0, 0,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Redraw the screen from the backing pixmap */
|
||
static gboolean expose_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventExpose *event )
|
||
{
|
||
gdk_draw_drawable (widget->window,
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)],
|
||
pixmap,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.width, event->area.height);
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Draw a rectangle on the screen */
|
||
static void draw_brush( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
gdouble x,
|
||
gdouble y)
|
||
{
|
||
GdkRectangle update_rect;
|
||
|
||
update_rect.x = x - 5;
|
||
update_rect.y = y - 5;
|
||
update_rect.width = 10;
|
||
update_rect.height = 10;
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap,
|
||
widget->style->black_gc,
|
||
TRUE,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean button_press_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventButton *event )
|
||
{
|
||
if (event->button == 1 && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->x, event->y);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean motion_notify_event( GtkWidget *widget,
|
||
GdkEventMotion *event )
|
||
{
|
||
int x, y;
|
||
GdkModifierType state;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint)
|
||
gdk_window_get_pointer (event->window, &x, &y, &state);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
state = event->state;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, x, y);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void quit ()
|
||
{
|
||
exit (0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int main( int argc,
|
||
char *argv[] )
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *drawing_area;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_name (window, "Test Input");
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the drawing area */
|
||
|
||
drawing_area = gtk_drawing_area_new ();
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (drawing_area), 200, 200);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), drawing_area, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (drawing_area);
|
||
|
||
/* Signals used to handle backing pixmap */
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "expose_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (expose_event), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "configure_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (configure_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Event signals */
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "motion_notify_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (motion_notify_event), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "button_press_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (button_press_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (drawing_area, GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK
|
||
| GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK
|
||
| GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
|
||
|
||
/* .. And a quit button */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
|
||
<!-- ----------------------------------------------------------------- -->
|
||
<sect2>
|
||
<title>scribble-xinput.c</title>
|
||
|
||
<programlisting role="C">
|
||
<!-- example-start scribble-xinput scribble-xinput.c -->
|
||
|
||
/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
|
||
* Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||
* version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||
*
|
||
* This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||
* Library General Public License for more details.
|
||
*
|
||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||
* License along with this library; if not, write to the
|
||
* Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||
* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
#include <gtk/gtk.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Backing pixmap for drawing area */
|
||
static GdkPixmap *pixmap = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new backing pixmap of the appropriate size */
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
configure_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventConfigure *event)
|
||
{
|
||
if (pixmap)
|
||
g_object_unref (pixmap);
|
||
|
||
pixmap = gdk_pixmap_new (widget->window,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height,
|
||
-1);
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap,
|
||
widget->style->white_gc,
|
||
TRUE,
|
||
0, 0,
|
||
widget->allocation.width,
|
||
widget->allocation.height);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Redraw the screen from the backing pixmap */
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
expose_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventExpose *event)
|
||
{
|
||
gdk_draw_drawable (widget->window,
|
||
widget->style->fg_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)],
|
||
pixmap,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.x, event->area.y,
|
||
event->area.width, event->area.height);
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Draw a rectangle on the screen, size depending on pressure,
|
||
and color on the type of device */
|
||
static void
|
||
draw_brush (GtkWidget *widget, GdkInputSource source,
|
||
gdouble x, gdouble y, gdouble pressure)
|
||
{
|
||
GdkGC *gc;
|
||
GdkRectangle update_rect;
|
||
|
||
switch (source)
|
||
{
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_MOUSE:
|
||
gc = widget->style->dark_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)];
|
||
break;
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_PEN:
|
||
gc = widget->style->black_gc;
|
||
break;
|
||
case GDK_SOURCE_ERASER:
|
||
gc = widget->style->white_gc;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
gc = widget->style->light_gc[gtk_widget_get_state (widget)];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
update_rect.x = x - 10 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.y = y - 10 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.width = 20 * pressure;
|
||
update_rect.height = 20 * pressure;
|
||
gdk_draw_rectangle (pixmap, gc, TRUE,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget,
|
||
update_rect.x, update_rect.y,
|
||
update_rect.width, update_rect.height);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
print_button_press (GdkDevice *device)
|
||
{
|
||
g_print ("Button press on device '%s'\n", device->name);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
button_press_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event)
|
||
{
|
||
print_button_press (event->device);
|
||
|
||
if (event->button == 1 && pixmap != NULL) {
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
gdk_event_get_axis ((GdkEvent *)event, GDK_AXIS_PRESSURE, &pressure);
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->device->source, event->x, event->y, pressure);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static gboolean
|
||
motion_notify_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event)
|
||
{
|
||
gdouble x, y;
|
||
gdouble pressure;
|
||
GdkModifierType state;
|
||
|
||
if (event->is_hint)
|
||
{
|
||
gdk_device_get_state (event->device, event->window, NULL, &state);
|
||
gdk_event_get_axis ((GdkEvent *)event, GDK_AXIS_X, &x);
|
||
gdk_event_get_axis ((GdkEvent *)event, GDK_AXIS_Y, &y);
|
||
gdk_event_get_axis ((GdkEvent *)event, GDK_AXIS_PRESSURE, &pressure);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
x = event->x;
|
||
y = event->y;
|
||
gdk_event_get_axis ((GdkEvent *)event, GDK_AXIS_PRESSURE, &pressure);
|
||
state = event->state;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK && pixmap != NULL)
|
||
draw_brush (widget, event->device->source, x, y, pressure);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
input_dialog_destroy (GtkWidget *w, gpointer data)
|
||
{
|
||
*((GtkWidget **)data) = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
create_input_dialog ()
|
||
{
|
||
static GtkWidget *inputd = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (!inputd)
|
||
{
|
||
inputd = gtk_input_dialog_new();
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (inputd, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (input_dialog_destroy), (gpointer) &inputd);
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (GTK_INPUT_DIALOG (inputd)->close_button,
|
||
"clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_hide),
|
||
inputd);
|
||
gtk_widget_hide (GTK_INPUT_DIALOG (inputd)->save_button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (inputd);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (inputd))
|
||
gtk_widget_show (inputd);
|
||
else
|
||
gdk_window_raise (inputd->window);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
int
|
||
main (int argc, char *argv[])
|
||
{
|
||
GtkWidget *window;
|
||
GtkWidget *drawing_area;
|
||
GtkWidget *vbox;
|
||
|
||
GtkWidget *button;
|
||
|
||
gtk_init (&argc, &argv);
|
||
|
||
window = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL);
|
||
gtk_widget_set_name (window, "Test Input");
|
||
|
||
vbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0);
|
||
gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (window), vbox);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (vbox);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (window, "destroy",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_main_quit), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Create the drawing area */
|
||
|
||
drawing_area = gtk_drawing_area_new ();
|
||
gtk_widget_set_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (drawing_area), 200, 200);
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), drawing_area, TRUE, TRUE, 0);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (drawing_area);
|
||
|
||
/* Signals used to handle backing pixmap */
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "expose_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (expose_event), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "configure_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (configure_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Event signals */
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "motion_notify_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (motion_notify_event), NULL);
|
||
g_signal_connect (drawing_area, "button_press_event",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (button_press_event), NULL);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_set_events (drawing_area, GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK
|
||
| GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK
|
||
| GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK
|
||
| GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
|
||
|
||
/* The following call enables tracking and processing of extension
|
||
events for the drawing area */
|
||
gtk_widget_set_extension_events (drawing_area, GDK_EXTENSION_EVENTS_CURSOR);
|
||
|
||
/* .. And some buttons */
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Input Dialog");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (create_input_dialog), NULL);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
button = gtk_button_new_with_label ("Quit");
|
||
gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vbox), button, FALSE, FALSE, 0);
|
||
|
||
g_signal_connect_swapped (button, "clicked",
|
||
G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_destroy),
|
||
window);
|
||
gtk_widget_show (button);
|
||
|
||
gtk_widget_show (window);
|
||
|
||
gtk_main ();
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
<!-- example-end -->
|
||
</programlisting>
|
||
|
||
</sect2>
|
||
</sect1>
|
||
|
||
</appendix>
|
||
</book>
|